X1 Technical Manual 1.1 (En) PDF
X1 Technical Manual 1.1 (En) PDF
X1 Technical Manual 1.1 (En) PDF
ComColor
TECHNICAL MANUAL
REVISION 1.1
October 2013
• Turn OFF the machine power and always disconnect the power plug
before performing maintenance work.
• Exercise extreme caution if you must work on the machine while power is
on.
Contents
CAUTION
[ Handling of Lithium Battery ]
- Never fail to follow the following instructions when you discard the used lithium battery.
1. The lithium battery must be replaced by a trained and authorized service technician.
2. The battery must be replaced only with the same or equivalent type recom- mended by
the manufacturer.
3. Discard used batteries according to the manufacturer instructions.
1. La batterie au lithium doit être remplacée par un technicien de maintenance formé et agréé.
2. La batterie de rechange doit être d’un type identique ou équivalent à celui recommandé par
le fabricant.
3. Éliminez les batteries usagées conformément aux instructions du fabricant.
!! WARNING !!
Important Safety Precautions
(1) Always disconnect electrical supply before placing hands in the machine.
1) To avoid injuries:
Be sure to turn OFF the power and disconnect the electrical power cord from the machine
before disassembling, assembling, or when making adjustments on the machine.
2) Protection of the machine:
Make sure to turn OFF the power to the machine before plugging or unplugging the main
power cord, electrical connectors, or when connecting a Meter.
(2) Discharge the Capacitors on the Power Supply Unit before servicing the machine.
1) To avoid electrical shock:
The capacitor (condenser) on the Power Supply Unit is still charged with electricity even
after the machine power is turned OFF and the machine power cord disconnected from the
power source.
Before servicing the machine, make sure to press the Sub Power Key, after switching OFF
the machine main power and disconnecting the power cord, to discharge the charged
power from the capacitor on the Power supply unit.
HEAT-SINK
1. Precautions
1-1. General precautions
* Unplug the power cord from the AC outlet before performing maintenance.
* Be careful to avoid getting neckties, clothing, or long hair tangled in moving parts.
* If you must perform work while the machine power is on, exercise the utmost caution.
* Never perform maintenance while the machine is operating.
- Be caution about the automatic descent operation of the transfer unit.
- After predetermined time, the descent operation of the transfer unit to the standby position and
the sliding operation of the cleaning unit to ink heads position are automatically performed.
- Be caution not to turn ON the machine and be injured by pinching hands or arms when covers
are removed for maintenance work.
* Work carefully to avoid injuring yourself on the sharp edges of metal sheets or springs.
* When a wrist watch, a ring, etc. become the obstacle of work, work by removing it.
cleaning is repeated several times, the print heads may need to be replaced.
* Differences between display and print colors
- The colors on prints may differ slightly from the colors seen on your display device.
- The difference in the colors may be attributable to various factors, including differences between
RGB and CMYK color systems, the RIP color system, display device settings, etc.
* Never touch the surfaces of the print head nozzles.
- Scratching the print head nozzle surface or dust adhering to the print head nozzle surface may
cause printing problems. Never wipe the print head nozzle surface.
- In the worst cases (misfiring nozzles), such problems may require replacement of the print heads.
To prevent problems, avoid touching print head nozzle surfaces during machine maintenance. Be
careful to avoid scratching print head nozzle surfaces with tools or parts when working near the
print heads.
* Protect the print heads from any physical shock.
- The print heads are extremely fragile. Handle them carefully, and avoid dropping or striking them.
* Selection of paper type
- Use only the specified paper type. Using the wrong paper may result in poor adhesion of ink to
the paper.
- If you choose to use a paper product not specifically recommended by the manufacturer, first
perform a printing test. Papers producing paper dust will cause misfires.
- Ink that fails to adhere to the paper may be left on the transport roller or transfer belt, smudging
subsequent prints.
- Internal parts contaminated by ink may require more frequent maintenance. To avoid these
problems, select your paper carefully.
* Maintenance of proper operating conditions
- Ink viscosity affects the ink ejecting performance of inkjet printers.
- Ink viscosity increases with lower temperatures, making ejection problems like nozzle misfires
more likely. Use the printer only under the specified operating conditions.
* Cleaning wipe
- To wipe off ink from the printer, use the Kimtech or Kimwipe products manufactured by CRECIA
Corp. or similar dust- and fiber-free materials. Never use ordinary tissue paper.
- Fibers and paper dust from cleaning materials may cause nozzle misfires and other problems.
- Never wipe the print head (the head surface). Let the machine clean the head by itself.
1-4.Sensors
* Be sure to turn off power before disconnecting or connecting sensors.
Photosensor types
* In general, photo sensors can be divided into four types: the interrupt type (U-shaped), the
actuator type, the reflection type, and the transmission type.
Switch types
* Microswitches use either N.O. (Normally Open) contact or N.C. (Normally Closed) contact.
* The N.O. contact closes when the switch actuator is pressed.
* The N.C. contact opens when the switch actuator is pressed.
2.Tools
Using tools other than those specified may result in damage to screws or other parts, or result in personal
injury. Be sure to have all the necessary tools on hand before beginning work.
5 mm 5.5 mm 7 mm
Spanners 8 mm 10 mm 13 mm
Monkey
5.0 mm 4.0 mm 3.0 mm
Hex wrenches 2.5 mm 2.0 mm 1.5 mm
(For 3.0mm, 2 pieces required )
Feeler gauge
Pliers
Nipper
Small flashlight
Multimeter
Vacuum cleaner
Inside of the machine must be kept free of the
paper dust. The paper dust must be sucked
out. Never blow on the dust, as the dust will
adhire to the print heads.
Plastic sheet
Working on the ink flow systems of the
machine,
it is recommended that pastic sheet is made
available to protect the floor from the ink stain.
Plastic sheet to protect the floor.
Isopropyl alcohol
To wipe off dripped ink from the metal frame
of the machine.
Lupe
Required to check the print quality.
Air filter
Required when working on the ink flow system
to prevent dust from entering into the ink flow
system.
Adjustable wrench.
Adjustable wrench is required to adjust
the height of the machine during the machine
installation.
Plastic forceps
Needed in working on the ink flow system.
4 pieces come with the machine.
For extra pieces, order them as spare parts.
Do not use the GREEN colored plastic forceps, which are
designed for HC models, on the ComColor ink tubes.
The green colored ones can only be used on the air tubes on
the ComColor machines.
Metal clip
These locally purchased metal clips maybe
applied on the ink tubes for temporary short
period on the site to stop the ink flow while
working on the ink flow system.
Use of dedicated plastic forceps is more recommended
Plastic cups
Rectangular plastic cups are convenient to
have in temporary resting of the removed Print
heads and also in catching the draining ink
while working on the ink flow system.
Laptop PC
Required in making the image adjustments on
ComColor machines when there is no HS4000
Scanner is not available.
Canon LiDE scanner is also needed.
USB cable
Required for connection between the Canon
LiDE Scanner and the Laptop PC.
Rubber cushion
For the injury prevention.
These are to cover the corner edges of
the PCB brackets.
3-2.Setup Wizard
* When the machine power is turned ON for the first time, Setup Wizard starts up.
* Make sure to input correct information on the Setup Wizard, especially the Year, Date and Time.
* Refer to the next page for the details on the Setup Wizard.
Setup Wizard
With full operation items connected to the ComColor, there are total of 12 pages to the items to
be selected.
Less selectable items are displayed when less options are connected.
Pages on the
Items Notes
LCD Display
00 Setup Wizard cover page -
01 Displayed language -
02 Metric/Inch switch -
03 Time zone setting -
04 Clock/Date -
05 Network setting -
06 Function key entry -
Selectable only when
07 Color mode HS4000 Scanner is
connected.
Selectable only when
Multi-function Finisher,
08 Output tray in each mode Auto Stacking Tray or
Wide Stacking Tray is
connected.
Selectable only on
09 Feed tray ComColor with Internal
paper feed tray.
10 Login setting -
11 Security level setting -
Selectable only when
12 User category HS4000 Scanner is
connected.
Displayed language
Select the desired language for the
ComColor LCD display message.
Metric/Inch switch
Select Metric for the machines to print on
metric size papers.
Select Inch for the machines to print on
inch size papers.
Clock/Date
Set the year, Month, Day, Hour and Minute.
Also select in which order the Year, Month
and Date should be displayed.
Network setting
Input the IP address, etc. of the ComColor.
Color mode
Selects the default color mode for the
Copy and Scanner modes. The selection
is available only whe HS4000 scanner is
connected.
Feed tray
Selectable only on ComColor with Internal
paper feed tray
Login setting
Selection of whether login is required or
not for each mode.
Copy and Scanner modes available only
when HS4000 Scanner is connected.
Auto logout time can also be set.
Need to change
the setting to ON.
User category
Selection of the user category.
DIFFERENT
SAME
SAME
Contents
1.Exterior covers
㻌
㻌
㻌 receiving tray
Face-down
㻌 Front right cover
㻌
㻌 Switchback guide
㻌
㻌
㻌 Rear left cover
㻌
㻌
㻌 External paper
Front left cover
㻌 feed tray cover
㻌
Left
㻌 bottom side cover
㻌
Tray cover
㻌
㻌
㻌
㻌
㻌
㻌
㻌
㻌
㻌
㻌
㻌
㻌
Ejection cover
2.Removal
2-1.Operation panel as a unit
The Operation panel is removed from the machine as a unit, together with its metal bottom plate, when going into
the Print head area.
** Remove the Top right cover and Top left cover. (Bind screws 4x8 (3 pcs each))
** Remove the screws at postions A and B. (IT3C screws 4x8 (3 pcs in total))
** Swing the Operation panel unit away, watching not to twist or damaging the electrical wires
Operation panel
2-3.Front doors
The left and right Front doors are removed as assemblies with the Right inner cover and Left inner
cover.
** Center inner cover must be removed first in order to remove the Left and Right inner covers.
2-4.Rear cover
It is best to remove the Rear cover with the Left rear cover and Right rear cover attached for easier
replacement.
** Left and Right top covers should be removed first for smooth removal and replacement of the Rear
cover.
Rear cover
Rear cover
SCREW
SCREW
SCREW
SCREW
2-6.Opening the PCBs and Ink supply unit to the service mode.
1) Remove the Left and Right top covers.
2) Remove the Rear cover assembly (Rear cover + Left & Right rear covers in one asssembly).
3) Remove the Grounding plate, which is screwed over the Engine control PCB. (Screws 4x8 (2 pcs))
If the Engine control PCB is lifted up without removing this Grounding plate, the Grounding plate will hit the
Engine control PCB and may damage the Engine control PCB.
Grounding plate.
4) Remove the screws and lift up the Engine control PCB. (Screws 4x8 (2 pcs))
- Screws numbered 1 & 2 on the next page photograph.
- Hook the arm on the right on the machine frame and fix its position using a screw.
5) Remove the screws and swing open the Power supply unit. (Screws 4x8 (2 pcs))
- Screws numbered 3 & 4 on the next page photograph.
6) Remove the screws and lift up the Controller PCB Box. (Screws 4x8 (2 pcs))
- Screws numbered 5 & 6 on the next page photograph.
- Support the raised Controller PCB with two screws, one on the right side of the Controller PCB
and the other on the left hand side.
Supporting screw on the left. Controller PCB Box Supporting screw on the right.
7)Remove the screws and swing open the Ink supply unit, very slowly and gently. (Screws 4x8 (3 pcs))
- Screws numbered 6, 7 & 8 on the next page photograph.
** The screw numbered 6 holds the two units, Controller PCB and Ink supply unit, together.
NOTE:
The screw numbers referred to on above explanation points to the photograph with these numbers
on the NEXT page.
The following photograph indicates the screw numbers used to identify the screws mentioned on the exploration on the
previous page.
Controller PCB Ink supply unit Engine controll PCB Power supply unit
Switchback motor
Re-feed motor
Head drive IC cooling fan 1
Upper transfer motor
Contents
1. x1 series ComColor specifications................................................. 3-2
ComColor 3110................................................................................ 3-2
ComColor 3150................................................................................ 3-3
ComColor 7110................................................................................ 3-4
ComColor 7150................................................................................ 3-5
ComColor 9110................................................................................ 3-6
ComColor 9150................................................................................ 3-7
High Capacity Feeder...................................................................... 3-8
High Capacity Stacker.................................................................... 3-8
Multifunction Finisher II.................................................................. 3-8
Face Down Offset Stapler............................................................... 3-9
ComColorExpress........................................................................... 3-9
IS1000C/IS950C............................................................................... 3-9
Scanner HS5000.............................................................................. 3-9
Wrapping Envelope Finisher........................................................ 3-10
Perfect Binder................................................................................ 3-11
2. Structural Overview......................................................................... 3-13
2-1. Overall Block Structure............................................................ 3-13
2-2. Overview of Paper Transfer..................................................... 3-17
2-3. Overview of Ink Flow Path....................................................... 3-19
ComColor 3110
ComColor 3110
Specifications
Print Type Line-type inkjet system
Ink Type Oil-based pigment ink (Cyan, Magenta, Yellow, Black)
Resolution Standard: 300 dpi (main scanning direction) × 300 dpi (subscanning direction)
Fine: 300 dpi (main scanning direction) × 600 dpi (subscanning direction)
Number of Gray Levels For each CMYK color (8 gray levels)
Data Processing Resolution Standard: 300 dpi × 300 dpi
Fine: 300 dpi × 600 dpi
Line smoothing: 600 dpi × 600 dpi
Warm-up Time 2 min. 45 sec. or less (at room temperature of 20ºC (68ºF))
First Print Time 5 sec. or less*1 (when copying A4/Letter short-edge feed using color mode)
Continuous Print Speed*2*6 A4 short-edge feed Simplex: 90 ppm, Duplex: 45 sheets/minute (90 ppm)
Letter short-edge feed Simplex: 90 ppm, Duplex: 45 sheets/minute (90 ppm)
Legal short-edge feed Simplex: 76 ppm, Duplex: 38 sheets/minute (76 ppm)
Paper Size Standard Tray Maximum: 340 mm × 550 mm (13 3/8" × 21 5/8")
Minimum: 90 mm × 148 mm (3 9/16" × 5 13/16")
Printable Area Maximum: 210 mm × 544 mm (8 1/4" × 21 7/16")
Guaranteed Print Area*3 Standard: Margin width of 5 mm (3/16")
Maximum: Margin width of 3 mm (1/8")
Paper Weight Standard Tray 46 gsm (12-lb bond) to 210 gsm (56-lb bond) (plain paper)
Paper Feed Method/ Standard Tray Height up to 110 mm (4 5/16")
Paper Tray Capacity
Output Tray Capacity Standard Height up to 60 mm (2 3/8")
Page Description Language RISORINC/CIII
Supported Protocols TCP/IP, HTTP, HTTPS (SSL), DHCP, ftp, lpr, IPP, SNMP, Port 9100 (RAW port), IPv4, IPv6, IPsec
Supported Operating Systems Microsoft® Windows® XP (32-bit), Microsoft® Windows Server® 2003 (32-bit/64-bit),
Microsoft® Windows Server® 2003 R2 (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft® Windows Vista® (32-bit/64-bit),
Microsoft® Windows Server® 2008 (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft® Windows Server® 2008 R2 (64-bit),
Microsoft® Windows® 7 (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft® Windows® 8 (32-bit/64-bit)*8, Microsoft® Windows Server® 2012 (64-bit)*8
Network Interface Ethernet 1000BASE-T, 100BASE-TX, 10BASE-T
Memory Capacity 1 GB
Hard Disk*4 Capacity 320 GB
Available Space 280 GB
Operating System Linux
Power Source AC 100-240 V, 10-5 A, 50-60 Hz
Power Consumption Maximum: 1,000 W
Ready*5: 150 W or less
Sleep*7: 5 W or less
Stand-by: 0.5 W or less
Operating Noise Max. 66 dB (when printing without optional equipment connected)
Operating Environment Temperature: 15ºC to 30ºC (59ºF to 86ºF)
Humidity: 40% to 70% RH (non-condensing)
Dimensions (W × D × H) In use: 1,220 mm × 705 mm × 1,030 mm (48 1/32" × 27 3/4" × 40 9/16")
Cover and feed trays closed: 1,155 mm × 705 mm × 1,010 mm (45 15/32" × 27 3/4" × 39 3/4")
Required Space (W × D × H) Cover and feed trays opened: 1,220 mm × 1,240 mm × 1,030 mm (48 1/32" × 48 13/16" × 40 9/16")
Weight Approx. 149 kg (328 lb)
Specifications are subject to change without notice.
*1 Within 10 minutes after the last print job
*2 When using plain paper and recycled paper (85 gsm (23-lb bond)), and density setting 3 (Standard) Chart used: Print measurement pattern [Color measurement sample 2 (JEITA standard pattern J6)]
*3 The margin when printing envelopes is 10 mm (3/8"). The guaranteed area when printing images is the area enclosed within 3 mm (1/8") of the edges of the paper.
*4 One gigabyte (GB) is calculated as one billion bytes.
*5 Without printing and temperature adjustment operation
*6 The continuous print speed varies depending on the type of optional output equipment connected. Multifunction finisher: Max. 90 sheets/minute (A4 short-edge feed simplex) Face down offset stapler: ComColor 3110: Max. 90 sheets/minute (A4 short-edge feed simplex)
*7 When setting [Power consumption (in sleep)] to [Low].
*8 Will soon be compatible, however will remain incompatible with Microsoft® Windows® RT.
NOTE:
This Machine Specification Sheet is for reference only.
Check with your Marketing Department for the precise specification of the machine to your country.
The specifications are subject to change without notice.
ComColor 3150
ComColor 3150
Specifications
Print Type Line-type inkjet system
Ink Type Oil-based pigment ink (Cyan, Magenta, Yellow, Black)
Resolution Standard: 300 dpi (main scanning direction) × 300 dpi (subscanning direction)
Fine: 300 dpi (main scanning direction) × 600 dpi (subscanning direction)
Number of Gray Levels For each CMYK color (8 gray levels)
Data Processing Resolution Standard: 300 dpi × 300 dpi
Fine: 300 dpi × 600 dpi
Line smoothing: 600 dpi × 600 dpi
Warm-up Time 2 min. 45 sec. or less (at room temperature of 20ºC (68ºF))
First Print Time 5 sec. or less*1 (when copying A4/Letter short-edge feed using color mode)
Continuous Print Speed*2*6 A4 short-edge feed Simplex: 90 ppm, Duplex: 45 sheets/minute (90 ppm)
Letter short-edge feed Simplex: 90 ppm, Duplex: 45 sheets/minute (90 ppm)
Legal short-edge feed Simplex: 76 ppm, Duplex: 38 sheets/minute (76 ppm)
Paper Size Standard Tray Maximum: 340 mm × 550 mm (13 3/8" × 21 5/8")
Minimum: 90 mm × 148 mm (3 9/16" × 5 13/16")
Feed Tray Maximum: 297 mm × 420 mm (11 11/16" × 17")
Minimum: 182 mm × 182 mm (7 3/16" × 7 3/16")
Printable Area Maximum: 210 mm × 544 mm (8 1/4" × 21 7/16")
Guaranteed Print Area*3 Standard: Margin width of 5 mm (3/16")
Maximum: Margin width of 3 mm (1/8")
Paper Weight Standard Tray 46 gsm (12-lb bond) to 210 gsm (56-lb bond) (plain paper)
Feed Tray 52 gsm (14-lb bond) to 104 gsm (28-lb bond) (plain paper)
Paper Feed Method/ Standard Tray Height up to 110 mm (4 5/16")
Paper Tray Capacity Feed Tray Height up to 50 mm (1 15/16") (× 3 trays)
Output Tray Capacity Standard Height up to 60 mm (2 3/8")
Page Description Language RISORINC/CIII
Supported Protocols TCP/IP, HTTP, HTTPS (SSL), DHCP, ftp, lpr, IPP, SNMP, Port 9100 (RAW port), IPv4, IPv6, IPsec
Supported Operating Systems Microsoft® Windows® XP (32-bit), Microsoft® Windows Server® 2003 (32-bit/64-bit),
Microsoft® Windows Server® 2003 R2 (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft® Windows Vista® (32-bit/64-bit),
Microsoft® Windows Server® 2008 (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft® Windows Server® 2008 R2 (64-bit),
Microsoft® Windows® 7 (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft® Windows® 8 (32-bit/64-bit)*8, Microsoft® Windows Server® 2012 (64-bit)*8
Network Interface Ethernet 1000BASE-T, 100BASE-TX, 10BASE-T
Memory Capacity 1 GB
Hard Disk*4 Capacity 320 GB
Available Space 280 GB
Operating System Linux
Power Source AC 100-240 V, 10-5 A, 50-60 Hz
Power Consumption Maximum: 1,000 W
Ready*5: 150 W or less
Sleep*7: 5 W or less
Stand-by: 0.5 W or less
Operating Noise Max. 66 dB (when printing without optional equipment connected)
Operating Environment Temperature: 15ºC to 30ºC (59ºF to 86ºF)
Humidity: 40% to 70% RH (non-condensing)
Dimensions (W × D × H) In use: 1,220 mm × 705 mm × 1,030 mm (48 1/32" × 27 3/4" × 40 9/16")
Cover and feed trays closed: 1,155 mm × 705 mm × 1,010 mm (45 15/32" × 27 3/4" × 39 3/4")
Required Space (W × D × H) Cover and feed trays opened: 1,220 mm × 1,240 mm × 1,030 mm (48 1/32" × 48 13/16" × 40 9/16")
Weight Approx. 171 kg (376 lb)
Specifications are subject to change without notice.
*1 Within 10 minutes after the last print job
*2 When using plain paper and recycled paper (85 gsm (23-lb bond)), and density setting 3 (Standard) Chart used: Print measurement pattern [Color measurement sample 2 (JEITA standard pattern J6)]
*3 The margin when printing envelopes is 10 mm (3/8"). The guaranteed area when printing images is the area enclosed within 3 mm (1/8") of the edges of the paper.
*4 One gigabyte (GB) is calculated as one billion bytes.
*5 Without printing and temperature adjustment operation
*6 The continuous print speed varies depending on the type of optional output equipment connected. Multifunction finisher: Max. 90 sheets/minute (A4 short-edge feed simplex) Face down offset stapler: ComColor 3150: Max. 90 sheets/minute (A4 short-edge feed simplex)
*7 When setting [Power consumption (in sleep)] to [Low].
*8 Will soon be compatible, however will remain incompatible with Microsoft® Windows® RT.
NOTE:
This Machine Specification Sheet is for reference only.
Check with your Marketing Department for the precise specification of the machine to your country.
The specifications are subject to change without notice.
ComColor 7110
ComColor 7110
Specifications
Print Type Line-type inkjet system
Ink Type Oil-based pigment ink (Cyan, Magenta, Yellow, Black)
Resolution Standard: 300 dpi (main scanning direction) × 300 dpi (subscanning direction)
Fine: 300 dpi (main scanning direction) × 600 dpi (subscanning direction)
Number of Gray Levels For each CMYK color (8 gray levels)
Data Processing Resolution Standard: 300 dpi × 300 dpi
Fine: 300 dpi × 600 dpi
Line smoothing: 600 dpi × 600 dpi
Warm-up Time 2 min. 45 sec. or less (at room temperature of 20ºC (68ºF))
First Print Time 5 sec. or less*1 (when copying A4/Letter long-edge feed using color mode)
Continuous Print Speed*2*6 A4 long-edge feed Simplex: 120 ppm, Duplex: 60 sheets/minute (120 ppm)
Letter long-edge feed Simplex: 120 ppm, Duplex: 60 sheets/minute (120 ppm)
A4 short-edge feed Simplex: 90 ppm, Duplex: 45 sheets/minute (90 ppm)
Letter short-edge feed Simplex: 90 ppm, Duplex: 45 sheets/minute (90 ppm)
B4/Legal short-edge feed Simplex: 76 ppm, Duplex: 38 sheets/minute (76 ppm)
A3 short-edge feed Simplex: 66 ppm, Duplex: 33 sheets/minute (66 ppm)
Ledger short-edge feed Simplex: 66 ppm, Duplex: 33 sheets/minute (66 ppm)
Paper Size Standard Tray Maximum: 340 mm × 550 mm (13 3/8" × 21 5/8")
Minimum: 90 mm × 148 mm (3 9/16" × 5 13/16")
Printable Area Maximum: 314 mm × 548 mm (12 3/8" × 21 9/16")
Guaranteed Print Area*3 Standard: Margin width of 3 mm (1/8")
Maximum: Margin width of 1 mm (0.04")
Paper Weight Standard Tray 46 gsm (12-lb bond) to 210 gsm (56-lb bond) (plain paper)
Paper Feed Method/ Standard Tray Height up to 110 mm (4 5/16")
Paper Tray Capacity
Output Tray Capacity Standard Height up to 60 mm (2 3/8")
Page Description Language RISORINC/CIII
Supported Protocols TCP/IP, HTTP, HTTPS (SSL), DHCP, ftp, lpr, IPP, SNMP, Port 9100 (RAW port), IPv4, IPv6, IPsec
Supported Operating Systems Microsoft® Windows® XP (32-bit), Microsoft® Windows Server® 2003 (32-bit/64-bit),
Microsoft® Windows Server® 2003 R2 (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft® Windows Vista® (32-bit/64-bit),
Microsoft® Windows Server® 2008 (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft® Windows Server® 2008 R2 (64-bit),
Microsoft® Windows® 7 (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft® Windows® 8 (32-bit/64-bit)*8, Microsoft® Windows Server® 2012 (64-bit)*8
Network Interface Ethernet 1000BASE-T, 100BASE-TX, 10BASE-T
Memory Capacity 1 GB
Hard Disk*4 Capacity 320 GB
Available Space 280 GB
Operating System Linux
Power Source AC 100-240 V, 10-5 A, 50-60 Hz
Power Consumption Maximum: 1,000 W
Ready*5: 150 W or less
Sleep*7: 5 W or less
Stand-by: 0.5 W or less
Operating Noise Max. 66 dB (when printing without optional equipment connected)
Operating Environment Temperature: 15ºC to 30ºC (59ºF to 86ºF)
Humidity: 40% to 70% RH (non-condensing)
Dimensions (W × D × H) In use: 1,220 mm × 705 mm × 1,030 mm (48 1/32" × 27 3/4" × 40 9/16")
Cover and feed trays closed: 1,155 mm × 705 mm × 1,010 mm (45 15/32" × 27 3/4" × 39 3/4")
Required Space (W × D × H) Cover and feed trays opened: 1,220 mm × 1,240 mm × 1,030 mm (48 1/32" × 48 13/16" × 40 9/16")
Weight Approx. 149 kg (328 lb)
Specifications are subject to change without notice.
*1 Within 10 minutes after the last print job
*2 When using plain paper and recycled paper (85 gsm (23-lb bond)), and density setting 3 (Standard) Chart used: Print measurement pattern [Color measurement sample 2 (JEITA standard pattern J6)]
*3 The margin when printing envelopes is 10 mm (3/8"). The guaranteed area when printing images is the area enclosed within 3 mm (1/8") of the edges of the paper.
*4 One gigabyte (GB) is calculated as one billion bytes.
*5 Without printing and temperature adjustment operation
*6 The continuous print speed varies depending on the type of optional output equipment connected. Multifunction finisher: Max. 120 sheets/minute (A4 long-edge feed simplex) Face down offset stapler: ComColor 7110: Max. 120 sheets/minute (A4 long-edge feed simplex)
*7 When setting [Power consumption (in sleep)] to [Low].
*8 Will soon be compatible, however will remain incompatible with Microsoft® Windows® RT.
NOTE:
This Machine Specification Sheet is for reference only.
Check with your Marketing Department for the precise specification of the machine to your country.
The specifications are subject to change without notice.
ComColor 7150
ComColor 7150
Specifications
Print Type Line-type inkjet system
Ink Type Oil-based pigment ink (Cyan, Magenta, Yellow, Black)
Resolution Standard: 300 dpi (main scanning direction) × 300 dpi (subscanning direction)
Fine: 300 dpi (main scanning direction) × 600 dpi (subscanning direction)
Number of Gray Levels For each CMYK color (8 gray levels)
Data Processing Resolution Standard: 300 dpi × 300 dpi
Fine: 300 dpi × 600 dpi
Line smoothing: 600 dpi × 600 dpi
Warm-up Time 2 min. 45 sec. or less (at room temperature of 20ºC (68ºF))
First Print Time 5 sec. or less*1 (when copying A4/Letter long-edge feed using color mode)
Continuous Print Speed*2*6 A4 long-edge feed Simplex: 120 ppm, Duplex: 60 sheets/minute (120 ppm)
Letter long-edge feed Simplex: 120 ppm, Duplex: 60 sheets/minute (120 ppm)
A4 short-edge feed Simplex: 90 ppm, Duplex: 45 sheets/minute (90 ppm)
Letter short-edge feed Simplex: 90 ppm, Duplex: 45 sheets/minute (90 ppm)
B4/Legal short-edge feed Simplex: 76 ppm, Duplex: 38 sheets/minute (76 ppm)
A3 short-edge feed Simplex: 66 ppm, Duplex: 33 sheets/minute (66 ppm)
Ledger short-edge feed Simplex: 66 ppm, Duplex: 33 sheets/minute (66 ppm)
Paper Size Standard Tray Maximum: 340 mm × 550 mm (13 3/8" × 21 5/8")
Minimum: 90 mm × 148 mm (3 9/16" × 5 13/16")
Feed Tray Maximum: 297 mm × 420 mm (11 11/16" × 17")
Minimum: 182 mm × 182 mm (7 3/16" × 7 3/16")
Printable Area Maximum: 314 mm × 548 mm (12 3/8" × 21 9/16")
Guaranteed Print Area*3 Standard: Margin width of 3 mm (1/8")
Maximum: Margin width of 1 mm (0.04")
Paper Weight Standard Tray 46 gsm (12-lb bond) to 210 gsm (56-lb bond) (plain paper)
Feed Tray 52 gsm (14-lb bond) to 104 gsm (28-lb bond) (plain paper)
Paper Feed Method/ Standard Tray Height up to 110 mm (4 5/16")
Paper Tray Capacity Feed Tray Height up to 50 mm (1 15/16") (× 3 trays)
Output Tray Capacity Standard Height up to 60 mm (2 3/8")
Page Description Language RISORINC/CIII
Supported Protocols TCP/IP, HTTP, HTTPS (SSL), DHCP, ftp, lpr, IPP, SNMP, Port 9100 (RAW port), IPv4, IPv6, IPsec
Supported Operating Systems Microsoft® Windows® XP (32-bit), Microsoft® Windows Server® 2003 (32-bit/64-bit),
Microsoft® Windows Server® 2003 R2 (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft® Windows Vista® (32-bit/64-bit),
Microsoft® Windows Server® 2008 (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft® Windows Server® 2008 R2 (64-bit),
Microsoft® Windows® 7 (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft® Windows® 8 (32-bit/64-bit)*8, Microsoft® Windows Server® 2012 (64-bit)*8
Network Interface Ethernet 1000BASE-T, 100BASE-TX, 10BASE-T
Memory Capacity 1 GB
Hard Disk*4 Capacity 320 GB
Available Space 280 GB
Operating System Linux
Power Source AC 100-240 V, 10-5 A, 50-60 Hz
Power Consumption Maximum: 1,000 W
Ready*5: 150 W or less
Sleep*7: 5 W or less
Stand-by: 0.5 W or less
Operating Noise Max. 66 dB (when printing without optional equipment connected)
Operating Environment Temperature: 15ºC to 30ºC (59ºF to 86ºF)
Humidity: 40% to 70% RH (non-condensing)
Dimensions (W × D × H) In use: 1,220 mm × 705 mm × 1,030 mm (48 1/32" × 27 3/4" × 40 9/16")
Cover and feed trays closed: 1,155 mm × 705 mm × 1,010 mm (45 15/32" × 27 3/4" × 39 3/4")
Required Space (W × D × H) Cover and feed trays opened: 1,220 mm × 1,240 mm × 1,030 mm (48 1/32" × 48 13/16" × 40 9/16")
Weight Approx. 171 kg (376 lb)
Specifications are subject to change without notice.
*1 Within 10 minutes after the last print job
*2 When using plain paper and recycled paper (85 gsm (23-lb bond)), and density setting 3 (Standard) Chart used: Print measurement pattern [Color measurement sample 2 (JEITA standard pattern J6)]
*3 The margin when printing envelopes is 10 mm (3/8"). The guaranteed area when printing images is the area enclosed within 3 mm (1/8") of the edges of the paper.
*4 One gigabyte (GB) is calculated as one billion bytes.
*5 Without printing and temperature adjustment operation
*6 The continuous print speed varies depending on the type of optional output equipment connected. Multifunction finisher: Max. 120 sheets/minute (A4 long-edge feed simplex) Face down offset stapler: ComColor 7150: Max. 120 sheets/minute (A4 long-edge feed simplex)
*7 When setting [Power consumption (in sleep)] to [Low].
*8 Will soon be compatible, however will remain incompatible with Microsoft® Windows® RT.
NOTE:
This Machine Specification Sheet is for reference only.
Check with your Marketing Department for the precise specification of the machine to your country.
The specifications are subject to change without notice.
ComColor 9150
ComColor 9110
Specifications
Print Type Line-type inkjet system
Ink Type Oil-based pigment ink (Cyan, Magenta, Yellow, Black)
Resolution Standard: 300 dpi (main scanning direction) × 300 dpi (subscanning direction)
Fine: 300 dpi (main scanning direction) × 600 dpi (subscanning direction)
Number of Gray Levels For each CMYK color (8 gray levels)
Data Processing Resolution Standard: 300 dpi × 300 dpi
Fine: 300 dpi × 600 dpi
Line smoothing: 600 dpi × 600 dpi
Warm-up Time 2 min. 45 sec. or less (at room temperature of 20ºC (68ºF))
First Print Time 5 sec. or less*1 (when copying A4/Letter long-edge feed using color mode)
Continuous Print Speed*2*6 A4 long-edge feed Simplex: 150 ppm, Duplex: 75 sheets/minute (150 ppm)
Letter long-edge feed Simplex: 146 ppm, Duplex: 73 sheets/minute (146 ppm)
A4 short-edge feed Simplex: 110 ppm, Duplex: 55 sheets/minute (110 ppm)
Letter short-edge feed Simplex: 116 ppm, Duplex: 58 sheets/minute (116 ppm)
B4/Legal short-edge feed Simplex: 90 ppm, Duplex: 42 sheets/minute (90 84 ppm)
A3 short-edge feed Simplex: 80 ppm, Duplex: 40 sheets/minute (80 ppm)
Ledger short-edge feed Simplex: 78 ppm, Duplex: 39 sheets/minute (78 ppm)
Paper Size Standard Tray Maximum: 340 mm × 550 mm (13 3/8" × 21 5/8")
Minimum: 90 mm × 148 mm (3 9/16" × 5 13/16")
Feed Tray Maximum: 297 mm × 420 mm (11 11/16" × 17")
Minimum: 182 mm × 182 mm (7 3/16" × 7 3/16")
Printable Area Maximum: 314 mm × 548 mm (12 3/8" × 21 9/16")
Guaranteed Print Area*3 Standard: Margin width of 3 mm (1/8")
Maximum: Margin width of 1 mm (0.04")
Paper Weight Standard Tray 46 gsm (12-lb bond) to 210 gsm (56-lb bond) (plain paper)
Feed Tray 52 gsm (14-lb bond) to 104 gsm (28-lb bond) (plain paper)
Paper Feed Method/ Standard Tray Height up to 110 mm (4 5/16")
Paper Tray Capacity Feed Tray Height up to 50 mm (1 15/16") (× 3 trays)
Output Tray Capacity Standard Height up to 60 mm (2 3/8")
Page Description Language RISORINC/CIII
Supported Protocols TCP/IP, HTTP, HTTPS (SSL), DHCP, ftp, lpr, IPP, SNMP, Port 9100 (RAW port), IPv4, IPv6, IPsec
Supported Operating Systems Microsoft® Windows® XP (32-bit), Microsoft® Windows Server® 2003 (32-bit/64-bit),
Microsoft® Windows Server® 2003 R2 (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft® Windows Vista® (32-bit/64-bit),
Microsoft® Windows Server® 2008 (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft® Windows Server® 2008 R2 (64-bit),
Microsoft® Windows® 7 (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft® Windows® 8 (32-bit/64-bit)*8, Microsoft® Windows Server® 2012 (64-bit)*8
Network Interface Ethernet 1000BASE-T, 100BASE-TX, 10BASE-T
Memory Capacity 1 GB
Hard Disk*4 Capacity 320 GB
Available Space 280 GB
Operating System Linux
Power Source AC 100-240 V, 10-5 A, 50-60 Hz
Power Consumption Maximum: 1,000 W
Ready*5: 150 W or less
Sleep*7: 5 W or less
Stand-by: 0.5 W or less
Operating Noise Max. 66 dB (when printing without optional equipment connected)
Operating Environment Temperature: 15ºC to 30ºC (59ºF to 86ºF)
Humidity: 40% to 70% RH (non-condensing)
Dimensions (W × D × H) In use: 1,220 mm × 705 mm × 1,030 mm (48 1/32" × 27 3/4" × 40 9/16")
Cover and feed trays closed: 1,155 mm × 705 mm × 1,010 mm (45 15/32" × 27 3/4" × 39 3/4")
Required Space (W × D × H) Cover and feed trays opened: 1,220 mm × 1,240 mm × 1,030 mm (48 1/32" × 48 13/16" × 40 9/16")
Weight Approx. 171 kg (376 lb)
Specifications are subject to change without notice.
*1 Within 10 minutes after the last print job
*2 When using plain paper and recycled paper (85 gsm (23-lb bond)), and density setting 3 (Standard) Chart used: Print measurement pattern [Color measurement sample 2 (JEITA standard pattern J6)]
*3 The margin when printing envelopes is 10 mm (3/8"). The guaranteed area when printing images is the area enclosed within 3 mm (1/8") of the edges of the paper.
*4 One gigabyte (GB) is calculated as one billion bytes.
*5 Without printing and temperature adjustment operation
*6 The continuous print speed varies depending on the type of optional output equipment connected. Multifunction finisher: Max. 120 sheets/minute (A4 long-edge feed simplex) Face down offset stapler: ComColor 9150: Max. 150 sheets/minute (A4 long-edge feed simplex)
*7 When setting [Power consumption (in sleep)] to [Low].
*8 Will soon be compatible, however will remain incompatible with Microsoft® Windows® RT.
NOTE:
This Machine Specification Sheet is for reference only.
Check with your Marketing Department for the precise specification of the machine to your country.
The specifications are subject to change without notice.
ComColor 9150
ComColor 9150
Specifications
Print Type Line-type inkjet system
Ink Type Oil-based pigment ink (Cyan, Magenta, Yellow, Black)
Resolution Standard: 300 dpi (main scanning direction) × 300 dpi (subscanning direction)
Fine: 300 dpi (main scanning direction) × 600 dpi (subscanning direction)
Number of Gray Levels For each CMYK color (8 gray levels)
Data Processing Resolution Standard: 300 dpi × 300 dpi
Fine: 300 dpi × 600 dpi
Line smoothing: 600 dpi × 600 dpi
Warm-up Time 2 min. 45 sec. or less (at room temperature of 20ºC (68ºF))
First Print Time 5 sec. or less*1 (when copying A4/Letter long-edge feed using color mode)
Continuous Print Speed*2*6 A4 long-edge feed Simplex: 150 ppm, Duplex: 75 sheets/minute (150 ppm)
Letter long-edge feed Simplex: 146 ppm, Duplex: 73 sheets/minute (146 ppm)
A4 short-edge feed Simplex: 110 ppm, Duplex: 55 sheets/minute (110 ppm)
Letter short-edge feed Simplex: 116 ppm, Duplex: 58 sheets/minute (116 ppm)
B4/Legal short-edge feed Simplex: 90 ppm, Duplex: 42 sheets/minute (90 84 ppm)
A3 short-edge feed Simplex: 80 ppm, Duplex: 40 sheets/minute (80 ppm)
Ledger short-edge feed Simplex: 78 ppm, Duplex: 39 sheets/minute (78 ppm)
Paper Size Standard Tray Maximum: 340 mm × 550 mm (13 3/8" × 21 5/8")
Minimum: 90 mm × 148 mm (3 9/16" × 5 13/16")
Feed Tray Maximum: 297 mm × 420 mm (11 11/16" × 17")
Minimum: 182 mm × 182 mm (7 3/16" × 7 3/16")
Printable Area Maximum: 314 mm × 548 mm (12 3/8" × 21 9/16")
Guaranteed Print Area*3 Standard: Margin width of 3 mm (1/8")
Maximum: Margin width of 1 mm (0.04")
Paper Weight Standard Tray 46 gsm (12-lb bond) to 210 gsm (56-lb bond) (plain paper)
Feed Tray 52 gsm (14-lb bond) to 104 gsm (28-lb bond) (plain paper)
Paper Feed Method/ Standard Tray Height up to 110 mm (4 5/16")
Paper Tray Capacity Feed Tray Height up to 50 mm (1 15/16") (× 3 trays)
Output Tray Capacity Standard Height up to 60 mm (2 3/8")
Page Description Language RISORINC/CIII
Supported Protocols TCP/IP, HTTP, HTTPS (SSL), DHCP, ftp, lpr, IPP, SNMP, Port 9100 (RAW port), IPv4, IPv6, IPsec
Supported Operating Systems Microsoft® Windows® XP (32-bit), Microsoft® Windows Server® 2003 (32-bit/64-bit),
Microsoft® Windows Server® 2003 R2 (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft® Windows Vista® (32-bit/64-bit),
Microsoft® Windows Server® 2008 (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft® Windows Server® 2008 R2 (64-bit),
Microsoft® Windows® 7 (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft® Windows® 8 (32-bit/64-bit)*8, Microsoft® Windows Server® 2012 (64-bit)*8
Network Interface Ethernet 1000BASE-T, 100BASE-TX, 10BASE-T
Memory Capacity 1 GB
Hard Disk*4 Capacity 320 GB
Available Space 280 GB
Operating System Linux
Power Source AC 100-240 V, 10-5 A, 50-60 Hz
Power Consumption Maximum: 1,000 W
Ready*5: 150 W or less
Sleep*7: 5 W or less
Stand-by: 0.5 W or less
Operating Noise Max. 66 dB (when printing without optional equipment connected)
Operating Environment Temperature: 15ºC to 30ºC (59ºF to 86ºF)
Humidity: 40% to 70% RH (non-condensing)
Dimensions (W × D × H) In use: 1,220 mm × 705 mm × 1,030 mm (48 1/32" × 27 3/4" × 40 9/16")
Cover and feed trays closed: 1,155 mm × 705 mm × 1,010 mm (45 15/32" × 27 3/4" × 39 3/4")
Required Space (W × D × H) Cover and feed trays opened: 1,220 mm × 1,240 mm × 1,030 mm (48 1/32" × 48 13/16" × 40 9/16")
Weight Approx. 171 kg (376 lb)
Specifications are subject to change without notice.
*1 Within 10 minutes after the last print job
*2 When using plain paper and recycled paper (85 gsm (23-lb bond)), and density setting 3 (Standard) Chart used: Print measurement pattern [Color measurement sample 2 (JEITA standard pattern J6)]
*3 The margin when printing envelopes is 10 mm (3/8"). The guaranteed area when printing images is the area enclosed within 3 mm (1/8") of the edges of the paper.
*4 One gigabyte (GB) is calculated as one billion bytes.
*5 Without printing and temperature adjustment operation
*6 The continuous print speed varies depending on the type of optional output equipment connected. Multifunction finisher: Max. 120 sheets/minute (A4 long-edge feed simplex) Face down offset stapler: ComColor 9150: Max. 150 sheets/minute (A4 long-edge feed simplex)
*7 When setting [Power consumption (in sleep)] to [Low].
*8 Will soon be compatible, however will remain incompatible with Microsoft® Windows® RT.
NOTE:
This Machine Specification Sheet is for reference only.
Check with your Marketing Department for the precise specification of the machine to your country.
The specifications are subject to change without notice.
Specifications
Specifications
High Capacity Feeder
High Capacity Feeder Multifunction
Multifunction Finisher II Finisher II
Type External unit Compatible Printer ComColor 9150/9110/7150/7110/3150/3110
Compatible Printer ComColor 9150/9110/7150/7110/3150/3110 Tray Type Top Tray Collating, stacking
Paper Size Maximum: Stacking Tray Collating, offset stacking
340 mm × 460 mm (13 3/8" × 18 1/8") Booklet Tray Booklet, paper folding
Minimum: Paper Size Top Tray*1 Maximum:
90 mm × 148 mm (3 9/16" × 5 13/16") 330 mm × 488 mm (13" × 19 3/16")
Paper Type and Weight 46 gsm (12-lb bond) to 210 gsm (56-lb bond) Minimum:
(plain paper, recycled paper, envelopes, 100 mm × 148 mm (3 15/16" × 5 13/16")
postcards) Stacking Tray*1 Maximum:
Tray Capacity Height up to 440 mm (17 5/16") 330 mm × 488 mm (13" × 19 3/16")
Power Source AC 100-240 V, 1.0-0.5 A, 50-60 Hz Minimum:
Power Consumption Maximum: 100 W 182 mm × 182 mm (7 3/16" × 7 3/16")
Operating Noise 68 dB (A) or less A4 long-edge feed printing Booklet Tray*1 Maximum:
(simplex/duplex) 330 mm × 457 mm (13" × 18")
Dimensions (W × D × H) 790 mm × 625 mm × 740 mm Minimum:
(31 3/32" × 24 19/32" × 29 1/8") 210 mm × 280 mm (8 1/4" × 11")
Required Space with Printer (W × D × H) 1,565 mm × 1,240 mm × 1,030 mm Paper Weight Top Tray 52 gsm (14-lb bond) to 210 gsm (56-lb bond)
(61 5/8" × 48 13/16" × 40 9/16") Stacking Tray 52 gsm (14-lb bond) to 210 gsm (56-lb bond)
Weight Approx. 67 kg (148 lb) Booklet Tray 60 gsm (16-lb bond) to 90 gsm (24-lb bond)
(cover: 210 gsm (56-lb bond))
Tray Capacity Top Tray 50 mm (1 31/32")
High Capacity
High Capacity Stacker Stacker Stacking Tray
Booklet Tray
200 mm (7 7/8")
50 mm (1 31/32")
Type External unit Stapling Maximum Number 100 sheets
Compatible Printer ComColor 9150/9110/7150/7110/3150/3110 of Staples* 2* 3
Finishing Functions Collating, offset stacking Paper Size Maximum:
297 mm × 432 mm (11 11/16" × 17")
Paper Size Maximum:
(equivalent to A3)
340 mm × 460 mm (13 3/8" × 18 1/8")
Minimum:
Minimum:
203 mm × 182 mm (8" × 7 3/16")
90 mm × 148 mm (3 9/16" × 5 13/16")
(equivalent to B5 long-edge feed)
Offset:
90 mm × 182 mm-340 mm × 432 mm Staple Position 1 at front side (angle stapling)
(3 9/16" × 7 3/16"-13 3/8" × 17") 1 at rear side (angle stapling*4, parallel stapling)
(envelopes are not acceptable) 2 at center (parallel stapling)
Paper Type and Weight 46 gsm (12-lb bond) to 210 gsm (56-lb bond) Punching Number of Punches 2 holes, 3 holes
(plain paper, recycled paper, postcards) 2 holes, 4 holes
Tray Capacity Collating: Paper Size 2 holes: A3, B4, A4, A4 long-edge feed, B5 long-
Height up to 440 mm (17 5/16")*1 edge feed, Ledger, Legal, Letter, Letter
Offset: long-edge feed
Height up to 405 mm (15 15/16")* 2 3 holes: A3, B4, A4 long-edge feed, B5 long-
edge feed, Ledger, Letter long-edge feed
Power Source AC 100-240 V, 1.4-0.7 A, 50-60 Hz
4 holes: A3, A4 long-edge feed, Ledger, Letter
Power Consumption Maximum: 140 W long-edge feed
Operating Noise 68 dB (A) or less A4 long-edge feed printing Paper Weight 52 gsm (14-lb bond) to 200 gsm (53-lb bond)
(simplex/duplex)
Creating a Booklet Max. Number of Center margin: 15 sheets (60 pages)
Dimensions (W × D × H) 1,000 mm × 700 mm × 935 mm (Center margin/2-fold) Sheets* 2*5 2-fold: 5 sheets (20 pages)
(39 3/8" × 27 9/16" × 36 13/16")
Power Source AC 100-240 V, 2.0-1.0 A, 50-60 Hz
Required Space with Printer (W × D × H) 2,810 mm × 1,320 mm × 1,030 mm
Power Consumption Maximum: 175 W
(110 5/8" × 51 31/32" × 40 9/16")
Operating Noise Max. 68 dB (when using Multifunction Finisher II)
Weight Approx. 130 kg (287 lb)
Dimensions (W × D × H) 1,120 mm × 765 mm × 1,130 mm
*1 For A5, postcard, envelope, irregular size, etc., height up to 110 mm (4 11/32") is applicable
(44 3/32" × 30 1/8" × 44 1/2")
*2 A5, postcard, envelope, irregular size, etc. are not applicable
Required Space with Printer (W × D × H) 2,315 mm × 1,280 mm × 1,130 mm
(with cover and tray extended) (91 5/32" × 50 13/32" × 44 1/2")
Weight Approx. 131 kg (289 lb)
*1 When color printing on paper that is no longer than 432 mm (17") may be distorted
*2 When using plain paper and recycled paper (85 gsm (23-lb bond))
*3 65 sheets for a paper size exceeding A4/letter
*4 Rear-side angle stapling is only available for A4 long-edge feed and A3
*5 Includes an added cover
NOTE:
This Machine Specification Sheet is for reference only.
Check with your Marketing Department for the precise specification of the machine to your country.
The specifications are subject to change without notice.
Face Down
Face Down Offset Stapler
Offset Stapler Scanner HS5000
Scanner HS5000
Type External unit Type Flat bed scanner with Automatic Document
Compatible Printer ComColor 9150/9110/7150/7110/3150/3110 Feeder (ADF)
Finishing Functions Offset stacking, staple Compatible Printer ComColor 9150/9110/7150/7110/3150/3110
Paper Size Without offset Maximum: Scanning Modes Color, Monochrome, Auto
340 mm × 550 mm (13 3/8" × 21 5/8") Scanning Resolution 600 dpi, 400 dpi, 300 dpi, or 200 dpi
Minimum: Maximum Scanning Area 303 mm × 432 mm (11 15/16" × 17")
90 mm × 148 mm (3 9/16" × 5 13/16") (when using flat bed scanner)
Offset output Paper width: 295 mm × 430 mm (11 5/8" × 16 15/16")
131 mm to 305 mm (5 3/16" to 12") (when using ADF)
Paper Type and Weight 46 gsm (12-lb bond) to 210 gsm (56-lb bond) Copy Writing Resolution Standard: 300 dpi × 300 dpi
(plain paper, recycled paper, postcards) Fine: 300 dpi × 600 dpi
Tray Capacity Height up to 108 mm (4 1/4") Copy Paper Size Maximum: 303 mm × 432 mm (11 15/16" × 17")
Max. Number of 50 sheets* A4, A4 long-edge feed, B5, B5 long-edge feed, (equivalent to A3)
Sheets for Staples Letter, Letter long-edge feed Initial Copy Time Monochrome/Color: 7 sec or less (when copying
25 sheets* A3, B4, Ledger, Legal A4/letter long-edge feed orientation using Color
Paper Size for Staple A3, B4, A4, A4 long-edge feed, B5, B5 long-edge Priority Mode)
feed, Ledger, Legal, Letter, Letter long-edge feed, Scanning Speed Simplex copying (A4/letter long-edge feed, using
Foolscap ADF): 50 ppm or higher
Paper Weight for Staple 52 gsm (14-lb bond) to 210 gsm (56-lb bond) Duplex copying (A4/letter long-edge feed, using
(plain paper, recycled paper) ADF): 12 sheets/minute (24 ppm) or higher
Staple Position 1 at front side (angle stapling) Scaling 50% to 200% (Copy mode)
1 at rear side (angle stapling) 50% to 200% (Scanner mode, resolution:
2 at center (parallel stapling) 200/300 dpi), only 100%
(Scanner mode, resolution: 400/600 dpi)
Power Source AC 100-240 V, 1.2-0.6 A, 50-60 Hz
Auto Document Type Original (transfer, duplex scanning with switch-
Power Consumption Maximum: 110 W
Feeder back system)
Dimensions (W × D × H) 759 mm × 677 mm × 582 mm
Original Source 297 mm × 432 mm (11 11/16" × 17")
(29 7/8" × 26 21/32" × 22 29/32")
Size: Maximum (equivalent to A3)
Required Space with Printer (W × D × H) 1,440 mm × 705 mm × 1,345 mm
Original Source Simplex:
(56 11/16" × 27 3/4" × 52 31/32")
Size: Minimum 100 mm × 148 mm (3 15/16" × 5 13/16")
Weight Approx. 30 kg (66 lb) Duplex:
* When using plain paper and recycled paper (85 g/m2 (23-lb bond)) 128 mm × 182 mm (5 2/32" × 7 3/16")
Paper Weight 52 gsm (14-lb bond) to 128 gsm (34-lb bond)
ComColorExpress
ComColorExpress IS1000C/IS950C
IS1000C/IS950C Original Capacity: Max. 100 sheets*1
Smaller than B4
Model Name ComColorExpress IS1000C ComColorExpress IS950C
Original Capacity: Max. 60 sheets*2
VB-XE34G VB-PG29G
B4 or Larger
Compatible Printer ComColor 9150/9110/7150/7110/3150/3110
Scanning Speed Simplex printing: 50 ppm or higher
CPU Intel® Xeon® E3-1275 3.4GHz Intel® Pentium® G850 2.9GHz (A4/letter long-edge feed)
Memory Capacity 8GB 2GB Duplex printing: 12 sheets/minute (24 ppm) or
HDD 500 GB (user available area*1: approximately 460GB) higher (A4/letter long-edge feed)
Controller OS Linux Scan Scanning Gray 10-bit input and 8-bit output for each RGB color
LAN I/F Ethernet 1000BASE-T, 100BASE-TX, 10BASE-T Levels
Power Source 100-240V AC, 1.1A-0.5A, 100-240V AC, 0.9A-0.4A, Scanning Speed Monochrome/Color: 50 ppm
50/60Hz 50/60Hz Network Interface* 3 Ethernet 1000BASE-T/100BASE-TX/10BASE-T
Power Consumption Maximum: 110 W Maximum: 85 W Data-saving Main unit hard drive, external server, or USB flash
Ready* 2: 75 W or less Ready* 2: 65 W or less Method* 3 drive, or e-mail
Stand-by: 4 W or less Stand-by: 4 W or less Data-saving Monochrome: TIFF, PDF
Dimensions (W x D x H) 185 mm x 415 mm x 360 mm (7 9/32" x 16 11/32" x 14 3/16") Format* 3 Grayscale/full Color: TIFF, JPEG, PDF
(excluding protrusions) Power Source AC 100-240 V, 1.0-0.6 A, 50-60 Hz
Weight Approx. 10kg (22lb) Power Consumption Maximum: 100 W
PDL Adobe® PostScript ® 3™ (CPSI 3019)* 3, PDF (1.7), PCL/PCL XL Dimensions (W × D × H) 650 mm × 560 mm × 255 mm
(PCL5c 1.38), TIFF (6.0), PPML (25 19/32" × 22 1/16" × 10 1/32")
Applicable Protocol TCP/IP, HTTP, HTTPS (SSL), DHCP, ftp*4, NetBIOS*5, AppleTalk, Required Space with Printer (W × D × H) 1,225 mm × 1,345 mm × 1,615 mm
lpr, IPP, Port 9100 (RAW port), IPv4, IPv6, Ipsec (with cover and tray extended) (48 7/32" × 52 31/32" × 63 19/32")
Installed Font PS: 139 fonts (Type 1: 129, TrueType: 19) Weight Approx. 26 kg (57 lb)
PCL: 80 fonts *1 80 gsm (21-lb bond) or less. More than 80 gsm (21-lb bond): Height up to 15 mm (5/8”)
Compatible OS Windows Server® 2003 (32-bit/64-bit)/Windows Server® 2003 R2 *2 80 gsm (21-lb bond) or less. More than 80 gsm (21-lb bond): Height up to 9 mm (3/8”)
(32-bit/64-bit)/Windows Server® 2008 (32-bit/64-bit)/Windows *3 Via the internal host controller
Server® 2008 R2 (64-bit)/Windows® XP (32-bit)/Windows Vista®
(32-bit/64-bit)/Windows® 7 (32-bit/64-bit)/Windows® 8 (32-bit/64-
bit)*6*7/Windows Server® 2012 (64-bit)*6*7
Mac® OS X v10.5/v10.6/v10.7 (Lion)/v10.8*6
Linux (compatible with PPD only)
*1 User available area: Job receiving area, hold, archive, form storage, font installation area
*2 When not printing
*3 Genuine Adobe engine
*4 ftp: hot-folder function
*5 NetBIOS: printing function, hot-folder function
*6 Will soon be compatible
*7 Incompatible with Microsoft ® Windows® RT Specifications are subject to change without notice.
NOTE:
This Machine Specification Sheet is for reference only.
Check with your Marketing Department for the precise specification of the machine to your country.
The specifications are subject to change without notice.
Specifications
Model Wrapping envelope finisher
Compatible Printer ComColor 9150/7150
Type In-line sealed mail making system
Finishing Type Sealed mail making
Size of Envelope Form Envelope Form A 233 mm × 296 mm (approx. 105 gsm)
Envelope Form B 233 mm × 391 mm (approx. 105 gsm)
Insert Paper Paper Size A4 (210 mm × 297 mm), B5 (182 mm × 257 mm)
Paper Type and Weight Standard tray: Plain paper, recycled paper (46 gsm to 120 gsm)
Feed tray: Plain paper, recycled paper (52 gsm to 104 gsm)
Maximum Printable Area Envelope Form A 212 mm × 217 mm
Envelope Form B 212 mm × 311 mm
Paper Tray Capacity Standard Tray Height up to 110 mm
Feed Tray Height up to 50 mm (× 3 trays)
High Capacity Feeder
Height up to 440 mm
(optional)
Mail Stacker Capacity Height up to 310 mm (approx. 110 mails with IJ paper (85 gsm, 1 sheet insert with inner 3 folds)
Number of Insert Pages 46 gsm to 59 gsm: 6 sheets or less
60 gsm to 80 gsm: 5 sheets or less
81 gsm to 100 gsm: 4 sheets or less
101 gsm to 120 gsm: 3 sheets or less
Adhesion Method Mail Short-edge Part Pressure seal
Mail Long-edge Part Water glue
Remoistening Adhesive Water Supply Method Replenish from the water supply tank
Water Supply Tank Capacity 400 ml
Water Tank Capacity
480 ml
Inside Printer
Finished Mail Size Envelope Form A 233 mm × 110 mm
Envelope Form B 233 mm × 158 mm
Processing Speed*1 37 mails/min.
Power Source AC 100-240 V, 3.0-1.5 A, 50-60 Hz
Power Consumption Maximum: 250 W
Operating Noise*2 Max. 68 dB
Operating Environment Temperature: 15°C to 30°C
Humidity: 40% to 70% RH (non-condensing)
Dimensions (W × D × H) 990 mm × 710 mm × 940 mm
Required Space with Printer (W × D × H) 2,255 mm × 1,280 mm × 1,030 mm
Weight Approx. 161 kg
Specifications are subject to change without notice.
*1 For ComColor 9150: When inserting one page for A4 simplex printing
*2 When connecting the printer and sealing the envelope form with one insert sheet
• Do not leave mails sealed with this unit in a location exposed to direct sunlight for a long term (approximately one month*).
Otherwise sealed mails may be spontaneously opened due to degradation of the sealing adhesive.
* The period of time varies depending on the envelope form.
• Please use caution when printing and inserting confidential information with this unit. RISO is not liable for opened mails,
due to degradation of the sealing adhesive.
• Send out sealed mails promptly or store them in a dark place.
NOTE:
This Machine Specification Sheet is for reference only.
Check with your Marketing Department for the precise specification of the machine to your country.
The specifications are subject to change without notice.
Perfect Binder
Specifications
Model Perfect binder
Compatible Printer ComColor 9150/9110/7150/7110
Finishing Type Side-binding
Warm-up Time 13 min. or less (at room temperature of 23°C (68°F))
Binding Speed*1 ComColor 9150/9110: 60 books/hour, ComColor 7150/7110: 48 books/hour
Paper Size Body Page A4/B5/A5/Letter long-edge feed
Cover Sheet*4 (when A5: 210 mm × 307-342 mm (8 1/4" × 12 3/32"-13 15/32")
cutting off the surplus B5: 257 mm × 374-409 mm (10 1/8" × 14 23/32"-16 3/32")
part) A4: 297 mm × 430-465 mm (11 11/16" × 16 15/16"-18 5/16")
Letter: 279.4 mm × 441.8-476.8 mm (11" × 17 13/32"-18 25/32")
Cover Sheet*4 (when A5: 210 mm × 298.5-342 mm (8 1/4" × 11 3/4"-13 15/32”)
leaving the surplus B5: 257 mm × 365.5-409 mm (10 1/8" × 14 3/8"-16 3/32")
part) A4: 297 mm × 421.5-465 mm (11 11/16" × 16 19/32"-18 5/16")
Letter: 279.4 mm × 433.3-476.8 mm (11" × 17 2/32”-18 25/32")
Paper Weight Standard Tray Body page: plain paper, recycled paper; 52 gsm to 128 gsm (14-lb bond to 34-lb bond)
(for A5 long-edge feed, 64 gsm to 128 gsm (17-lb bond to 34-lb bond))
Cover*5: plain paper, recycled paper; 80 gsm to 210 gsm (21-lb bond to 56-lb bond)
Feed Tray Body page: plain paper, recycled paper; 52 gsm to 104 gsm (14-lb bond to 28-lb bond)
Cover*5: plain paper, recycled paper; 80 gsm to 104 gsm (21-lb bond to 28-lb bond)
Body Sheet Stacker Plain paper, recycled paper; 52 gsm to 128 gsm (14-lb bond to 34-lb bond)
Cover Sheet Inserter Plain paper, recycled paper; 80 gsm to 210 gsm (21-lb bond to 56-lb bond)
Book Thickness 1.5 mm to 30 mm (1/16" to 1 3/16"), 15-300 sheets
(binding amount of sheets) Binding amount of sheets varies depending on the paper type
Binding Side Long-edge
Binding Margin* 2 Body page: 5 mm (3/16") or more
Cover: Whole back side of spine, 5 mm (3/16") or more
Computer Environment for Supplied Operating System Microsoft ® Windows ® XP (32-bit), Microsoft ® Windows Vista® (32-bit/64-bit), Microsoft ® Windows ® 7 (32-bit/64-bit),
Software Microsoft ® Windows® 8 (32-bit/64-bit)* 6
Memory 1 GB or more
CPU Intel® Pentium® or fully compatible
Clock 1 GHz or more
Hard Disk 200 MB of free space (space enough to operate the OS)
Display 1,024 x 768 or more, High Color or greater resolution
Corresponding File Format* 7 doc, docx Microsoft ® Word 2003, 2007, 2010
xls, xlsx Microsoft ® Excel® 2003, 2007, 2010
ppt, pptx Microsoft ® PowerPoint ® 2003, 2007, 2010
pdf Version 1.3 to 1.7
Power Source AC 220-240 V, 6.0 A, 50-60 Hz
Power Consumption Maximum: 1,500 W
Operating Noise* 3 Max. 70 dB (when binding)
Operating Environment Temperature: 15°C to 30°C (59°F to 86°F); Humidity: 40% to 70% RH (non-condensing)
Dimensions (W × D × H) 1,290 mm × 675 mm × 1,125 mm (50 25/32" × 26 3/8" × 44 9/32")
Required Space with Printer (W × D × H) 2,750 mm × 1,240 mm × 1,125 mm (108 9/32" × 48 13/16" × 44 9/32")
Weight Approx. 220 kg (485 lb)
*1 The speed converted to per hour by outputting five 100-page books (A4) and a simplex cover *3 150 ppm when connecting to the printer, binding A4 long-edge feed
(297 mm × 465 mm (11 11/16" × 18 5/16")), finishing the second to fifth outputs *4 The length of a cover changes depending upon the thickness of the body pages to be bound. Paper with shorter length
*2 • Two-page spread on the body page • Two-page spread on the cover than body pages cannot be used
Body page margin Inside front Cover margin *5 If the thickness of a book (spine) is 20 mm (25/32") or more, use of paper with 105 gsm (28-lb bond) or heavier is
Body page margin Inside back Cover margin
recommended
*6 Will soon be compatible, however will remain incompatible with Microsoft® Windows® RT
*7 The file composed in 64-bit version is not supported
Binding margin
NOTE:
This Machine Specification Sheet is for reference only.
Check with your Marketing Department for the precise specification of the machine to your country.
The specifications are subject to change without notice.
MEMO
2. Structural Overview
3) Registration Section
This section sends sheets (while adjusting the speed and timing) from the external or internal paper feed
section toward the face up paper receiving tray for printing at the BP section.
4) BP Section
This section prints via print heads as the Belt Platen feeds the paper.
7) Switchback Section
In duplex printing, sheets are sent to the switchback section for printing on the other side.
Switchback
section
Registration section
Switchback unit A
Maintenance unit
Circulation pump
Negative pressure ink
tank air valve
Bellows unit
Overflow pan
Paper elevation
Print heads
Face up paper ejection
Maintenance unit
Switchback sensor Upper transfer roller 5 Upper transfer roller 4 Upper transfer roller 3
Flipper
Switchback
Upper transfer roller 2
Switchback roller Upper transfer
Flipper sensor
Upper transfer OUT sensor
Transfer path changeover gate
Upper transfer roller 6 Paper elevation
Re-feed roller
Top edge sensor 2 Print head
Re-feed sensor
Upper transfer roller 1
Registration sensor
Pickup roller Top edge sensor 1 Face up paper ejection
Paper elevation IN sensor
Scraper roller
Maintenance unit
Joint
The path of one color ink is shown as an example.
: Ink path Ink Cartridge
: Air valve/waste ink path
S M
Ink supply valve Joint connection/
(solenoid) disconnection motor
Pressurized Filter
Ink Tank
Air chamber in
common to all colors
of pressurized ink
tank
Heater
Ink bus
Ink bus
Heat Sink
Head Head Head Head Head Head
Bellows elevation
Lower limit sensor mechanism
Ink level detection sensor
Near-full detection
Full detection
Waste ink tank
MEMO
1. Mechanisms
1-1. Basic Structure
The external paper feed section is comprised of the external paper feed unit and paper feed tray unit (including the
elevation mechanism). Paper loaded in the external paper feed tray is fed to sections inside the printer one sheet at
a time.
Elevator motor
Paper guides
Elevation mechanism
• The upper limit position is detected by the upper limit sensor, attached to the frame, by means of a shield plate
on the external paper feed unit, which is raised by the paper feed tray. (This is based on the upper limit sensor
and shield plate selected by paper setting.)
• The lower limit position is detected by the lower limit sensor by means of a shield plate built into the elevation
mechanism.
• The paper feed tray detects activation and deactivation of the upper limit sensor as paper is transferred and
maintains paper feed pressure as it rises to the specified position.
• If the paper feed tray detects that there is no more paper, it lowers to the lower limit position.
• The paper feed tray can be raised or lowered by means of the paper feed tray elevation switch. However, it can
only be raised when at the lower limit position and when there is paper.
• The paper feed tray stops moving immediately and completely if the lower limit frame on the bottom of the tray is
pressed and the unit detects that the safety switch was activated.
Scraper roller
Pickup roller
Elevator motor
When the paper feed tray is raised, the elevator motor lifts the tray and stops at the upper limit position (when
the upper limit sensor is activated). The criteria determining the upper limit position vary depending on upper limit
sensors A and B and software settings. (These depend on paper settings on the control panel.) Additionally, upper
limit sensors A and B are related as follows.
HIGH
Card stock: The timing when the Upper limit sensor A detection status changes from ON to OFF.
Tray Height
Standard: The timing when the Upper limit sensor B detection status changes from OFF to ON.
Thin Paper: The timing when the Upper limit sensor A detection status changes from OFF to ON.
LOW
ON
Light blocked
Upper limit sensor B
OFF
Light received
During printing after the paper feed tray is raised, paper is fed one sheet at a time by the paper feed rollers, and the
paper feed tray is repeatedly raised to maintain the same upper limit position. This operation to maintain the upper
limit position is performed during printing. When there is no more paper in the paper feed tray, the external paper
feed tray automatically lowers to the lower limit position.
Elevator motor
3. Elevator Switch
• Used to raise or lower the paper feed tray manually.
→ When in the lower limit position
Pressing the switch once raises the elevator to the upper limit position and positions it. Pressing the switch again as
the elevator is rising stops the elevator.
→ When the tray is in positions other than the lower limit position
Holding the switch lowers the elevator. The elevator stops when the lower limit position is reached or when the
switch is released.
Paper
Pickup roller
Stripper plate
External paper
feed unit
Vertical
paper Top edge sensor 1
feed unit Paper length calculated from the timing
between activation and deactivation
Although the paper size is detected when paper is loaded in the paper feed tray or the other tray, if the paper length
detection sensor is triggered by incorrectly set feed tray paper guides or objects other than paper placed in the
paper feed tray, the system misinterprets this, treating it as if the paper is larger than the paper actually loaded.
Because printing at that wrong paper size occurs if paper is transferred after incorrect detection, the belt may
become soiled.
For this reason, the paper length is also detected in the paper transfer system. In the paper transfer system, paper
length is detected by the timing of activation and deactivation of top edge sensor 1. If different sizes are detected
in the system and the paper transfer section and the difference exceeds a particular range, the speed is controlled
based on the paper size detected in the paper transfer section.
Shield plate
(adjustable)
Paper volume
detection sensor
Concave (not adjustable)
A
Paper feed tray
B
Paper detection sensor
Reflective (not adjustable)
As paper is transferred, first the registration sensor is activated and then top edge sensor 1 is activated.
Multiple paper feed detection is not performed until the leading edge travels 5 mm after top edge sensor 1 is
activated. After the paper moves 5 mm, sampling begins in top edge sensor 1.
Note:Because top edge sensor 1 works on a principle of light transmission, sampling is not performed until the
paper moves 5 mm so that the optical axis of the sensor is completely covered.
Before registration section paper feeding Registration motor and external paper feed motor ON
(1) (Paper is buckled)
(2) (Noise reduction assistance started)
ON
1. Registration motor
OFF
OUT
2. External paper ON
feed motor Noise reduction assistance in progress
OFF
50 ms
Motor deactivated 50 ms after assistance starts
Notes
Start Finish
Operation started Operation finished
2. Disassembly
2-1. Elevator Motor
1. Turn OFF the machine power and disconnect the power cable from the power source.
2. Lower the paper feed tray to the lower limit and turn the unit OFF.
3. Remove the center inner cover. (Refer to Chapter 2.)
4. Remove the left inner cover. (Refer to Chapter 2.)
5. Remove the ground wire. (IT 3x6 (1 pc))
6. Remove the reuse band.
7. Remove the connector. (1 pc)
8. Remove the elevator springs (front and rear).
9. Remove the elevator motor assembly. (IT 4x8 (1 pc) and 6 mm dia. E-ring (1 pc))
10. Remove the elevator motor cover. (W sems screw 3x6 (1 pc))
11. Remove the motor cover. (W sems screw 3x5 (4 pcs))
12. Remove the elevator motor collar.
13. Remove the spur gear m1x24.
14. Remove the spur gears m0.8x29+m1x14.
15. Remove the spur gears m0.8x23+m0.8x14.
16. Remove the spur gears m0.8x30+m0.8x14.
17. Remove the elevator motor collar.
18. Remove the elevator motor. (W sems screw 3x5 (2 pcs))
Note: After replacement, check operation in test modes 1423 (move to paper feed tray upper limit
position) and 1424 (move to paper feed tray lower limit position).
Elevator spring
Ground wire
Connector
Reuse band
Elevator motor
Hinge cover
Paper guides
Paper feed tray paper length detection sensor Paper feed tray paper width potentiometer
Tensioner
Tension spring
< Belt tension loosened > < Belt tension tightened >
13. Remove the lower limit frame holder. (IT 3x6 (1 pc))
14. Remove the lower limit frame.
15. Remove the elevator guides (front and rear). (Binding screw 4x8 (2 pcs for each))
Pick-Up Roller
Clip
Scraper Roller
Clip
19. Remove the external paper feed unit. (IT3C screw 4x8 (4 pcs))
Lower safety switch spring Paper feed tray lower safety switch
Stripper plate
MEMO
3. Adjustment
3-1. Upper Limit Position Adjustment
(1) Standard Adjustment (Perform mainly if the upper limit position has changed due to wear of the scraper roller)
Insert a Phillips screwdriver in the adjustment hole on the paper feed cover to adjust the position.
Turn clockwise to lower the upper limit position.
Turn counter-clockwise to raise the upper limit position.
In either case, one rotation adjusts the position by approximately 0.5 mm. (Not accounting for backlash from
turning back in the opposite direction.)
Phillips screwdriver
(2) Custom Adjustment (Perform mainly to support special user paper, by adjusting the sensor shield plate (sensor
actuator plate) for the Card and Custom paper.
Remove the scraper sub unit. On top, loosen the screw of the shield plate for the Card and Custom paper upper
limit to adjust the sensor shield position (the right hand side shield plate, which works in pairs with the Upper
limit sensor A).
Since the upper limit position adjustment is done based on the Standard paper (Sensor B) position, this
adjustment changes the Card and Custom paper upper limit position in relation to the Standard paper upper limit
position.
Move the shield plate toward the pickup roller to lower the upper limit position.
Move the shield plate toward the scraper roller to raise the upper limit position.
(Moving the shield plate 1.0 mm changes the upper limit position by approximately 0.4 mm.)
Shield plate
3-3. Adjusting the External Paper Feed Amount (paper buckle amount before Registration Roller)
By changing the External paper feed motor OFF timing, the paper buckle amount in front of the Registration roller
can be adjusted. The motor turning OFF too early will cause paper not to feed into the 2nd paper feed area. The
motor turning too late will make too much large of a buckle and cause the paper to bend or fold.
The motor OFF timing can be adjusted by the test mode setting.
The test mode number differs according the paper type.
• Test Mode No. 7701 (Normal paper)
• Test Mode No. 7747 (Card stock)
• Test Mode No. 7793 (Thin paper)
• Test Mode No. 7839 (Post card)
• Test Mode No. 7885 (Envelope)
Contents
1. Mechanisms........................................................................................ 5-2
1-1. Basic Structure .......................................................................... 5-2
1-2. Internal Paper Feed Action ....................................................... 5-3
1-3. Paper Feed Tray Unit................................................................. 5-3
1-4. Internal Paper Feed Unit............................................................ 5-4
1-5. Paper Volume Detection Mechanism......................................... 5-5
1-6. Paper Size Detection Mechanism.............................................. 5-6
1-7. Assist Action............................................................................... 5-7
1-8. Paper Transfer Action................................................................ 5-8
2. Disassembly................................................................................ 5-15
2-1. Internal Paper Feed Unit (Tray 1)............................................ 5-15
2-2. Internal Paper Feed Unit (Tray 2)............................................ 5-17
2-3. Internal Paper Feed Unit (Tray 3)............................................ 5-18
2-4. Internal Paper Feed Motor....................................................... 5-19
2-5. Internal Paper Feed Clutches 1, 2 and 3................................. 5-20
2-6. Upper Limit Sensors of Trays 1, 2 and/or 3............................. 5-20
2-7. Paper Detection Sensors of Trays 1 to 3 (3 Sets).................... 5-21
2-8. Stripper Plates 1, 2 or 3........................................................... 5-21
2-9. Internal Paper Feed Rollers 1, 2
and/or 3. (Scraper and Pickup Rollers)........ 5-22
2-10. Elevator Motors for Trays 1, 2 and 3...................................... 5-23
2-11. Set Interlock Switch for Trays 1, 2 and 3............................... 5-24
2-12. Paper Volume Detection Sensor for Trays 1, 2 and 3............ 5-24
3. Adjustment....................................................................................... 5-27
3-1. Stripper Plate Angle Adjustment.............................................. 5-27
3-2. Internal Paper Feed Upper Limit Position Adjustment............. 5-27
3-3. Internal Paper Feed Tray - End Fence
& Slider (Sensor Actuator) Position Adjustment.......... 5-28
1. Mechanisms
1-1. Basic Structure
The internal paper feed section is a unit that transfers paper from the internal paper feed tray unit to vertical paper
feed unit B. It is comprised of the internal paper feed unit and internal paper feed tray unit, and in back, components
including the tray elevator motors (1–3), internal paper feed clutches (1–3), and internal paper feed motor.
The tray structure is (from the top down) tray 1, tray 2, and tray 3. Tray set interlock switches, paper volume
detection sensors, paper size detection sensors (4 each), and a tray elevator in the back of the unit are provided for
each tray. Additionally, the internal paper feed unit incorporates a paper detection sensor and upper limit sensor.
Role of Each Sensor
1. Safety Switch for Trays 1–3
Activation of the safety switch for trays 1–3 determines the presence of trays.
2. Upper Limit Sensor
Activation of the upper limit sensor determines whether the top of the paper is at the upper limit position.
3. Tray Paper Detection Sensor
Activation of the tray paper detection sensor determines whether there is paper in the tray.
4. Paper Volume Detection Sensor
Data from trays in the upper limit position determines how much paper is left. Because trays are equipped with a
single level sensor, determination of the remaining level occurs when they are more or less than 50% full of
paper.
5. Paper Size Detection Sensor (4)
The pattern formed by four Interrupt type sensors enables detection of the paper size. These sensors work on a
principle of the shield plate sliding from the end paper guide on a structure incorporating links and gears.
Rear
Internal paper feed tray unit
Internal paper feed unit
Front
• Paper is easy to remove when a tray is pulled out because the stripper plate and pickup roller are separated.
• The end paper guide can be smoothly adjusted to match the length of paper.
• Action of Elevator Motor
The following actions are performed by the elevator motor, which moves the tray bottom plate.
An ON tray set signal (indicating that a tray has been loaded) activates rising by the elevator motor
After this, activation of the upper limit sensor causes the elevator to be lowered once for positioning,
and when the upper limit sensor goes OFF, the elevator rises again and stops. If the upper limit sensor
goes OFF during printing, the elevator is raised.
Size detection
sector gear
Size detection
intermediate gear
Tray rail
Stripper plate
Stripper holder
Tray
Level sensor
Shield
plate
OFF OFF ON
Shield plate
Joint
Trays 1–3
Paper size detection
sensors (4)
Sensor 4
Top edge sensor 1
Sensor 3
Sensor 2
External paper
Sensor 1 feed unit
Paper
Vertical
paper Top edge sensor 1
Paper length calculated from the timing
feed unit between activation and deactivation
Tray
Direction of tray removal
Although the paper size is detected when paper is loaded in the internal paper feed tray, if the paper length
detection sensor is triggered by incorrectly set feed tray paper guides or objects other than paper placed in the
paper feed tray, the system misinterprets this, treating it as if the paper is larger than the paper actually loaded.
Because printing at that wrong paper size occurs if paper is transferred after incorrect detection, the belt may
become soiled.
For this reason, the paper length is also detected in the paper transfer system. In the paper transfer system, paper
length is detected by the timing of activation and deactivation of top edge sensor 1. If different sizes are detected
in the system and the paper transfer section and the difference exceeds a particular range, the speed is controlled
based on the paper size detected in the paper transfer section.
FF
Millimeters Inches 4 3 2 1
Type of paper Length Type of paper Length
B5R 182
A4R 210 Letter R 216 (215.9)
B5 257
Foolscape 340
B4 364 Legal (14) 365 (355.6)
etection pattern
ensor layo t
Rear 4 3 2 1 Front
Tray 2
Tray 3
(Internal paper feed clutch 1 ON) (30 ms after internal paper feed clutch 1 ON)
Paper
Tray 1 Tray 1
Tray 2 Tray 2
Tray 3 Tray 3
eing transferred
(4)
Internal paper feed clutch 1 OFF
(3) Internal paper feed clutch 1 OFF
(Vertical paper feed sensor 5 ON) (Simultaneously vertical paper feed sensor 4
ON, then after 50 ms vertical paper feed roller 5
activated)
Tray 1 Tray 1
Tray 2
Tray 2
Tray 3 Tray 3
Name Timing
ON
1. Vertical paper feed sensor 4
OFF
2. "Not arrived" "Still present" error
error
3.
4.
IN
5.
6.
7.
8.
ON
1. Internal paper feed motor
OFF
ON
2. Internal paper feed clutch 1
OFF
30 ms
3. Vertical paper feed clutch 1 ON
OFF
OUT
ON
4. External paper feed motor 50 ms
OFF Further details omitted
5. Assistance
6.
Start Finish
Transfer started Transfer ended
ra 3
ra 1 ra 1
Paper
ra 2 ra 2
ra 3 ra 3
eing transferred
(4) Vertical paper feed clutch 1 ON (3) Internal paper feed clutch 2 OFF
(21 ms after vertical paper feed sensor 2 ON) (Vertical paper feed sensor 2 ON)
ra 1 ra 1
ra 2 ra 2
ra 3 ra 3
(5) Vertical paper feed clutch 2 OFF ( ) Vertical paper feed clutch 1 OFF
( imultaneousl vertical paper feed sensor 3 ON (Vertical paper feed sensor 5 ON)
then after 1 ms vertical paper feed roller 5 activated)
ra 1 ra 1
ra 2 ra 2
ra 3 ra 3
Name Timing
1. Vertical paper feed ON "Not arrived" error
sensor 2 "Still present" error
OFF
2. Vertical paper feed ON
sensor 3 OFF
"Not arrived" error "Still present" error
3.
4.
IN
5.
6.
7.
8.
ON
1. Internal paper feed motor
OFF
ON
2. Internal paper feed clutch 2
OFF
ON
3. Vertical paper feed clutch 2
OFF
ON 30 ms 21 ms
OUT
6. Assistance
Start Finish
Transfer started Transfer ended
ra 1
Vertical paper feed sensor 1
ra 2
Vertical paper feed clutch 2
Internal paper feed clutch 3
Paper feed roller 3
Vertical paper feed roller 1 ra 3
ra 1 ra 1
ra 2 ra 2
Paper
ra 3 ra 3
eing transferred
(4) Vertical paper feed clutch 1 ON (3) Internal paper feed clutch 3 OFF
(124 ms after vertical paper feed sensor 1 ON) (Vertical paper feed sensor 1 ON)
ra 1 ra 1
ra 2 ra 2
ra 3 ra 3
(5) Vertical paper feed clutch 2 OFF ( ) Vertical paper feed clutch 1 OFF
( imultaneousl vertical paper feed sensor 3 ON (Vertical paper feed sensor 5 ON)
then after 1 ms vertical paper feed roller 5 activated)
ra 1 ra 1
ra 2 ra 2
ra 3 ra 3
Name Timing
ON "Not arrived" error
1. Vertical paper feed sensor 1 "Still present" error
OFF
ON "Not arrived" error
2. Vertical paper feed sensor 3
OFF
4.
IN
5.
6.
7.
ON
1. Internal paper feed motor
OFF
ON
2. Internal paper feed clutch 3
OFF
ON
3. Vertical paper feed clutch 2
OFF
OUT
ON 50 ms 124 ms
4. Vertical paper feed clutch 1
OFF
ON 61 ms
5. External paper feed motor OFF Further details omitted
Assistance
Start Finish
Transfer started Transfer ended
Explanation: Clutch deactivation alone may be executed if processing for the second sheet is executed after
completion of processing for the first, but clutch activation may not be executed, and if activation
does not occur, it may cause jams.
MEMO
2. Disassembly
Slide the Gear and Gear-Pulley maximum out to allow the metal bushing to come off.
15. Remove the mounting screw of the internal paper feed unit (tray 1) in back. (IT3C screw 4x8 (1 pc))
Mounting screw of
the Internal paper
feed unit (Tray 1).
Mounting screw of
the Internal paper
feed unit (Tray 2).
Mounting screw of
the Internal paper
feed unit (Tray 3).
16. Remove the mounting bracket of the internal paper feed unit (tray 1) in front. (IT3C screw 4x8 (3 pcs))
17. Disconnect the wire connector from the machine frame on the back of the unit . (1 pc)
<Do not forget to re-plug the wire connector in assembly.>
18. Remove the scraper spring.
Wire connector to be unplugged.
19. Remove the internal paper feed unit (tray 1) from above, in front.
Note:
1. Tighten one fixing screw of the Internal Paper Feed Tray on the rear side, two frame bracket screws of the
bracket plate, one screw of the Internal Paper Feed Unit bracket plate.
2. After completing the above procedures, remove papers on the Transport Belt.
3. When putting the parts back, don’t forget to plug the connector of the Internal Paper Feed Unit.
Tray Rail Guide (Left) removed and the Rail mounting screw visible.
9. Remove the Tray rail of tray 1 (left side). (IT3C screw 3x8;1 pc front and IT3C screw 4x8;1 pc rear)
10. Disconnect the wire connector and remove internal paper feed clutch 2. (5 mm dia. E-ring)
11. Slide the gear and gear-pulley out of the way (1 pc each). (6 mm dia. E-ring (1 pc each))
12. Remove the metal bushing. (6 mm dia. E-ring)
13. Remove the mounting screw of the internal paper feed unit (tray 2) in back. (IT3C screw 4x8 (1 pc))
14. Remove the mounting bracket of the internal paper feed unit (tray 2) in front. (IT3C screw 4x8 (3 pcs))
Note: Use a 5.5 mm wrench.
15. Disconnect the wire connector from the machine frame on the back of the unit . (1 pc)
<Do not forget to re-plug the wire connector in assembly.>
16. Remove the internal paper feed unit (tray 2) from the top, in front.
Note:
1. Tighten one fixing screw of the Internal Paper Feed Tray on the rear side, two frame bracket screws of the
bracket plate, one screw of the Internal Paper Feed Unit bracket plate.
2. When putting the parts back, don’t forget to plug the connector of the Internal Paper Feed Unit.
Tray Rail Guide (Left) removed and the Rail mounting screw visible.
Tray Rail left (TRAY 3)
Note: Refer to the following figure for the timing belt path.
Stripper Plate
2-9. Internal Paper Feed Rollers 1, 2 and/or 3. (Scraper and Pickup Rollers)
1. Turn OFF the machine power and disconnect the power cable from the power source.
2. Pull out and remove all three Internal Paper Feed Trays from the machine.
3. Remove the Scraper and Pickup rollers from the appropriate Internal paper feed unit. (1 plastic clip per roller.)
Note: Both rollers contain one-way bearing. Make sure to mount the rollers facing in the correct direction.
The side with the one-way The side with only the plastic
bearing faces towards the core faces the rear of the
front of the machine (faces machine. (This side goes into
towards the Plastic clip). the shaft first.)
Plastic clip
Scraper roller
Pickup roller
Stripper plate
Stripper holder
FRONT View
REAR View
FRONT View
REAR View
FRONT View
Paper volume
detection sensor
REAR View
MEMO
3. Adjustment
3-3. Internal Paper Feed Tray - End Fence & Slider (Sensor Actuator) Position Adjustment
The paper size in the internal paper feed trays are detected by the position of the end fence in the tray.
If the position between the end fence and the slider is incorrect, the machine cannot detect the correct paper size in
the tray.
When in need, follow the steps below to make the adjustment.
1) Remove the internal paper feed tray from the machine.
2) Set A4 size paper (Length = 297 mm paper) in the paper feed tray and slide the end fence against the paper.
If A4 size paper is not available, use a scale and set the end fence at 297 mm position.
End fence
( 297 mm )
A4 size paper
3) Turn over the internal feed tray up-side-down, and remove the size detection device cover plate.
Size detection
SCREW device cover plate
SCREW
SCREW
SCREW
5) Slide the Slider to match the 3 mm diameter positioning hole on the Slider against the 3 mm diameter hole on
the Tray.
Slider
6) While the two 3 mm hole are aligned, put back the previously removed Flat Gear; m1x36x4.
7) Put back the size detection device cover plate to complete the adjustment.
MEMO
Contents
1. Mechanisms........................................................................................ 6-2
2. Disassembly..................................................................................... 6-11
3. Adjustment....................................................................................... 6-26
3-1. Adjustment to Make the Registration Roller and BP Unit Parallel.................. 6-26
3-2. CIS Adjustment............................................................................................... 6-26
3-3. Sensor Sensitivity Adjustment........................................................................ 6-30
1. Mechanisms
1-1. Basic Structure
The registration section transfers paper into the printing area from the internal or external paper feed unit or
switchback unit. This section is comprised of vertical paper feed units B and A, the registration roller unit, and the
paper position detection unit.
Registration roller unit
Paper position detection unit
Registration sensor
(receive) Registration roller
Registration rollers
Registration sensor Registration Section: Roller and Sensor Layout
Stripper section
Tray 1
Vertical paper feed roller 1
Vertical paper feed sensor 1
Tray 2
Stripper section
Tray 3
Stripper section
Positioning pins
Points of attachment
Positioning pins
(Inserted in unit rear plate)
Points of attachment
(Affixed to unit front plate with screws)
Fulcrum
(Appearance when closed) (Appearance when open)
Progression of paper
Assist control by the vertical paper feed section (paper feeding from the internal paper feed tray) serves the
following two purposes.
1. To control slippage during paper transfer by the registration roller section, caused by back tension created by
stripper pressure from the stripper section and resistance in the paper path.
2. To reduce noise created by flattening paper that has buckled as it is fed in the registration section.
Unlike paper feeding from the external paper feed section, paper feeding from the internal paper feed tray may
generate significant back tension from stripper pressure in the stripper section and resistance in the paper path.
This is due to differences in the layout of the paper path and feed rollers. The back tension may cause slippage
when paper is transferred by the registration rollers.
Controlling back tension is one purpose of assist control by the vertical paper feed section, in which back tension
from the vertical paper feed section is counteracted by running the external paper feed motor in reverse to drive
vertical paper feed roller 5.
In conjunction with action by the registration rollers, vertical paper feed roller 5 is also operated for assist control.
Assist control, which occurs until the trailing edge of sheets leave the vertical paper feed sensor 5, can counteract
the effect of back tension occurring in the stripper section or other areas.
Assist control is activated in sync with the activation of the registration motor, and the external paper feed motor
stops when vertical paper feed sensor 5 is deactivated.
Note: By the default setting, the noise reduction is performed in external paper feeding, internal paper feeding, and
re-feeding (duplex printing).
Registration rollers
Tray 1
Tray 2
Being transferred
Tray 1 Tray 1
Tray 2 Tray 2
Registration
roller assembly
SS roller assembly
Registration sensor
Transfer belt
Gate gap
Adjustment arm Top edge sensor 2
(reflective)
CIS
Detection gate
Registration rollers
Transfer belt rollers Transfer belt
Suction fan
Transfer stopped
(3) (Belt platen stopped)
*1: Because a reflective sensor is used in top edge sensor 2, the following conditions may cause detection
problems.
1. Using preprinted paper that has a printed border.
2. Using colored paper.
3. Using paper with low reflectivity.
4. Duplex printing, in combination with conditions from 1 to 3 of above.
CIS
2. Disassembly
2-1. Vertical Paper Feed Unit A
1. Turn OFF the machine power and disconnect the power cable from the power source.
2. Remove the center inner cover. (Refer to Chapter 2.)
3. Remove the left inner cover. (Refer to Chapter 2.)
4. Remove the rear cover center assembly. (Refer to Chapter 2.)
5. Put the power supply unit in maintenance position. (Pan-head screw 4x8 (2 pcs))
6. Remove the belt.
Timing belt
Reuse band
2. Attache the vertical paper feed unit A to the printer. (IT3C 4x8 (2 pcs))
3. Attach the vertical paper feed A driven Assy. (W sems 3x6 (1pcs))
Pulley
Vertical paper feed roller 4 Pulley
Pulley
Vertical paper feed roller 3
2-13. Internal Feed Paper Jam Door Interlock Switch (Vertical Paper Feed Unit B)
1. Turn OFF the machine power and disconnect the power cable from the power source.
2. Remove the external paper feed unit. (Refer to Chapter 4.)
3. Remove vertical paper feed unit B. (Refer to the instructions for removal.)
4. Remove the safety switch spring.
5. Remove the entire switch mounting plate. (3 mm dia. E-ring (1 pc))
6. Remove the internal feed paper jam door interlock switch. (Sems screw 3x14 (2 pc))
Wire connector
Vertical paper feed clutch holder
Registration motor
Engine control PCB
Registration motor
Tensioner
Registration roller
Guide roller
Registration roller
Guide roller
Registration motor
7 mm Wrench
REMOVE
Watch for
DO NOT REMOVE the Collar.
Remove the Screw
BEARING to be removed
E-Ring
E-Ring
< REAR View >
< FRONT View >
Guide roller assembly
Connector
Paper Width Detection Sensor (FRONT) Paper Width Detection Sensor (REAR)
MEMO
3. Adjustment
3-1. Adjustment to Make the Registration Roller and BP Unit Parallel
<Adjustment Overview>
Adjust the alignment of the registration roller after replacing the registration roller or registration roller unit.
<Adjustment Instructions>
Refer to Chapter 11, Section 3, "Adjustment: Adjusting the Registration Roller."
<Adjustment Instructions>
1. Adjustment Procedure
1) Execute test mode 2407 (move the BP elevation motor to the lower limit position).
2) Open the right front cover.
3) Place a piece of paper on top of the BP Unit in the machine with the corner of the paper set at the position
shown on the photograph.
<< When adjusting the two CIS at one time.>>
Loading Position 1: < When adjusting both CIS units at the same time.>
Place a piece of paper cut to the length shown below (approx. 360 mm) on top of the BP Unit in the machine
with the corner of the paper set at the position shown on the photograph below.
A3 or Ledger size paper
cut to the length of 360
mm and laid sideways
Approx. 360 mm
REAR
297 mm
A4 size paper
70 mm
FRONT
REAR
A4 size paper
FRONT
CAUTION:
Confirm that the BP registration pin
hole is not covered by the paper.
FRONT
5) Execute the following CIS shading compensation test modes, depending on the paper loading position.
Loading Position 1: Test Mode 2461 (shading compensation for the left and right CIS at same time)
Loading Position 2: Test Mode 2462 (shading compensation for the left CIS only)
Loading Position 3: Test Mode 2463 (shading compensation for the right CIS only)
Note: Execute only the Test Mode 2462 <Loading Position 2 > for machines with only the left CIS,
such as ComColor models 9110, 7110 and 3110.
1. This process ends with an error if the CIS reference voltage was not read correctly. (See Note 1 on
next page.)
• W58-0225-1: Incorrect reference voltage for the left CIS
• W58-0225-2: Incorrect reference voltage for the right CIS
• W58-0225-3: Incorrect reference voltage for the left and right CIS
2. This process ends with an error if the unit determines that paper was not loaded in the specified position.
(See Note 1 on next page.)
• W58-0226-1: Reference paper loading error for shading compensation of the left CIS
• W58-0226-2: Reference paper loading error for shading compensation of the right CIS
• W58-0226-3: Reference paper loading error for shading compensation of the left and right CIS
• W58-0226-4: No reference paper loaded for CIS shading compensation
3. This process ends with an error if shading compensation not executed correctly. (See Note 1 on next
page.)
• W58-0227-1: Shading compensation error for the left CIS
• W58-0227-2: Shading compensation error for the right CIS
• W58-0227-3: Shading compensation error for the left and right CIS
8) If you have executed shading compensation for the left and right CIS, go to step 2, "Confirmation
Procedure."
If you have only adjusted one side, return to step 1 and adjust the other CIS.
2. Confirmation Procedure
1) Load a sheet of lightweight Riso paper on the transfer belt. (Load an A4 sheet in portrait orientation, where
it can be detected by the CIS.)
Note:
• Load the sheet centered relative to the width of the transfer belt.
• Load the sheet parallel relative to the transfer direction of the transfer belt.
(Use the suction holes of the transfer belt for reference.)
7) Execute the following test modes and check the value of each.
1. Execute test mode 1609 (left CIS paper level detection results).
2. Execute test mode 1610 (right CIS paper level detection results).
Note: No need to execute Test Mode No.1610 for machines without the right CIS.
Description: Indicates the paper level (as a percentage, with the reference paper level as 100%) when
test mode 2464 (checking CIS action) was executed.
Criteria: Acceptable if in the range 95–105%.
3. Execute test mode 1611 (left CIS belt level detection results).
4. Execute test mode 1612 (right CIS belt level detection results).
Note: No need to execute Test Mode 1612 for machines without the right CIS.
Description: Indicates the belt level (as a percentage, with the reference belt level as 100%) when
test mode 2464 (checking CIS action) was executed.
Criteria: Acceptable if 25% or less.
10) When all items are acceptable, execute test mode 1497 (save adjustment values).
This backs up the settings values, which can be accessed by executing test mode 0503 (factory defaults).
Note 1: Adjustment ends with an error in the case of errors W58-0225 to 0227 and default settings are restored
(reference paper level: 0, threshold: 0, offset value: 128 (0 mV), black and white adjustment data: All 0).
In this case, CIS-based masking (edge detection) is not performed.
Note 2: Confirmation ends with an error in the case of errors W58-0225 and W59-0228, but the default settings
as described in note 1 are not restored.
<Adjustment Instructions>
1) Place either A3 (Ledger) or A4 (Letter) size clean white paper of which the customer normally uses, on the
external paper feed tray.
2) Press the tray elevation button or execute test mode No.1423 to raise the external paper feed tray to the
upper limit position.
3) Execute test mode No.1498 to automatically feed the paper to the two sensors.
4) Execute test mode No.1494 to automatically adjust the sensitivity of the two sensors.
Note: The two sensors, Registration sensor and Top edge sensor 1, are both adjusted at the same time.
5) Remove the paper from the machine.
Transfer belt
Paper
<Adjustment Instructions>
Drive roller
Driven roller
MEMO
Chapter 7. BP Section
Contents
1. Mechanisms........................................................................................ 7-2
2. Disassembly..................................................................................... 7-11
3. Adjustment....................................................................................... 7-21
1. Mechanisms
1. Paper received from the registration rollers is transferred and conveyed to the paper elevation unit or optional
face up paper ejection unit.
2. The BP section supports transfer of maintenance unit and is raised and lowered along with the maintenance
unit.
3. Coming into contact with the head holder contact pins maintains adequate distance and parallelism between
the heads and the paper transfer surface and parallelism between the drive and driven roller shafts.
4. If paper jams occur, the BP unit will be lowered.
5. While the transfer belt is being driven, the belt HP sensor detects the belt position once per revolution to adjust
ink ejection timing.
Wires (4 pieces)
Belt HP sensor
Encoder Part touching head holder
Positioning pin
registration hole
Maintenance unit
Face up paper
ejection flipper
Gap adjuster
BP Elevation motor
1. The BP unit is raised or lowered by means of four wires suspended from the head holder. (See Figure 5.)
2. The wires are held by wire hooks incorporated in the BP unit, which hold the wires with anchors (balls). (See
Figure 6.)
3. There are five stopping positions: a position for standard paper, for heavyweight paper, for envelopes 1 and 2,
and for clearing paper jams (when the maintenance unit is moved). Two sensors detect the stopping position of
the belt platen, one each at the upper limit and one at the lower limit. (See Figure 7.)
4. For the paper position, stopping after raising or lowering is controlled by a pulse when the upper limit sensor is
activated. For the position to clear paper jams, movement stops when the lower limit sensor is activated. Note
that the BP unit moves along the elevation guide in back. (See Figure 8.)
5. Regarding the lower limit position, because the maintenance unit moves on top of the BP unit, this position is
kept constant. However, regarding the maintenance position, because the head holder is positioned relative
to the maintenance unit, the BP unit can be moved forward or back. Additionally, regarding the upper limit
position, because the BP unit can be positioned by means of registration with pins protruding from the head
holder (which provide reference points), it can be moved forward or back as well as the direction of paper
supply and ejection.
6. During printing, a specific clearance (head gap) is maintained between the top surface of the belt and the
surface of the head nozzles. In the event of paper transfer problems, the belt platen is lowered, enabling the
paper to be removed.
7. For head maintenance as well, the BP unit can be raised.
8. During paper jams, the maintenance unit does not go under the head.
Wire hook
Wire
Figure 6
Wires (4 pieces)
Wire hooks
(4 positions)
Figure 5
+ =
BP upper limit sensor
BP unit
Elevation guide
Figure 7 Figure 8
Tension spring
Drive roller
Paper
Suction fan
Adjusting screw
Drive roller
Parts to
adjust Transfer belt
Front motor Figure 4
Figure 3
1. To keep the head and the surface of the belt platen for paper transfer in the same position and parallel to each
other, the BP plate assembly touches the contact pins protruding from the head holder side. (See Figure 9.)
This action also keeps the driven and drive rollers parallel.
2. At this time, because the contact pins are arranged so that the wires pass through the center, the BP plate
assembly is sandwiched between the contact pins and wire hooks. (See Figure 10.)
3. Positioning in the direction of paper transfer is determined by the positioning pins protruding from the head
holder being inserted in the reference pin registration hole and the registration hole for position adjustment on
the belt platen side. (See Figure 11.)
4. Adjustment in the direction of paper transfer with the registration roller is done using the head holder pins,
which are inserted in the registration hole for position adjustment. Additionally, the adjustment piece in the
registration hole for position adjustment can be adjusted to move forward or back, and image adjustment (rough
adjustment) in the direction of paper transfer is possible.
BP plate
Wire
Driven roller
Contact pin
(head holder) Wire
Contact pin
(head holder) BP plate
Figure 9 Figure 10
Positioning pin
registration hole
Figure 11
us
di
Ra
Core
Core material
Drive roller
As depicted above, one reason for inconsistency in ink drops is unevenness of the core material inside the belt.
This unevenness causes discrepancy in the distance between the center of the roller and the core material over
a length of belt, and as a result, uneven transfer and inconsistent impact. To reduce this effect, an adjustment value
must be prepared to adjust the timing of ink ejection.
For this reason, the BP unit creates roller profiles and belt profiles, which represent adjustment values for the ink
drop position. These profiles are transmitted to the unit that creates data for storage. Each profile requires
execution of a separate test mode.
BP Section
Envelope 1
Standard Paper
Envelope 2
Card Paper
NO CONDUCTIVITY CONDUCTIVITY
Space Pushed up Contact
Insulating plate Hanging down
(mounted on the BP Unit)
Test Mode
Process Name Description
Number
2170 BP Hit Detection (RL) ON: Contact detected / OFF: Contact not detected
2171 BP Hit Detection (RR) ON: Contact detected / OFF: Contact not detected
2172 BP Hit Detection (FL) ON: Contact detected / OFF: Contact not detected
2173 BP Hit Detection (FR) ON: Contact detected / OFF: Contact not detected
2440 Head Gap STD Paper Position Elevates the BP Unit to the STD paper head gap position.
2441 Head Gap Card Paper Position Elevates the BP Unit to the Card paper head gap position.
2442 Head Gap Envelope-1 Position Elevates the BP Unit to the Envelope-1 head gap position.
2443 Head Gap Envelope-2 Position Elevates the BP Unit to the Envelope-2 head gap position.
NOTE:
Above test modes 2440, 2441, 2442 and 2443 operates only when both the left and right Front Door interlock switches
are activated (Front Doors closed), and the Maintenance Unit (Ink Pan) is in the maintenance position.
BP tension spring
Envelopes
Rotary guide
Card
Gap adjuster
Standard paper
Spring guide
Gap adjuster
Switching position
Standard paper
Card paper Contact tip on
Envelope-1 the Rotary guide
Envelope-2
Gap adjuster
Rotary guide
BP tension spring
Spring guide
Gap adjuster
Spring guide
Rotary guide Place the BP tension spring over the Rotary guide
Rotary guide by matching the marking on the green colored
< Mounted on the machine >
line shown on the sketch on the left. The green
colored line indicates how the Spring guide hook
should be pushed up.
Push the BP tension spring and Spring guide all
the way up against the top of the Rotary guide.
Then fit the Gap adjuster over the Rotary guide.
Gently rotate the Gap adjuster so that it hangs on
the Rotary guide.
Release fingers from the Gap adjuster and let it
hang freely on the Rotary guide.
Then release the fingers from the Spring guide,
which was kept held all the way up on the Rotary
guide. The BP tension spring and Spring guide
will drop inside the Gap adjuster.
Gently push the Gap adjuster all the way up
on the Rotary guide. The Gap adjuster should
rotate as it goes up. If the Gap adjuster does not
rotate as it goes up, the parts are not assembled
There is no Green colored line on correctly.
the actual Rotary guide. Repeat the procedure until correctly assembled.
By making the similar marking
on the Rotary guide will make the
work easier.
Detects loose wires (caused by winding the wires in the reverse, for example).
2. Disassembly
Caution : Do not remove the Front Frame of the BP unit. (The Front Frame is positioned with a Factory jig.)
5. Turn the maintenance unit drive gear in the counter-clockwise direction and slide the maintenance unit to the
retracted position away from the BP unit.
8. Loosen the mounting screws of the elevation guide (IT3C screw 4x8 (4 pcs)), slide the guide upward, and affix
it temporarily by tightening one of the four screws.
Elevation guide
9. Unhook the wires from the wire hooks on the BP Unit (in 4 positions).
10. Unhook the electrical connectors from the BP Unit. (3 pcs)
Electrical connectors
Precautions in Assembly
2) Ground Wire:
Mount the ground wire onto the BP Unit from the RIGHT.
Belt HP Sensor
REFERENCE PHOTOGRAPH
Encoder assembly
Connector
Reuse band
REFERENCE PHOTOGRAPH
6. Remove the Belt tension shaft from the rear of the BP Unit. (6 mm dia. E-ring (1 pc))
7. Remove the Belt guide shaft from the rear of the BP Unit. (6 mm dia. E-ring (1 pc))
8. Remove the Drive roller bearing from the rear of the BP Unit. (8 mm dia. E-ring (1 pc))
Note: During the assembly, note the shaft length.
• Longer shaft: Belt tension shaft
• Shorter shaft: Belt guide shaft
Encoder assembly
Connector
11. Remove the driven roller bearing mounting screw. (IT screw 3x8 (1 pc)) <Note: Be careful not to drop the
plastic spacer.>
12. Remove the Driven roller, with the Encoder attached, from over the top of the BP Unit. (Unhook the bearing
from the frame.)
13. Pull out the Driven roller from the rear of the BP unit.
Encoder assembly
BP Unit <REAR VIEW>
Direction of removal
14. Remove the Guide pulley mounting bracket. (IT3C screw 4x8 (3 pcs))
15. Remove the Ground wire. (IT3C screw 3x6 (1 pc))
Ground wire
Reuse band
17. Turn the BP Unit up-side-down on the table, and then remove the Rear frame of the Belt platen unit. (W sems
screw 4x10 (4 pcs), P-tight screw 3x8 (1 pc), and binding P-tight screw 4x10 (6 pcs)).
NOTE: Keeping the unit facing down prevents four mounting nuts from falling out of the unit. Be careful not to
drop and lose the nuts.
Transfer belt
Elongated hole
t
ou
i de
Sl
MEMO
3. Adjustment
BP Front cover
STICKER
1. Enter the particular adjustment values for belts in test modes 1910–1921 (corresponds to the parameter
numbers printed on the sticker affixed on the BP Front cover surface.). The 13th parameter is test mode 1922
[Belt Profile Check Digit Input].
2. As the test mode parameter numbers differ from one BP Belt to the other, a replacement spare part BP Belt
always comes with a new sticker with the parameter numbers of its own. Make sure to input the new parameter
numbers for these test modes after the BP Belt is replaced.
3. Update and save the data by test mode 1442 [save belt profile data].
(After entering the data, turn the machine power OFF and ON. The data is updated and saved automatically.)
• Amplitude Input
1. Load A3 paper in the paper feed tray. (16 sheets or more.)
2. Execute test mode 1479 (printing for roller profile amplitude adjustment).
3. The 16 sheets are printed continuously, producing a black pattern with lines in landscape orientation
4. Check the printed pattern, which shows an amplitude of deviation of 0100, followed by 0200, and so on (in
increments of 100) up to 1600.
5. Check the shading caused by transition from one print head to another. Select the amplitude of the pattern that
is least blurry. <Refer to the sketch on the next page.>
6. Enter the selected amplitude value in test mode 1923 (roller profile amplitude input).
7. Access the data in test mode 1443 (save roller profile data), update the adjustment data with it, and save it. (Turn
the unit OFF and ON to update the data and save it automatically.)
• Phase Input
1. Load A3 paper in the paper feed tray. (18 sheets or more.)
2. Execute test mode 1478 (printing for roller profile phase adjustment).
3. The 18 sheets are printed continuously, producing a black pattern with lines in landscape orientation.
4. Check the printed pattern, which shows a phase of 0, followed by 20, and so on up to a phase of 340.
5. Check the shading caused by transition from one print head to another. Select the phase of the pattern that is
least blurry. <Refer to the sketch on the next page.>
6. Enter the selected phase value in test mode 1924 (roller profile phase input).
7. Access the data in test mode 1443 (save roller profile data), update the adjustment data with it, and save it. (Turn
the unit OFF and ON to update the data and save it automatically.)
Note: Both the belt profile data, explained on the previous page, and the roller profile data explained on this
page are saved on both the Hard Disk (HDD) and Engine Control PCB as settings values. If either
one of these two components are replaced, the setting values are copied automatically from the one to
the other when the machine is powered ON after the replacement.
Print out samples of Test Mode numbers 1478 and 1479 <ENLARGED VIEW>
Uneven in color,
density and width.
GOOD BAD
The binding area is smooth in width The binding area is not smooth in the
and in color density. width and color density.
<Adjustment Instructions>
Adjust the belt alignment on the unit as follows.
1. Execute test mode 2405 (move BP elevation motor to upper limit position) and raise the BP unit, so that it is in
the normal printing position.
2. Execute test mode 1256 (transfer belt motor) and start the transfer belt motor.
3. From the jam release section of the vertical paper feed, check the position of the transfer belt relative to the belt
guide flange on the belt driven roller.
4. If the belt edge surface is touching the flange on the front, tighten the Cap Screw (clock-wise rotation) of the
belt tension block and let the BP Belt slide to the rear for the amount of 0.5 to 1.0 mm. If the front belt edge
already has a space from the flange, or if 0.5 to 1.0 mm space is achieved by following this step, go to the next
step.
5. Rotate the Cap Screw in the counter-clock-wise direction (loosen the Cap Screw) one calibration line at a time
and check the BP Belt movement towards the front.
Calibration lines
6. Keep the BP Belt motor running for 3 minutes or more after each Cap Screw rotation.
Do not rotate the Cap Screw more than one calibration at a time, as when the belt starts to side, it slides quickly
and goes over the flange.
Caution: The BP Belt will be damaged if it rides over the flange, even once.
7. End the adjustment when the belt stabilizes in the location against the flange in the front. Tighten the lock nut
against the Cap Screw and rotate the BP Belt motor for another 3 minutes or longer to confirm that the BP Belt
stays stable in one place.
Mounting screw
If the Cap screw cannot be moved enough in either
direction to complete the Transfer belt alignment,
making sure that the machine power is OFF, rotate
Belt the Cap screw to bring the spring to the center of the
to the
REA calibration lines, loosen the Mounting screw (shown on
R the left photograph) and side the whole Front tension
Belt roller assembly in the direction that the Belt needed to
to the move toward.
FRO
NT Tighten the Mounting screw, turn ON back the machine
power and re-start the adjustment from above step-4.
The position of the BP Belt edge against the Flange on the belt driven roller can only be checked at one location,at
the left-front of the BP Unit. At no other location the observation can be made. Use a MIRROR and a flashlight
to confirm the BP Belt edge position against the Flange as the belt rotates -- must be looking at the belt all through
the duration the belt is rotated by the test mode. Since the BP Belt is running, watch out for all the moving
parts to avoid injury.
MIRROR
BP Belt BP Belt
Belt edge Belt edge
Insulation plate
Drive roller
Driven roller
Flange
LEFT-HAND SIDE RIGHT-HAND SIDE
VIEW from the TOP
Roller Correct:
Belt edge aligned with the Flange
<Adjustment Instructions>
For adjustment instructions, refer to Chapter 11A on the subject of “Transfer Unit Position Adjustment” and
“Registration Roller Position Adjustment*.
MEMO
Contents
1. Mechanisms........................................................................................ 8-2
1-1. Basic Structure........................................................................... 8-2
2. Disassembly....................................................................................... 8-5
2-1. Paper Elevation Motor................................................................ 8-5
1. Mechanisms
Description
1) When printing starts, the upper transfer rollers start rotating.
(Except during simplex printing when face up paper ejection is specified.)
2) Upper transfer rollers 1 and 2 are set up to rotate at the same circumferential speed as the belt platen (to
prevent the elevation path from pulling the paper from the belt platen or vice-versa).
3) Paper from the BP unit is detected by the paper elevation IN sensor, and if a paper jam is detected, the upper
transfer rollers will stop rotating.
4) The specified speed is maintained as long as there are no problems during transfer, and when the job is
finished, the rollers stop.
Face up paper
ejection flipper
Description
1) When printing starts, the upper transfer rollers start rotating.
(Except during simplex printing when face up paper ejection is specified.)
During simplex printing, rollers of the upper transfer unit rotate at the same circumferential speed as the belt
platen. During duplex printing, the speed varies depending on the length of the paper.
2) Paper is detected by the flipper sensor, and if a paper jam is detected, the upper transfer rollers will stop
rotating.
3) The specified speed is maintained as long as there are no problems during transfer, and when the job is
finished, the rollers stop.
2. Disassembly
Stay plate
Tensioner spring Paper elevation guide drive; middle Assy (C1 door)
5. Remove the mounting base of the driven roller. (P-tight screw 3x8 (2 pcs))
6. Remove the shaft holder for driven rollers. (P-tight screw 3x8 (2 pcs))
7. Remove the driven roller.
Driven roller
Flipper sensor
MEMO
Contents
1. Mechanisms........................................................................................ 9-2
1-1. Basic Structure..................................................................................... 9-2
2. Disassembly..................................................................................... 9-11
2-1. Removing the Unit.............................................................................. 9-11
2-6. FD Paper Ejection Motor FG Sensor (FD Paper Ejection Unit).......... 9-14
2-7. FD Paper Ejection Flipper Solenoid (FD Paper Ejection Unit)............ 9-15
2-10. FD Ejection Driven Roller (FD Paper Ejection Unit) ........................ 9-16
3. Adjustment....................................................................................... 9-17
3-1. FD Paper Ejection Flipper Solenoid (FD Paper Ejection Unit)............ 9-17
3-2. Phase adjustment of the Fence Rack (FD Fence Unit)...................... 9-18
1. Mechanisms
FD fence unit
Unit Structure
De-electricity brush
End wall
Flipper
solenoid
Paper ejection
roller (driven)
This action involves switching between the face down paper receiving tray and upper transfer path.
Switching the gate is done by means of a solenoid. Normally (in the OFF position), paper is transferred to the face
down paper receiving tray.
• When the face down paper receiving tray is selected as the destination for ejection in simplex printing, the
flipper transfers paper in the normal, OFF state.
• When the face down paper receiving tray is selected as the destination for ejection in duplex printing, the flipper
operates on a timing determined by the flipper sensor as paper passes through.
• The timing of flipper operation varies depending on paper size and the speed of the upper transfer motor.
Note: Installation and removal of the flipper sensor is described in Chapter 8.
Flipper
Target sheet Target sheet
Being transferred
Flipper solenoid
5.
6.
7.
8.
1.
2.
3.
OUT
4.
5.
6.
Start Finish
Transfer started Transfer ended
Paper receiving FULL detection relies on the FD paper ejection full sensor. After detection by the FD paper ejection
full sensor, the FD paper ejection motor remains on for a period equivalent to 30 consecutive sheets, and then the
motor stops.
A schematic diagram of FD paper receiving full detection is shown below.
FD paper ejection
fence motor
FD paper ejection fence
FD paper ejection roller
FD paper FD paper
receiving tray Paper ejection motor
FD paper ejection
FD paper ejection
full sensor
paper detection sensor
State when FD paper ejection full sensor is ON Stopped with paper full
(3) (After sensor detection, transfer continues for
( ) (Full determined with 3 sheets
the e uivalent of 3 sheets) fed when ON)
Note: The number of sheets for which the FD paper ejection motor keeps running after detection by the paper
receiving FULL sensor can be set in test mode 1837 (paper receiving FULL detection sheet quantity setting).
By default, the test mode setting value is 35 sheets. The setting range is 1–100.
1. If the FD paper ejection full sensor incorrectly detects an ejected sheet as it is dropped and goes ON, the
count is reset the next time it goes OFF.
2. Although a command to stop transfer is issued once the FD paper ejection full sensor has been ON for
the specified number of sheets, inside the unit at this time, sheets that were transferred after the specified
number of sheets will be mixed in. (The quantity of sheets varies depending on the size of paper.) In order
to eject all sheets that were mixed in, a quantity equivalent to the specified quantity + α (which includes the
ejected portion) is ejected, and then transfer stops.
α: Sheets transferred after the quantity of sheets for which the full detection sensor remains ON.
Note: If the FD paper ejection full sensor is ON when paper transfer is requested, "Error: 1150" is displayed,
indicating a tray detection error (FD paper ejection full).
Fence Movement
1. Determination of Fence Movement
After a job begins, fence movement is determined by the following information.
• Target position for fence movement
• Current fence position
• Presence of paper in the paper receiving tray
2. Home Positioning
The FD paper ejection fence moves to the home position in the following situations.
• When the unit is turned ON
• During recovery after an emergency stop when the fence was moving
• When the unit is reset
MEMO
2. Disassembly
Wire connector
End wall
Access lever D1
2-4. FD Paper Ejection Full Detection Sensor (FD Paper Ejection Unit)
1. Turn OFF the machine power and disconnect the power cable from the power source.
2. Remove the FD paper ejection unit. (Refer to the instructions for removal.)
3. Unplug the sensor wire connector.
4. Remove the sensor together with the mounting bracket. (Round tip IT3C screw 3x6 (1 pc))
5. Detach the sensor from the bracket.
Note: After the replacement, check the operation by test mode 1151 (paper receiving FULL sensor).
SCREW
Socket stopper
2-11. FD Paper Ejection Paper Detection Sensor (FD Paper Ejection Unit)
1. Turn OFF the machine power and disconnect the power cable from the power source.
2. Remove the paper receiving tray unit. (Refer to the instructions for removal.)
3. Unplug the paper detection sensor wire connector.
4. Remove the paper detection sensor from the paper receiving tray.
Note: After the replacement, check the operation by test mode 1152 (FD paper ejection paper detection
sensor).
3. Adjustment
1. With the Solenoid in activated condition (the plunger is pulled into the Solenoid), confirm that the clearance
between the Flipper and the Upper guide plate is 4.2 mm ± 1 mm.
The adjustment, when required, is made by loosening the set screws of the Flipper solenoid link plate and re-
tightening the set screws with correct clearance of 4.2 mm ± 1 mm.
Flipper
4.2 mm ± 1 mm
2. Next, with the Solenoid in deactivated condition (the solenoid spring is pulling the Flipper down), confirm that
the clearance between the Flipper and the Lower guide plate is 5 mm ± 1 mm.
Refer to the next step for the adjustment.
5 mm ± 1 mm
3. If the clearance is out of the range, loosening the mounting screw of the Solenoid cover plate and slide the plate
to the left or right until the clearance of 5 mm ± 1 mm is obtained, and tighten the screw.
ADJUSTMENT
1. Open wide the both Fence rack gears, all the way maximum.
2. Mount the FD paper ejection fence motor assembly over the fence rack gears.
Open the rack gear maximum to the end wall. Rack gear
Open the rack gear maximum to the end wall. Rack gear
Contents
1. Mechanisms...................................................................................... 10-2
1-1. Basic Structure......................................................................... 10-2
2. Disassembly..................................................................................... 10-7
2-1. Switchback Motor..................................................................... 10-7
1. Mechanisms
Switchback roller
Switchback section
Upper transfer
Re-feed roller roller 6
Registration sensor
Registration roller
Re-feed roller
Switchback Unit A
Switchback sensor
Switchback roller
Switchback motor
Re-feed motor
Re-feed roller
Switchback clutch
Magnet catch
(holds the paper feed tray)
Switchback cover
(outer cover)
Jam release lever
Re-feed sensor
Jam release dial
Switchback Unit B
Switchback roller
Upper transfer roller
Re-feed roller
Re-feed sensor
Top edge sensor 1
( ) Switchback roller starts slowing down ( ) Switchback roller starts reverse motion
Simultaneousl rollers to reverse paper
(Starts slowing down after a specific pulse,
following activation of switchback sensor) feed also start
( ms after stopping)
5.
6.
7.
8.
ON 176.2 ms
1. Switchback clutch 187.5 ms
OFF
Normal old
2. Switchback motor OFF
Normal
Reversed
Reversed 4 ms
30 ms
ON
OUT
4.
5.
Start Finish
Paper transfer started Paper transfer ended
2. Re-feed sensor
OFF
ON
1. Registration motor
OFF
OUT
ON
2. Re-feed motor
OFF Noise reduction assistance in progress
2. Disassembly
Switchback motor
Re-feed motor
8. Remove the re-feed motor. (Roud tip IT3C screw 4x8 (2 pcs))
11. Remove the external paper feed unit mounting bracket in front. (Round tip IT3C screw 4x8 (1 pc))
13. Remove Switchback unit A. (Round tip IT3C screw 4x8 (4 pcs))
Switchback unit A
Interlock switch
Switchback sensor
MEMO
Contents
1. Mechanisms....................................................................................11A-3
1-1. Ink Supply Mechanisms.........................................................11A-3
2. Disassembly.................................................................................11A-15
2-1. Cutting the Ink Tubes...........................................................11A-15
2-2. Ink Spill Prevention from the Ink Cartridge Holder Unit........ 11A-17
2-27. KG Roller............................................................................11A-90
3. Adjustment...................................................................................11A-91
Image Adjustment.......................................................................11A-91
1. Mechanisms
Joint
The path of one color ink is shown as an example.
: Ink path Ink Cartridge
: Air valve/waste ink path
Pressurized
Ink Tank Filter
Air chamber in
common to all colors
of pressurized ink
tank
Heater
Ink bus
Ink bus
Heat Sink
Ink level
detection
sensor
Head Head Head Head Head Head
One-way Diaphragm
Negative pressure pump (each color
ink tank air valve separate)
Pressurized ink
tank air valve
Ink drain for Negative Ink drain for heat exchanger
Weight pressure ink tank (normally (normally sealed with a blind
sealed with a blind plug) plug)
Bellows sensor
Upper limit sensor
Idle position sensor Overflow and leak detection tank
Bellows elevation
Lower limit sensor mechanism
Ink level detection sensor
Drain joint
Normal Cleaning
Strong Cleaning Near-full detection
Waste ink tank
Full detection
Ink Cartridge
These cartridges hold the ink supplied to the printer.
Electronic ink tags embedded in cartridges contain information about the ink.
(K)
(C)
(M)
Ink cartridge
Circulation Pump
Comprised of a pump for circulation of ink from the negative pressure ink tank to the pressurized ink tank and
an overflow pan.
The circulation pump incorporates piston pumps that can drive the supply of ink independently for each color.
Circulation pump
One-way Valve
Ink flows only in the
direction indicated.
Flow in the opposite From the negative pressure ink tank
direction is stopped.
Made of soft rubber. to the heat sink
(Heat exchanger tower)
Electromagnetic Coil
The piston is moved by magnetic force of the coil.
Same as a solenoid.
When the coil is activated, the piston slides back and the ink chamber expands,
taking in the ink from the Negative pressure ink tank.
After this, deactivating the coil causes the piston to push out under the force
of the spring. The ink chamber contracts, pushing the ink up towards the
Pressurized ink tank, creating a pressure in the ink flow system. Note that when
the piston movement stops, no pressure in the ink-flow system is generated.
Bellows Unit
Comprised of the bellows and motor connected to the common air chamber, in turn connected to the negative
pressure ink tank for each color. Raising and lowering the bellows adjusts the pressure in the negative
pressure ink tank.
Bellows cover
Bellows
Weight
Bellows sensor
HP sensor
Bellows Sensor
The unit is stopped when the bellows sensor detects that the bellows spindle has reached the bottom.
Heat Exchanger
This device regulates the temperature (based on the head thermistor temperature) so that ink used in printing
is within a specific temperature range. It incorporates a radiator in contact with the ink path, a fan to cool the
radiator, and an ink heater. The radiator and fan are used to cool ink, and the heater is used to heat it.
Filter
A filter is incorporated in the pressurized ink tank to filter the ink in circulation.
Ink Bus
This unit distributes ink from the ink supply unit uniformly to all head IN ports, and circulates the ink from the
head OUT ports back to the ink supply unit. There are two IN and OUT paths per color between the head and
ink supply unit.
Ink bus
Print head
Overflow Detection
Detects the amount of ink that has come into the overflow pan.
Negative
Pressurized Negative
Pressure Pressurized Ink
Ink Ink Supply Pressure Bellows Pump
Printer Status Ink Ink Tank Circulation Notes
Tank Valve Ink Tank Air Sensor Position
Tank Air Valve Pump
Sensor Valve
Sensor
Power OFF - - Closed Closed Open Lower limit Stopped
Negative
Pressurized Negative
Pressure Pressurized Ink
Ink Ink Supply Pressure Bellows Pump
Printer Status Ink Ink Tank Circulation Notes
Tank Valve Ink Tank Air Sensor Position
Tank Air Valve Pump
Sensor Valve
Sensor
Transition to ink circulation Home position →
Printer turned ON
lower limit
- - Closed Opens Closes Stopped
(state when spindle
dangles)
During circulation: OFF OFF Opens Stopped
Ink level checked
OFF ON Closed Started
Open Closed Lower limit
ON OFF Closed Stopped
ON ON Closed Stopped
Transition to idle (standby) Lower limit →
- - Closed Closes Opens Stopped
state home position
Negative
Pressurized Negative
Pressure Pressurized Ink
Ink Ink Supply Pressure Bellows Pump
Printer Status Ink Ink Tank Circulation Notes
Tank Valve Ink Tank Air Sensor Position
Tank Air Valve Pump
Sensor Valve
Sensor
Printing in progress
Home position →
Transition to ink circulation - - Closed Opens Closes Stopped
lower limit
Negative
Pressurized Negative
Pressure Pressurized Ink
Ink Ink Supply Pressure Bellows Pump
Printer Status Ink Ink Tank Circulation Notes
Tank Valve Ink Tank Air Sensor Position
Tank Air Valve Pump
Sensor Valve
Sensor
Idle
Transition to sleep
There is no change along the ink path.
1) After a specific period in standby, the maintenance unit emerges under the heads.
2) The elevation lever of the pressure adjusting bellows is lowered to the lower limit sensor position.
3) The printer is now in sleep mode.
Negative
Pressurized Negative
Pressure Pressurized Ink
Ink Ink Supply Pressure Bellows Pump
Printer Status Ink Ink Tank Circulation Notes
Tank Valve Ink Tank Air Sensor Position
Tank Air Valve Pump
Sensor Valve
Sensor
During circulation:
Cartridge replacement
ON ON Closes Stopped
Negative
Pressurized Negative
Pressure Pressurized Ink
Ink Ink Supply Pressure Bellows Pump
Printer Status Ink Ink Tank Circulation Notes
Tank Valve Ink Tank Air Sensor Position
Tank Air Valve Pump
Sensor Valve
Sensor
Normal cleaning
Home position →
Pressurization - - Closed Closed Closed upper limit → home Stopped
position
Home position →
Transition to ink circulation - - Closed Opens Closes Stopped
lower limit
During circulation:
OFF OFF Opens Stopped
Ink level checked
OFF ON Closed Started
Open Closed Lower limit
ON OFF Closed Stopped
ON ON Closed Stopped
Negative
Pressurized Negative
Pressure Pressurized Ink
Ink Ink Supply Pressure Bellows Pump
Printer Status Ink Ink Tank Circulation Notes
Tank Valve Ink Tank Air Sensor Position
Tank Air Valve Pump
Sensor Valve
Sensor
Strong cleaning
Lower limit →
Pressurization - - Closed Closed Closed upper limit → home Stopped
position
Home position →
Transition to ink circulation - - Closed Opens Closes Stopped
lower limit
During circulation:
OFF OFF Opens Stopped
Ink level checked
OFF ON Closed Started
Open Closed Lower limit
ON OFF Closed Stopped
ON ON Closed Stopped
Transition to idle (standby) Lower limit →
- - Closed Closes Opens Stopped
mode home position
Negative
Pressurized Negative
Pressure Pressurized Ink
Ink Ink Supply Pressure Bellows Pump
Printer Status Ink Ink Tank Circulation Notes
Tank Valve Ink Tank Air Sensor Position
Tank Air Valve Pump
Sensor Valve
Sensor
Preliminary actions *The maintenance unit
Filling the system with ink initially
Wiping - - In the state of "Preliminary actions," the wiper cleans the head nozzle plate (runs back and forth over the plate).
Home position →
Transition to ink circulation - - Closed Opens Closes Stopped
lower limit
During circulation:
Ink level checked OFF OFF Opens Stopped
Lower limit *Ink circulates for 30 sec.
OFF ON Closed Started
Open Closed (With the spindle (this setting is subject to
ON OFF Closed dangling) Stopped change in the future).
ON ON Closed Stopped
Transition to idle (standby) Lower limit →
- - Closed Closes Opens Stopped
mode home position
2. Disassembly
Tube (sample)
Right Angle
Nipper
2. Allowance in the cutting area.
Cut the tube within plus or minus 5 mm from the imprinted black line.
Cut-mark line
5 mm 5 mm
3. The cutting angle should be within 1.5 mm (approx. 10 degrees) from the imprinted marking.
1.5 mm
4. Check with the eye for any left over tube on the cut area.
If any leftover piece(s) are left on the tube, cut the leftover piece off.
5. Insert the joint on the tube. If the joint is too tight to fit, put some ink on the tip of the tube to act as a lubrication.
< Too much ink to act as lubrication will cause the joint to slip off. Make sure not to put too much ink, and
confirm that the joint does not slip off.>
2-2. Ink Spill Prevention from the Ink Cartridge Holder Unit
Follow this procedure before swing opening the Ink cartridge holder unit in the vertical open position to
prevent ink spillage from the Ink cartridge holder.
Ignoring this procedure may cause the spilled ink to stain the machine interior with the ink.
1. Turn OFF the machine power and disconnect the power cable from the power source.
2. Pull out the four Ink cartridges from the Ink cartridge holder unit.
3. Using lint-free paper or cloth, wipe clean the pooled ink from the Ink cartridge holder unit.
4. Do the same in the area beyond the Ink cartridge joint nozzle on the machine.
6. Turn ON the machine power and confirm that the Ink cartridge joint drive motor operates and mechanically joins
the Ink tubes to the Ink cartridge holder unit.
< If not required to supply ink into the machine, skip this step-6.>
7. Make four cuts of ink absorbent papers in the shape of about 150 mm x 200 mm rectangular shape, and then
fold each piece into approx. 20 mm x 100 mm piece.
< The size of the ink absorbent papers will differ according to the paper thickness. The size is not so critical.>
200 mm
20 mm
150 mm
100 mm
8. Hook these four folded papers between the ink cartridge holder and ink tubes of the each four color, and confirm
that the papers do not slide out or fall off.
Before going to the instruction in the next page, confirm that the Flat cable has a good fold, or
the Ink cartridge joint drive motor may hit on the Flat cable, when the Ink cartridge holder unit is
raised up, and damage the cable.
10. Remove one thumb screw and one IT screw 4x8 (1 pc) from the Ink cartridge holder unit and the unit to the
vertical position. << Refer to the two photographs below.>>
< Make sure to screw the Lock arm to prevent the Ink cartridge holder from falling down.>
CAUTION:
Make sure to remove the ink absorbent paper the each time the Ink cartridge is pulled out or plugged into the
Ink cartridge unit. Then re-hook the ink absorbent paper in the instructed position, using a new piece of paper if
the previous one has already absorbed the ink.
Stopper
4. Remove the scissor clamps attached to the top of the head holder cover.
Scissor clamps
Connector
Sensor plate
6. Disconnect the Bellows air tube from the Negative pressure ink tank common air chamber.
Bellows unit
7. Remove the bellows unit mounting screws. (IT screw 4x8 (4 pcs)), and remove the Bellows unit from the
machine
CAUTION:
1. If the Bellows unit contains ink from the past ink overflow, the ink may drip out from the Bellows air tube if the
Bellows unit is held up-side-down with the Bellows air tube disconnected from the Common air chamber of the
Negative pressure ink tank.
2. There is only a narrow space between the Bellows unit and the four Ink pump PCBs.
Pay caution not to damage the Ink pump PCBs by hitting the Bellows unit against the PCBs.
2-5. Draining the Ink from the Ink Supply Unit into the Waste Ink Tank
Draining all 4 colors from the Pressurized ink tanks, Heat exchanger tower and Negative pressure ink tanks.
The instruction given here is to drain the ink from the system in replace any if the following 4 components on the
machine.
• Pressurized Ink Tank
• Print Head
• Overflow Pan
• Pressurized Ink Tank Air Valve
• Negative Pressure Ink Tank
NOTE: Test Mode 2711 (Head Replacement Mode) will be done later in the procedure.
1. Turn OFF the machine power and disconnect the power cable from the power source.
2. Remove the 4 scissor clamps from the head holder cover. (Refer to the "Removing the Scissor Clamps.")
3. Open the rear cover and the ink supply unit. (Refer to Chapter 2.)
4. Following the instructions in "Bellows Unit" given in this chapter, remove the bellows unit.
5. Use the 4 scissor clamps to clamp the drainage tubes under the Heat exchanger Tower.
< Refer to the photograph below.>
6. Disconnect the four drainage tubes on the overflow pan side. Insert the ends in the port in the overflow pan.
<Prior to the insertion of the drainage tubes into the Ink drain port of the Overflow pan, remove the sponge if the
sponge exists.>
Note: Be careful, because ink may drip when you remove the tubes.
< Refer to the photographs, sketch, and instructions on this page.>
Note: Insert drainage tubes so that they go into the groove (ink drain port) on the overflow pan.
Overflow pan
< Refer to the photographs on the next page for further details.>
Following photographs show how the Ink drainage tubes should be inserted into the Ink drain port of the Overflow
pan.
< The ends of the disconnected Ink drainage tubes are inserted in the
Ink drain port of the overflow pan.>
Do not remove the Scissor clips from the Ink drainage tubes yet.
The instruction for that is on Step-(9).
7. Unplug the Air tube between the Negative pressure ink tank common air chamber and Negative pressure ink
tank air valve, on the air valve side.
These are the two sponges to remove and throw away before inserting
the 4 Ink drainage tubes into the Ink drain port of the Overflow pan.
The air tube to disconnect from the Negative pressure ink tank air valve.
8. Drop the unplugged end of the air tube into the Overflow pan in order that any overflown ink coming to the tube
is drained out onto the Overflow pan and not drip on the floor.
9. Remove the scissor clamps from the ink drainage tubes clamped in step (5).
The ink from the Pressurized ink tank, Ink bus, Negative pressure ink tank, and Heat exchanger tower starts to
drip down from the Ink drainage tubes once the scissor clamps are removed.
The ink will not drain freely if the Ink drainage tube is bent or flattened. Use fingers to straighten the Ink
drainage tube(s) to allow smooth ink drainage.
Wait few minutes and confirm that the ink is draining smoothly before going to the next step.;
In replacing the Ink supply valve(s), Negative pressure ink tank(s) or entire Ink
circulation system, do all the following Steps including [10] to [15].
In replacing only the Ink bus, skip the Steps [10] and [12] , as the ink supply
tube(s) need not be emptied of ink when replacing only the Ink bus.
10. Unplug the Ink cartridge(s), from the Ink cartridge holder of the machine when replacing the Ink supply
valve or Negative pressure ink tank of that color. Unplug all 4 ink cartridges when replacing the entire Ink
circulation system.
11. With the Front door of the ComColor opened, turn ON the machine power. < IMPORTANT !! >
< The Front door is opened to prevent the machine from making the initial movement, including the
ink supplying action, when the machine power is turned ON.>
Error message Z05-1212 [Front Cover Open] error message displays, but ignore the message and go into
Test Mode.
When the Test Mode is accessed, error message Z05-1212 [Front cover open] displays.
• Press the Close button on the error message display.
Then error message W51-1301 [Request to start recovery operations] displays.
• Press the Close button on the error message display.
Lastly, error message Z02-2126 [Ink cartridge not loaded] displays.
• Press the Close button on the error message display.
12. Activate one or more of the following 4 Test Modes to empty the Ink supply tube between the Ink supply valve
and Negative pressure ink tank.
Which test mode to activate depends on which ink color to empty.
< Make sure that the Ink cartridge for those colors to activate the test modes are pulled out.>
Test Mode No. 2482 [K-Ink Supply Valve Open] -------- < Black Ink >
Test Mode No. 2483 [C-Ink Supply Valve Open] -------- < Cyan Ink >
Test Mode No. 2484 [M-Ink Supply Valve Open] -------- < Magenta Ink >
Test Mode No. 2485 [Y-Ink Supply Valve Open] --------- < Yellow Ink >
Activate the necessary test mode(s) from above 4, one at a time.
For each test mode, press the START Key approximately 10 times at 1 second interval between each press.
The ink in the Ink supply tube should become free of ink after about 10 press of the START Key.
13. Activate Test Mode No. 2711 [Head Replacement Mode], and change the setting to [1: ON]. < IMPORTANT !!>
< This test mode setting is to prevent the Print Head to drip ink on the BP Belt when the power is turned ON
the next time to supply the ink in the ink circulation system.>
Turn OFF the machine power.
14. Wait until all the ink is drained out of the Negative pressure ink tank of which the ink is drained.
< Once again, the ink will not drain freely if the Ink drainage tube is bent or flattened. Use fingers to straighten
the Ink drainage tube(s) to allow smooth ink drainage.>
15. Connect back the Air tube between the air chamber (in common to the negative pressure ink tanks) and
negative pressure ink tank air valve, unplugged in Step-7, on the Negative pressure ink tank air valve.
Connect the Air tube back on the Negative pressure ink tank air valve.
16. Return the Ink drainage tubes back in their original position.
Make sure to make good Z-shape bend on the tube to prevent ink leakage.
Also make sure to hook the tube in the tube clamp.
This completes the ink draining procedure.
Make good Z-shape bend on all four Ink drainage tubes to prevent ink leakage.
17. Proceed to the replacement of the components in the Ink circulation system.
Test Mode No. 2711 set to [1] prevents the Ink pan from moving out from top of the BP Belt until the ink filling is
completed and Head cleaning is automatically made at the end. The Ink pan moves away from the BP Belt after
the Head cleaning is finished and all the Print heads have the meniscus made.
In the case if forgotten to set Test Mode No. 2711 to [1] before turning the machine OFF and working on the Ink
circulation system, there is one way to get into Test Mode No. 2711 without having the machine make the initial
movement.
Steps to take if forgotten to set Test Mode No. 2711 to [1] before working on the Ink circulation system:
1. After working on the Ink circulation system is finished and the machine is in workable condition, open the Front
door of the machine, and then turn ON the machine power.
Go into Test Mode No. 2711 and change the setting to [1].
< Opening the Front door will trip the Safety switch and with the Safety switch tripped, the machine will not
make any mechanical initial movement nor supply the ink, when the machine power is turned ON.>
2. After changing the Test Mode No. 2711 setting to [1], turn OFF the machine power.
3. Close the Front door of the machine.
4. Refer to the steps given below to start filling the machine with the Ink.
1. Turning ON the machine power will start the Initial ink filling action.
2. The Test Mode No. 2711 [Head Replacement Mode] initial ink filling action ends after automatic Head cleaning
action. Do not operate nor go into any other test mode until the Initial ink filling action is completely finished.
3. Test Mode No. 2711 will automatically go back to setting [0] after the ink is filled.
4. Gently close the Ink cartridge holder back to its original flat position.
5. Put all the covers back.
3. Remove the left and right top covers. (Refer to the section on covers in Chapter 2.)
4. Remove the operation panel (the entire bracket; round tip IT3C screw 4x8 (3 pcs)) and rest it on the left side of
the ink cartridge unit.
5. Remove the center inner cover. (Refer to the section on covers in Chapter 2.)
6. Remove the stoppers at two positions (IT3C screw 4x8 (1 pc) and remove the upper transfer unit.
Stopper
7. Open the Ink cartridge holder unit to the vertical position following the instruction given in the, “Ink spill
prevention from the Ink cartridge holder unit” procedure described earlier in this chapter.
Make sure to lock the Ink cartridge holder unit position by a screw to prevent the Ink cartridge holder
from folding down.
8. Disconnect the connector and remove the sensor bracket. (IT screw 3x6 (2 pcs))
Engraved arrow
marks on the
Head holder
cover indicates
the position of the
mounting screws in
Head holder cover
all 6 positions.
<Confirm of the
following in assembly.>
Connector
8. Using scissor clamps, clamp the tubes between the ink cartridges and ink supply valves, near the ink supply
valve port on all four colors. (4 scissor clamps)
9. Disconnect the tubes between the ink cartridges and ink supply valves from the ink supply valve port.
Note: Be careful of the ink which may drip from the ink supply valves.
10. Remove the scissor clamps and allow the ink in the tubes to drain into the pan of the Ink cartridge holder unit.
Cap the four ink drained ink tube openings with the rubber caps provided in the replacement Ink cartridge holder
unit kit.
11. Open the Ink cartridge holder unit to the vertical position following the instruction given in the, “Ink spill
prevention from the Ink cartridge holder unit” procedure described earlier in this section.
Since the ink in the four tubes were drained into the ink pan of the Ink cartridge holder unit, the ink may very
likely to drip out unless this procedure is followed with care.
Make sure to lock the Ink cartridge holder unit position by a screw to prevent the Ink cartridge holder
from folding down.
12. Wait few minutes for the ink from the Ink cartridge holder unit to drain down into the Waste ink tank. Then at the
three-way joint of the ink drain tubes, use scissor clamps to clamp the tubes from the overflow pan of the Ink
cartridge holder unit and to the waste ink tank. (2 tubes.)
13. Disconnect the Ink drain tube from the ink cartridge holder unit at the three-way joint. Plug a rubber cap on the
tip of the unplugged ink drain tube to prevent ink from dripping out.
14. Likewise, plug the port of the three-way stopper from which above ink drain tube was unplugged, to prevent ink
drip.
15. Use a nipper or a similar tool to cut the fastener (band) holding the ink drain tube where it emerges out from the
inside of the machine frame out towards the back.
16. Pull up the waste ink tube into the frame.
17. Restore the ink cartridge holder unit, which was standing, to its original flat position. Remove all four ink
absorbing papers from the Ink cartridge holder unit.
18. Remove the E-rings linking the arm plate of the ink cartridge holder unit to the bracket on the printer side. (6 mm
dia. E-ring (2 pcs))
E-rings
19. Remove the Ink cartridge holder unit from the printer.
Assembly Precautions
1. Thread the Ink drain tube of the Ink cartridge holder unit from inside to the outside of the machine frame.
Push the Ink drain tube through and down until the plastic band hits the machine frame and stops.
2. On the rear of the machine, wrap a plastic band on the Ink drain tube and tighten it and cut off the excess
length of the band.
< This will fix the position of the Ink drain tube and keep it from going in or coming out.>
3. The grips on the Tube Clips on the Ink supply tubes against the Ink supply valves should face in the direction
shown on the photograph, below, on four colors.
4. As mentioned earlier, when assembled, the Cyan ink tube should be at the bottom. The three wire connectors
are in the middle and the Black ink tube should come on the very top.
Connector
Cartridge holder
joint drive motor
Screw driver
Connector Connector
4. Unhook the RFID PCB from the two plastic hooks, and then pull out the RFID PCB.
Hooks
8. Use nippers to cut the ink supply tube at the downstream port of the the ink supply valve for replacement.
<Do only for that of the color to replace.>
Note:Hold the tube end with a clean lint-free cloth or paper while cutting it. Continue holding it until the ink in the
tube drains into the negative pressure ink tank.
9. Cap the cut ends of the ink tube with rubber caps, which are supplied in the replacement Ink supply valve kit.
10. Cut the Ink supply tube at the Cut-Marking located above the Negative pressure ink tank, and cap the cut end of
the ink tube, and cap the cut end of the ink tube with the rubber cap included in the replacement kit.
11. Also cap the cut tube on the negative pressure ink tank.
12. Free the cut ink tube from the machine by cutting away the tube band banding it to the other color ink tubes and
unlock the ink tube harness bands to free it from the machine frame. Then throw away the removed ink tube.
13. Disconnect the ink tube running between the ink cartridge holder and ink supply valve, at the ink cartridge
holder port shown on the photograph below.
Then drain the ink from the tube into the ink pan on the Ink cartridge holder unit by lifting up the Ink supply
valve.
14. Use the rubber cap included in the Ink supply valve replacement kit to cap the unplugged end of the ink tube on
the previous step and dispose of the tube together with the Ink supply valve.
Assembly Precautions
(1) Replace the drainage tubes on the bottom of the Heat exchanger tower with four new ones and make good
Z-shape bends on all four drainage tubes.
(2) Replace the air tube running between the Air valve of the Negative pressure ink tank and Common air
chamber of the Negative pressure ink tank.
(3) Replace the Bellows unit air tube.
(4) Cut the tube for the <Ink supply valve to Negative pressure ink tank> (included with the Ink supply valve) at
the Cut-mark line.
(5) Add the Joint on the tube cut in step (4).
(6) Form the new tube (ref: step (5)) and put it in through the tube harness bands. Bind the 4 tubes with a band.
<refer to the photograph below.>
30 mm
Binding band
Bind the 4 tubes at a distance approx. 30 mm from
the Tube harness band.
The Binding band should not be tightened too much
as to interefere with the smooth flow of the ink.
(7) Confirm that the tubes do not buckle when the Ink supply unit (Heat exchanger tower) is closed.
(8) The tube clip on the Ink supply valve should face in the following directions, as shown on the photograph below.
The grip of the clip should face to the front of the machine for the colors Y, M and C. The grip of the clip for color
K should face to the rear of the machine.
M K
Y
(9) Referring to the section on the Initial ink filling, fill the machine with ink.
6. Follow the procedure in “Draining Ink into the Waste Ink Tank.”
< Make sure to follow the instructions and do not forget to do the Test Mode No. 2711.>
7. Cut the Ink supply tube coming down from the Ink supply valve to the Negative pressure ink tank to be replaced
at the Cut-mark line. < Cut only the tube for the tank to be replaced.>
< To prevent the ink from dripping, confirm that the ink tube is empty of the ink before cutting.>
The cutting position on the ink tube is marked with black marker line.
K = 45 mm C = 45 mm M = 45 mm Y = 40 mm <Distance from the tube end on the tank.>
8. Cap the cut end of the ink supply tube with the rubber cap included in the replacement parts kit.
9. Cap the cut end of the ink supply tube remaining on the Negative pressure ink tank with the rubber cap included
in the replacement parts kit.
10. Cut the Ink tube coming from the Ink bus to the Negative pressure ink tank at the Cut-mark line for the Negative
pressure ink tank to be replaced. < Cut only the tube for the tank to be replaced.>
K = 30 mm C = 25 mm M = 30 mm Y = 43 mm <Distance from the tube end on the tank.>
11. Cap the cut end of the Ink tube, cut by above step-10, with the rubber cap which comes in the replacement
parts kit.
12. Cap the cut end of the Ink tube remaining on the Negative pressure ink tank with the rubber cap which comes in
the replacement parts kit.
13. Unplug the wire connector to the Ink detection sensor on the Negative pressure ink tank from the tank to
remove.
14. Unplug the wire connector from the extension wire from the Ink pump PCB for the Negative pressure ink tank to
remove.
15. Disconnect from the Common air chamber of the air tube of the Negative pressure ink tank to replace.
16. Cap the port on the Common air chamber from which the air tube was unplugged with the rubber cap included
in the replacement parts kit. This is to prevent dust from entering into the ink circulation system.
17. Remove 4 mounting screws from the Negative pressure ink tank, which is to be removed.
( IT screw 3x6 (2 pcs), Pan-head screw 3x8 (2 pcs))
18. Release the Air tube from the tube guide on the ink circulation tower of the Negative pressure ink tank to
replace.
19. Pull and unplug the Negative pressure ink tank straight out, gently from the Ink circulation tower.
< Pay caution to the ink, which may drip from the removed Negative pressure ink tank or from the Ink
circulation tower from where the tank was removed.>
20. Confirm that the black-colored rubber O-Ring does not stay on the Ink circulation tower. If the O-Ring is on
the Ink circulation tower from where the Negative pressure ink tower was unplugged, remove it and throw it
away.
< The new replacement Negative pressure ink tank replacement kit comes with a new O-Ring. Make sure to
use the new O-Ring and throw away >
20. Confirm that the black-colored rubber O-Ring does not stay on the Ink circulation tower. If the O-Ring is
18) Pull the Negative pressure ink tank gently forward to disengage from the Ink supply unit.
<Watch out for the small amount of ink which may drip, when the tank is pulled out.>
19) A rubber O-Ring may stay inside the Heat exchanger tower. If so, take out the O-Ring from the tower.
Caution:
<Make sure to remove the existing O-Ring out from the Heat exchanger tower, or it will cause ink
leakage when the new O-Ring on the new replaced Negative pressure ink tank pushes over the
existing O-Ring which should have been removed.>
Precaution in Assembly:
1) Confirm that there is an O-Ring attached on the port on the Negative pressure ink tank.
2) Coat the port, on which the O-Ring is attached, lightly with the ink of its color to act as lubrication and then
firmly insert the Negative pressure ink tank into the Ink supply unit tower.
3) The 4 Ink drainage tubes under the Heat exchanger should be replaced with new drainage tubes, which are
included in the Negative pressure ink tank spare part kit.
<Make sure to make good Z-shaped bend on the each drainage tube to prevent ink leakage.>
4) Add the Joints on the cut tubes.
<Straight joints are for the tubes to the ink supply.>
<Right-angled joints are for the tubes to the Ink bus.>
5) The right-angled joints should face in the direction as shown on the photograph below.
6) The tube Clips on the straight joints and bottom Clips on the right-angled joints should all face forward.
The top Clips on the right-angled joints should face up.
7) Mount the Common air chamber on the Overflow pan.
8) Connect the Air tube on the Common air chamber to the Negative pressure ink tank air valve.
9) Connect the 4 Air tubes between the Common air chamber and Negative pressure ink tanks.
<Make sure to keep the Caps on the Common air chamber ports plugged for those ports not used on the
chamber. Otherwise the air will go into the Common air chamber and the ink will overflow.>
10) The Clips for the 4 Air tubes attached by step-(9) should all face to the left on the Common air chamber ports.
11) Mount the Bellows unit back on the machine and connect the Air tube between the Bellows unit and Common
air chamber.
12) Confirm that all the parts are mounted back on the machine.
Confirm that all the Ink tubes and Air tubes are mounted correctly.
Confirm that both the Air valves for the Pressurized ink tank and Negative pressure ink tank have the black
rubber cap on the top.
Confirm that all the electrical connectors are connected.
13) Follow the instruction on the Initial Ink Filling and fill the machine with the ink.
Flexible cable
4) Open the power supply unit, engine control PCB, and ink supply unit. (Refer to the section on covers in
Chapter 2.)
5) Follow the procedure in "Draining Ink into the Waste Ink Tank".
6) Unplug the connector of the Ink detection sensor on the Pressurized ink tank which is to be replaced.
7) Unplug the Air valve tube of the Pressurized ink tank from the Common air chamber.
Then plug the port on the Common air chamber with a Cap included in the Pressurized ink tank parts kit.
Assembly Precautions
(1) Confirm that the round rubber sheets, on which the Pressurized ink tank is to sit, are free of dust.
(2) Replace the 4 drainage tubes, at the bottom of the Heat exchanger, with new ones which are included in
the Pressurized ink tank spare part kit.
Make sure to make good Z-shaped bend on these 4 drainage tubes to prevent ink leakage.
(3) Replace the Bellows unit tube with the new tube included in the spare parts kit.
(4) The 4 tube Clips on the Common air chamber air ports for the Air hose to the Pressurized ink tank
should all face to the right. <Refer to above photograph.>
(5) The tube Clip on the Air tube at the Common air chamber connecting to the Air valve should face down.
(6) Follow the instruction on the Initial Ink Filling and fill the machine with the ink.
Cable stoppers
Flexible cables
6) When removing the cyan or black ink bus, loosen the screws (IT screw 3x6 (4 pcs)) on the left head drive
PCB, lift entire PCB bracket, and hook it on the two screws on left wall.
7) When removing the magenta or yellow ink bus, loosen the screws (IT screw 3x6 (3 pcs)) on the right hand
side Head drive PCB, remove the entire PCB bracket, and hook it over the left Head drive PCB.)
REAR
FRONT
FRONT view
REAR view
(1) Slide the tip of the PCB bracket into the hook.
8) Disconnect the Print head ink tube of the Ink bus to replace at the Print head side. (Be careful of the ink that
may drip.)
9) Unplug the Ink circulation tube of the color of the Ink bus to replace, at the heater OUT port under the
Pressurized ink tank. <Refer to the photograph, below> Put a Cap at the pulled out end of the tube.
< Watch out for the ink, which may drip from the tube.>
10) Cap the heater OUT port under the Pressurized ink tank.
11) Cut the Ink circulation tube of the color of the Ink bus to replace, at the cut-mark line located above the ink
inlet port of the Negative pressure ink tank. <Refer to the photograph below.> Put a Cap on the Ink tube on
the Negative pressure ink tank where it is cut.
< Watch out for the ink, which may drip from the tube.>
Unplugged in step-(9)
Cut in step-(11)
12) Remove Ink circulation tubes out from the tube harness bands for easy tube removal from the machine.
13) Remove the Ink bus mounting screws. (IT screw 3x6 (2 pcs))
14) Remove the Ink bus together with the Ink circulation tubes.
Assembly Precautions
(1) Make sure that all the Print head tubes are firmly connected to the Print heads.
(2) Replace the 4 Drainage tubes, from the Heat exchanger, ti new tubes and make good Z-shaped bend to
prevent ink leakage.
(3) Cut the Ink circulation tube from the new Ink bus to the Negative pressure ink tank (attached on the new
Ink bus) at the Cut-mark line.
(4) Attach tube Joint (included in the Ink bus spare part kit) between the new Ink circulation tube on the Ink
bus (which was cut on above step-(3)) and the remaining existing tube on the Negative pressure ink
tank and Clip the tubes on the Joint.
<The Clips should face in the direction as shown on the photograph below.>
(5) Making sure that the Ink tubes are not tangled, run the tubes through the Tube harness bands.
<Refer to the photographs on the bottom>
Hook the Air tube of the Negative pressure ink tank through the Tube guide on the Ink supply unit tower.
<Refer to the photograph below>
(6) To prevent the Ink tubes from being unplugged accidentally when the Ink circulation tower is Opened or
Closed, check again the Ink tubing layout, as shown on the photograph below.
The YELLOW Ink tube from the Ink bus to the Negative pressure
ink tank should be in the front of all other 7 Ink tubes in this Tube
saddle band.
The same YELLOW Ink tube from the Ink bus to the Negative
pressure ink tank should have some slack (not tightly pulled)
when the Ink circulation tower is opened all the way wide.
Confirm that none of the Ink tubes twists when the Ink circulation
tower is closed.
(7) Follow the instruction on the Initial Ink Filling and fill the machine with the ink.
(8) Confirm that no ink leaks from the replaced Ink bus and the Ink tubes touched in this procedure.
Other Precautions
1) Make sure not to damage the Head drive PCBs during this work.
Scraping the back surface of the PCB against metal object will damage the PCB.
2) Do not damage the flexible wires of the Print heads when moving the Head drive PCB.
Ink bus
NOTE:
The photograph shows all the Ink tubes full of ink, but in actuality the ink tubes are all empty of ink, as ink drainage
procedure is done prior to this step.
This applies to all the photographs shown here after in this section.
7) Cut the 4 Ink tubes, which connects the Ink bus and Negative pressure ink tank, at the Cut-mark line above
the Negative ink tank. Cap the cut Ink tubes with the Caps included in the Ink circulation system spare part
kit.
The Air tubes of the Negative pressure ink tanks get in the
way, so unhook the Air tubes from the tube guide on the Ink
circulation unit tower and hang the Air tubes down.
8) Cut the 4 Ink supply tubes, running from the Ink supply valve to the Negative pressure ink tank at the Cut-
mark line above the Negative pressure ink tank. Cap the cut tubes with the Caps supplied in the spare parts
kit of the Ink supply unit.
< Be careful of the ink, which may drip from the cut ink tubes.>
9) Disconnect the wire harnesses connectors in the ink tower (the Pressurized ink tank and Negative pressure
ink tank Ink sensor connectors, Ink pump connectors, Overflow tank sensor connector, and Bellows sensor
connector).
10) Referring to the disassembly instructions for the overflow pan, remove the Overflow pan and allow all the ink
in the Overflow pan and waste ink tube to flow into the waste ink tank.
Reinstall the Overflow pan.
11) Use Scissor clamps to clamp the waste ink tube from the Cartridge holder pan (on the upstream of the 3-way
joint) and from the waste ink tank (on the downstream of the three-way joint). (2 tubes.)
12) Disconnect the waste ink tube from the overflow pan on the upstream side of the three-way joint.
Insert stoppers in the end of the disconnected tube and in the joint port.
13) Remove the 2 scissor clamps from the remaining waste ink tubes on the three-way joint.
14) Remove the entire Ink circulation system.
Assembly Precautions
1) Use four new Ink drainage tubes under the Heat exchanger (included in the kit) and fit the bottom ends over
the nipples on the Overflow pan. Make good Z-fold bend to prevent ink leakage.
2) Use four new Air tubes between the Negative pressure ink tanks and Common air chamber (included in the
kit).
3) Use new Air tube for the Bellows unit (included in the kit).
4) Connect Tube joints on the cut tubes (included in the kit).
<Straight joints are for the tubes to the ink supply.>
<Right-angled joints are for the tubes to the Ink bus.>
The right-angled joints should face in the direction as shown on the photograph below.
5) Making sure that the Ink tubes are not tangled, run the tubes through the Tube harness bands.
<Refer to the following photographs>
Hook the Air tubes of the Negative pressure ink tanks through the Tube guide on the Ink supply unit tower.
6) To prevent the Ink tubes from being unplugged accidentally when the Ink circulation tower is Opened or
Closed, check again the Ink tubing layout, as shown on the photograph below.
The YELLOW Ink tube from the Ink bus to the Negative pressure
ink tank should be in the front of all other 7 Ink tubes in this Tube
saddle band.
The same YELLOW Ink tube from the Ink bus to the Negative
pressure ink tank should have some slack (not tightly pulled)
when the Ink circulation tower is opened all the way wide.
Confirm that none of the Ink tubes twists when the Ink circulation
tower is closed.
C6
K6
C1
K1
C2
K2
K,Y & C,M C3
Position reference
K3
6) Disconnect the flexible cable from the stopper on the back of the head drive PCB.
When removing the Cyan and Black heads, disconnect the flexible cable on the left, and when removing the
Magenta and Yellow heads, disconnect the flexible cable on the right.
C1
K1
C2
K2
C3
K3
7) When removing the Cyan and Black heads, loosen the screw on the left head drive PCB, remove the entire
bracket, and hook it vertically against the head holder.
8) When removing the Magenta and Yellow heads, loosen the screw on the right Head drive PCB, remove the
entire bracket, and lay it over the left Head drive PCB. (IT screw 3x6 (3 pcs))
< Make sure to number each of the M and Y Flat cables use a felt-tip non-erasable marker pen. Do not use
any thing with hard-tip, such as ballpoint pen, etc. which damages the flat cable.>
M1
Y1
M2
Y2
M3
Y3
M6 M4
Y4
Y6 M5
Y5
M6
Y6
(1) Slide the tip of the PCB bracket into the hook.
9) Remove the Head adjust jig from the Head holder cover. (IT screw 3x6 (2 pcs))
10) Bring the two adjustment screws on the Head adjust jig to their neutral position.
1.4 mm
The neutral position for this adjustment screw is The neutral position for this adjustment screw is
where the screw extrudes approx. 0.6 mm down where the screw is turned two rotations up after the
from the bottom edge of the Head adjust jig collar of the screw touches the Head adjust jig.
11) Attach the Head adjust jig to the head. (IT screw 3x6 (2 pcs))
Note: Before removing the head, always attach the head adjust jig.
The actual instruction on how to use the head adjust jig is explained from the next page.
(Rear)
Print head
Plate spring
(Pushes head)
In contact
1 Mount the Head adjust jig against the Print head to be replaced.
2 Tighten the two screws of the Head adjust jig loosely. (IT screw 3x6 (2 pcs))
By pulling the Head ink tube lightly towards the direction of the arrow
mark makes it easier for the Head adjust jig to be set.
CAUTION:
The shoulder of the Adjusting screw should not ride on the Head adjust jig.
GOOD BAD
1
To hook the Plate spring:
The sketch does not show the Print head, but in actuality
there is a Print head against the Head adjust jig. (Rear)
Print head
12) Unplug the Flat cable of the Print head from the Head drive PCB.
13) Using two Scissor clamps, clamp the two Ink tubes going to the Print head from the Ink bus, for the Print head
to remove.
Clamp the Ink tubes in the area between the Print head and the Rib on the Ink hose assembly.
< Refer to the photograph below >
, Forgetting to clamp the Print head Ink tubes will cause cause the ink to drain down into the Negative pressure
ink tank and cause the Negative pressure ink tank to overflow.
Rib
Scissor clamps
Ink bus
Print head
Remove the two mounting screws of the Ink bus, which is interfering with the removal of the Print head.
Using the two black colored plastic Bands mounted on the machine frame, hook the hole of the Band on the
pin located on the under-surface of the Ink bus.
This procedure will pull the Ink bus away from the Print head and make the room to work.
plastic Band
Pin
Pin
14) Gently unplug the two Ink tubes from the Print head.
< The ink will start dripping from the Print head when the Ink tubes are unplugged. Watch out for the dripping
Ink from the Print head surface when removing the Print head.>
15) Unhook the Spring plate of the Head adjust jig from the Print head.
< The Spring plate can be unhooked easily from the Print head by sliding the Spring plate side-ways towards
the Lock release groove on the Head adjust jig.
16) Remove the Print head from the machine. (3x10 screws; 2 pcs)
1 Then gently slide the Print head towards the front of the machine to unlatch the Print head from the
rear adjusting screw of the Head adjust jig.
REAR FRONT
2 Lift the Print head horizontally up until the bracket on the Print head at the rear almost clears the
adjusting screw.
< The instruction continues to the next page >
REAR FRONT
3 Tilt the Print head towards the front and lift the rear to fully clear the rear adjusting screw.
FRONT
REAR
4 When the front portion of the Print head clears away from the Head adjust jig, gently lift the Print head
out of the machine.
FRONT
REAR
Refer to the next page for the important notes and instructions.
1) Mount the new Print head, and keep the Head adjust jig on the Print head.
2) Connect head ink tubes and remove the Scissor clamps.
3) Connect the Print head Flat cables onto the Head drive PCB and finish all the wire connection onto the Head
drive PCB.
4) Without putting on the Head holder cover, slide in the Upper transfer unit slowly, being careful not to catch the
Print head Flat cables.
5) Connect the Sensor bracket amount the bracket with the two screws.
6) Follow the Initial ink filling instruction given in this Chapter and fill the machine with the ink.
7) After the ink circulation is finished, lower the BP unit by test mode and confirm that no ink is leaking from the
replaced Print head by looking at the replaced Print head from underneath.
8) Start performing the automatic image adjustment using the HS4000 Scanner or Canon LiDE scanner in the
order given on the next Chapter in this technical manual.
9) After the Head angle adjustment and head position adjustment is finished, turn OFF the machine power and
remove the Head adjust jig from the Print head after removing necessary parts off the machine to access to
the Head adjust jig.
10) Mount back on the machine all the parts removed from the machine for the Head replacement.
11) Turn ON the machine and continue with the Image adjustment.
12) Make sure to change the Print head Voltage and AL number setting of the replaced Print head (Test Mode No.
442) in the 7th item to adjust in the Image adjustment procedure after replacing the Print head.
If removing both the left (Cyan/Black) and right (Magenta/Yellow) Head drive PCBs, it is best to remove the right
(Magenta/Yellow) Head drive PCB first.
1) Disconnect the Power cable connector and two white Flat cables from the Head drive PCB.
Power cable
connector
Flat cables
CAUTION:
Make sure to gently
unlock the Connector
lock before unplugging
each of the white Flat
cable.
2) Remove the mounting screws of the Head drive PCB bracket (the entire bracket; IT screw 3x6 (3 pcs)).
3) Slide the PCB over to the left and lay the PCB on top of the left Head drive PCB as shown on page 11A-59 of
this Chapter.
4) Make sure that all the Flat cables of the Print heads are numbered. If not, number all the Print head cables to
match with the head color and head location, referring to pages 11A-58 and 11A-59 of this Chapter.
Otherwise it will be difficult to find the correct location to pug in the Flat cables in assembly.
5) Remove all 12 Flat cables of the Print heads from the Magenta/Yellow Head drive PCB.
6) Remove the Magenta/Yellow Head drive PCB from the machine with the PCB bracket attached.
7) Remove the head drive PCB from the bracket. (IT screw 3x6 (6 pcs))
Precautions
1. Do not scrape the bottom surface of the Head drive PCB as the circuit is printed on the bottom.
2. Connect Flat cable of each Print head to the correct connectors on the Head drive PCB.
3. Unlock the Connector lock on the Head drive PCB when unplugging and pugging in the white Flat cables.
4. Make sure to lock the Connector lock on the Head drive PCB after the white Flat cables are inserted.
1) Make sure that all the Flat cables of the Print heads are numbered. If not, number all the Print head cables to
match with the head color and head location, referring to pages 11A-58 and 11A-59 of this Chapter.
Otherwise it will be difficult to find the correct location to pug in the Flat cables in assembly.
2) Disconnect the Power cable connector, two Flat cables and all 12 Print head Flat cables from the Cyan/Black
Head drive PCB.
Refer to the CAUTION stated on the previous page in unplugging both the two white Flat cables and Print
head Flat cables.
3) Loosen the screws and remove the head drive PCB (the entire bracket). (IT screw 3x6 (4 pcs))
4) Remove the head drive PCB from the bracket. (IT screw 3x6 (6 pcs))
Precautions
1. Do not scrape the bottom surface of the Head drive PCB as the circuit is printed on the bottom.
2. Connect Flat cable of each Print head to the correct connectors on the Head drive PCB.
3. Unlock the Connector lock on the Head drive PCB when unplugging and pugging in the white Flat cables.
4. Make sure to lock the Connector lock on the Head drive PCB after the white Flat cables are inserted.
8) Remove the Overflow tank mounting screws. (IT screw 3x6 (2 pcs))
9) Disengage the hook(s) where the Negative pressure ink tank common air chamber is mounted.
10) Remove the Overflow pan. Tilt it to drain remaining ink into the Waste ink tank.
Note: Remember to drain the remaining ink. If the ink is not drained, it may spill out.
Note: Alternatively, you can use the drainage tube (3 mm dia.) on the bottom of the overflow pan to drain the
ink into an empty plastic bottle or other container.
11) Use two Scissor clamps to clamp the ends of the three-way joint of the waste ink tube. (Clamp the tube on the
side that flows to the Waste ink tank and the tube that comes down from the Ink cartridge holder.)
Then from the three-way joint, unplug the tube coming down from the Overflow pan and cap the port on the
three-way port and unplugged tube with rubber cap. (Rubber caps are supplied with the new Overflow pan.)
Three-way joint Cap the port and tube after unplugging the Tube.
Assembly Precautions
1) At the markings on the Ink drainage tube, 75mm and 290mm from where the tube connects to the Overflow
pan, fix the Ink drainage tube on metal brackets on the machine with plastic bands as shown on the sketch
below.
The tube goes over the metal bracket and held by plastic band.
The tube goes under the metal bracket and held by plastic band.
2) Using the new tubes supplied with the new Overflow pan, replace the tubes on the machine.
• Ink drainage tubes under the Heat exchanger tower. (4 pcs)
• Air tube between the Common air chamber and Air valve of the Negative pressure ink tank. (1 pc)
• Air tube of the Bellows unit. (1 pc)
3) With all the removed parts and components assembled back on the machine, fill the machine with the ink
following the instruction give on the “Initial Ink filling” in this Chapter.
Screw
Screw
Screw Screw
Screw Screw
6) Disconnect the Pressurized ink tank air valve tube (between the valve and pressurized ink tank), on the
Pressurized ink tank side.
7) Disconnect the Pressurized ink tank air valve tube (between the Air valve and Overflow pan), on the Overflow
pan side.
Connector
Caution in Assembly
1) Do not forget to mount the Air filter on the Pressurized ink tank air valve.
2) The connector of the Pressurized ink tank air valve should be connected to the socket labelled “K”.
3) Using the new tubes supplied with the new Pressurized ink tank air valve, replace the tubes on the machine.
• Ink drainage tubes under the Heat exchanger tower. (4 pcs)
• Air tube between the Common air chamber and Air valve of the Negative pressure ink tank. (1 pc)
• Air tube of the Bellows unit. (1 pc)
4) The metal Clip on the Air tube, between the Pressurized ink tank air valve and Common air chamber, should
face down at the tube connection on the Common air chamber.
5) With all the removed parts and components assembled back on the machine, fill
the machine with the ink following the instruction give on the “Initial Ink filling” in this
Chapter.
Draining the ink from the Ink circulation unit is not required when replacing the Negative pressure ink tank
air valve.
< This is because the Negative pressure ink tank air valve is already OPENED when the machine power is OFF.>
1) Remove the Left and Right Top covers, Rear cover, and Right-side cover.
2) Open the Power supply unit, Engine control PCB, and Ink supply unit.
3) Disconnect the Air tube, between the Negative pressure ink tank air valve and the Negative pressure ink tank
common air chamber, from the Common air chamber port.
4) Remove the connector.
5) Remove the mounting screws of the Negative pressure ink tank air valve and remove the Valve. (IT screw 3x4
(2 pcs))
Remove in Step-(5)
Air valve for the Negative
pressure ink tank
Caution in Assembly
1) The Wire harness for the Connector of the Negative pressure ink tank air valve should go from under the Wire
saddle to the connector port.
2) The connector of the Negative pressure ink tank air valve should be connected to the socket labelled “F”.
Wire saddle
2-23. Left and Right Wire Units, and Black and White Torque Limiters
1) Open the right and left front covers.
2) Remove the center and right inner covers, the right side cover, the ejection cover, the left and right top covers,
and the rear cover. (Refer to the section on covers in Chapter 2.)
3) Remove the operation panel (the entire bracket; round tip IT3C screw 4x8 (3 pcs)) and rest it on the left side
of the ink cartridge unit.
4) Confirm that the maintenance unit is under the head holder. If it is not, bring the maintenance unit under the
head holder.
5) Manually lower the BP unit to the lower limit position. Make the wires slack until they can be removed from the
BP unit.
Note: If the BP unit is not lowered, it will drop when the elevating unit is removed.
6) Remove the wires from the BP unit wire hooks (in 4 positions).
7) Remove the head holder cover. (Follow steps 5)–8) in "Removing the Head Holder Cover.")
8) Unlock the two flexible cable connectors of the head drive PCB, and then remove the FFC connectors (4 pcs).
9) Remove the two connectors from the head drive PCB.
8)
9)
10) Remove the 12 print head FPCs on the magenta-yellow side of the head drive PCB.
<< Make sure to number the PFCs (flat cables) as described on page 11A-59.>>
Note: When pulling out PFCs, avoid tilting it to the left or right side, which may damage the slot on the board.
Pull the PFCs straight out.
11) Loosen the mounting screws on the magenta-yellow head drive PCB. Place this board above the cyan-black
head drive PCB.
12) Remove the magenta-yellow side of the head drive PCB (the entire bracket).
13) Remove the 12 print head FPCs on the cyan-black side of the head drive PCB.
<< Make sure to number the PFCs (flat cables) as described on page 11A-58.>>
14) Loosen the mounting screws on the cyan-black side of the head drive PCB. Remove the board (the entire
bracket).
15) Put the controller PCB box in maintenance position. (Refer to the section on covers in Chapter 2.)
16) Remove the paper elevation motor. (Refer to paper transfer section information in Chapter 8.)
17) Remove the stay plate next to the paper elevation unit. (IT screw 4x8 (2 pcs))
Stay plate
18) Remove the paper elevation unit. (Refer to paper transfer section information in Chapter 8.)
19) Remove the right head holder cover. (IT screw 3x6 (6 pcs))
20) Remove the screw on the front of the cyan ink bus, loosen the screw on the back, and move the ink bus out of
the way (IT screw 3x6 (2 pcs)). Remove the wire cover on the left and right.
Wire cover
Wire cover
22) Remove the spring attached to the loose wire detection plate of the head holder.
Loose wire
detection
plate
23) Remove the clip on the support shaft of the loose wire detection plate, and then remove the detection plate.
24) Lay a sheet of paper by the harness hole under the pulley for winding the wire on the paper feed side. (This is
a precaution against dropping the parallel pin of the wire shaft.)
Note: After removing the wire unit, also remove the paper.
Wire-winding
pulley
25) Following the disassembly instructions for the BP elevation motor, remove the BP unit elevating unit.
26) Remove the clip on the paper feed side of the elevation wire shaft. (1 pc)
Note: Rotate the shaft so that the C-shaped plate securing the elevation wire shaft and black torque limiter
faces the screw side.
27) Remove the C-shaped plates (in 2 positions on the left and right).
Note: This task is easier if you remove the ink bus mounting screw and move the ink bus out of the way a little.
28) Remove the E-ring (one 6 mm dia. E-ring) on the paper feed side of the elevation wire shaft. Remove the
elevation wire shaft from the head holder.
29) Remove the wire-winding pulley for the black and white torque limiters.
Note: Be careful not to drop the three parallel pins that are engaged in the elevation wire shaft.
Note: Be careful about screw length when attaching the wire holder guide. Screws longer than the specified
length will interfere with the paper position detection unit.
31) Pull out the wire from the gap adjuster (in 4 positions).
32) Remove the wire unit.
Installation Precautions
Note: Install the wire unit with wire completely pulled out from the wire-winding pulley.
Note: Install the torque limiter after rotating it so that the rectangular peg and parallel pin groove are
perpendicular, as shown. As a way to make them perpendicular, insert the torque limiter in the elevation
wire shaft (in which the parallel pin is inserted), and, as shown, rotate the shaft so that the torque limiter
peg lies on the same plane as the screw hole.
Approx. 90º
Peg
Torque Limiter
Screw hole
Front
Rear
Stay plate
10) Remove the paper elevation unit. (Refer to paper transfer section information in Chapter 8.)
11) Remove the elevating unit cover. (IT screw 3x6 (1 pcs))
Connector
Belt platen
Elevating unit
13) Remove the BP unit elevating unit screw, pull out the shaft for manually raising and lowering from the shaft
holder, and remove the BP unit elevating unit from the head holder. (IT screw 3x6 (2 pcs))
14) Remove the BP elevation motor from the BP unit elevating unit. (IT screw 3x6 (4 pcs))
2-27. KG Roller
1) Turn OFF the machine power, unplug the power cord and open the right and left front covers.
2) Remove the center inner cover. (Refer to the section on covers in Chapter 2.)
3) Manually lower the BP unit to the lower limit position.
4) Unhook the KG Roller from the KG Base Bar in the front, and gently pull out the KG Roller out of the machine.
KG Base Bar
KG roller
Assembly Precautions
Insert the rear tip of the KG Roller into the rear KG Base Bar first, and then clip on the front tip of the KG Roller into
the front KG Base Bar.
3. Adjustment
Image Adjustment
Refer to Chapter 11B for the details on the ComColor image adjustment.
MEMO
Contents
1. Image Adjustment........................................................................................................11B-2
1-1. Adjustment Items.............................................................................................. 11B-2
1-2. Required Tools and Instruments....................................................................... 11B-3
1-3. Basic operation of the Automatic Image Adjustment........................................ 11B-3
1-4. Cautions before starting the Image Adjustment................................................ 11B-3
1-5. Print Head Replacement Procedure................................................................. 11B-4
1-6. Image Adjustment Procedure........................................................................... 11B-4
1-7. Print Head Adjustment Jig................................................................................ 11B-4
1-8. Order of Adjustment.......................................................................................... 11B-5
1-9. Paper Size........................................................................................................ 11B-6
1-10. Image Adjustment Parameter Charts.............................................................. 11B-7
1-11. Necessary Adjustments for the Parts Replaced............................................ 11B-10
1-12. Image Adjustment Prints............................................................................... 11B-11
1-13. Relation Between Test Mode No. 435 & No.437........................................... 11B-13
3. Mechanical Adjustments...........................................................................................11B-16
3-1. Head Angle Adjustment (Test Mode No. 423)................................................ 11B-16
3-2. Head Position Adjustment (Test Mode No. 424)............................................ 11B-18
3-3. Transfer Belt Direction Adjustment (Test Mode No. 421)............................... 11B-20
3-4. Registration Roller Direction Adjustment (Test Mode No. 422)...................... 11B-23
4. Automatic Image Adjustments.................................................................................11B-26
4-1. Print Timing Rough Adjustment (Test Mode No. 420).................................... 11B-26
4-2. Print Timing Fine Adjustment (Test Mode No. 425)....................................... 11B-27
4-3. Overlap Adjustment (Test Mode No. 426)...................................................... 11B-28
4-4. Head Replacement Parameter (Test Mode No. 442)..................................... 11B-29
4-5. Head Density Adjustment (Test Mode No. 427)............................................. 11B-30
4-6. Head Edge Density Adjustment (Test Mode No. 443)................................... 11B-31
4-7. Image Elongation Adjustment (Test Mode No. 433)...................................... 11B-33
1. Image Adjustment
<Independent Adjustment>, when mentioned on below chart, refers to those adjustments, which do not require
another adjustment to be done together in given order.
Head Angle Adjustment 423 To adjust the Print head position right angle to the flow of the paper.
Head Position Adjustment 424 To adjust the Print head position against the adjacent Print heads.
Transfer Belt Direction Adj. 421 To adjust the Transfer belt position against the Print Head carriage.
Registration Roller Direction Adj. 422 Adjust the Registration roller position against the Transfer belt.
Print Timing Rough Adjustment 420 Rough adjustment of the Print timing.
Print Timing Fine Adjustment 425 Fine adjustment of the Print timing.
Overlap Width Adjustment 426 Adjusts the Ink drop range of each Print Head.
Head Density Adjustment 427 Adjusts the Print density against the adjacent Print Heads.
Head Edge Density Adjustment 443 Adjusts the Print density of the edge (approx. 0.5mm) of the Print Heads.
Image Elongation Adjustment 433 Adjusts the Elongation/Shrinkage of the printed image. <Independent Adjustment>
Leading Edge Position Adj. 428 Adjusts the print Start position. <Independent Adjustment>
Trailing Edge Position Adj. 428 Adjusts the print Stop position. <Independent Adjustment>
Side Mask Adjustment 432 Adjusts the Side Margin amount. <Independent Adjustment>
X-direction Adjustment 435 Adjusts the Ink drop position for each color against the Black ink.
Y-direction Adjustment 436 Adjusts the Lateral ink drop position for all the colors.
Overlap Amount Adjustment 437 Adjusts the Overlap amount between the adjacent heads of each color.
Density Compensation 438 Compensates the print density between the adjacent heads of each color.
Head Replace Parameter 442 Input the Voltage and AL parameters of the newly replaced Print Heads.
Parameter Save 440 Copies the Image adjustment settings from the Engine PCB onto the HDD as backup.
Parameter Retrieve 441 Retrieves the Image adjustment settings from the HDD back onto the Engine PCB.
Re-writes the Image adjustment parameters onto the Factory default data saving
Adjustment Parameter Save 1497
area on the Engine PCB.
In general, the adjustments are done in the order of Print Timing → Overlap → Density adjustment.
Head Angle Adjustment (Test Mode No. 423) image prior to the start of the
Test Mode No. 423 [Head
Angle Adjustment], will provide
a rough view of the mounted
angle, lateral and vertical
position, as well as the X
Head Position Adjustment (Test Mode No. 424) and Y printing position of the
replaced Print Head(s).
This will aid in making the
actual adjustment.
Print Timing Fine Adjustment (TM 425) Trailing Edge Position Adj. (TM 428)
Overlap Width Adjustment (TM 426) Side Mask Adjustment (TM 432)
Head Edge Density Adjustment (TM 443) Head Edge Density Adjustment (TM 443)
Print the Head Maintenance Print (TM 404) and confirm that the image is good.
< A3/Ledger size Matte Paper on External Paper Feed Tray.>
Activate Test Mode No. 440 and make backup of the adjustment in HDD.
Re-write the Image adjustment parameters onto the Factory default data saving
area on the Engine PCB (Test Mode No. 1497).
2. Use ComColor dedicated Matte Paper for the adjustment. Using inappropriate type of paper will cause the
image adjustment to end in error.
442 Head Replace Parameter < Paper not needed > Auto & Manual
Note:
Paper orientation A4, A3, Letter = short edge feed.
Paper orientation A4R, Letter-R = A4 & Letter rotated = long edge feed.
[ 11B-7 ]
Transfer belt 4 mm gap Print => Scan
1 scale [+] = rotate to
direction 421 0 0 0 -15 scales +15 scales - and open => Manually
(=0.032mm) CCW direction.
adjustment the scanner adjust.
cover.
Make 3 to
Registration Use 4 mm gap Print =>Scan
Mechanical Adjustment
Within Within [+] = make the
direction 422 0 -1mm +1mm thickness - and open =>Manually
-0.1mm +0.1mm gap smaller.
adjustment gauge. the scanner adjust.
cover.
No gap and
Print timing Print => Scan
close the
rough 420 - - - _ _ - - 1 to 2 => Self
scanner
adjustment adjusting
cover
Make 3 to
Print 4 mm gap Print => Scan
timing fine 425 - - - - - - - 4 to 5 and open => Self
Ink Flow Section: Image Adjustment
[ 11B-8 ]
442 - - - 1400 3100 1 - - - correct print
parameter
head position
(Voltage)
Head
Select the
replace
442 - - - 0 5 1 - - - correct print
parameter
head position
(AL No.)
No gap and
Head No Print => Scan
Make 3 to
Image No Print => Scan
4 mm gap
elongation 433 - - - - - => Self
Selection and open the
adjustment adjusting.
scanner cove
Trailing edge Sensor 1 = -100 Sensor 1 = +100 1 (=0.1mm) [+] = Less Botton If margin not found,
position 428 0.5 mm -0.5 mm +0.5 mm increase margin, then
adjustment Sensor 2 = -70 Sensor 2 = +70 1 mm = 10 margin adjust.
Side mask 1 (=0.1mm) [+] = More Side Adjust both the left &
432 0.5 mm -0.5 mm +0.5 mm -100 +100
adjustment 1 mm = 10 margin right.
[ 11B-9 ]
Use Black (K) as
X-direction -4230 +4230 1 (=1 um)
435 0 mm -1 dot +1 dot [+] = Left reference position.
adjustment (=50 dot) (=50 dot) 1 mm = 1000
1 Dot = approx. 85
Test BP BP Regist-
BP BP BP
Adjustments Mode
motor unit unit
belt enco- ration Guide Print
No. fan der roller roller head
1540
Test mode 1540 & 1447 1447 - 5 - 4 - 2 - 3
The numbers in the ( ) parenthesis represent Manual image adjustments which would replace the
Automatic image adjustments.
Pay attention on which side of the prints are the TOP as referred by how the paper came out on the Paper
Receiving Tray.
The TOP side of the prints must be known in order that the prints can be scanned correctly.
If by some reason, which way the prints came out on the Paper Receiving Tray is forgotten, refer to the following
major sample prints indicating which side is the TOP.
As stated on top of this page, some of the prints may not apply on the specific machine that you are working on.
< Cyan colored dots indicates the TOP of the print >
< Black colored dots indicates the TOP of the print >
< Black colored dots indicates the TOP of the print >
[ This image is mainly for Inch Size Paper machines.]
< Small solid square indicates the TOP of the print >
1) Test Mode No. 435 [X-Direction Adjustment] input parameter range changes in accordance with the Test
Mode No. 437 [Overlap Amount Adjustment] parameter input.
2) Test Mode No. 437 [Overlap Amount Adjustment] input parameter range changes in accordance with the
Test Mode No. 435 [X-Direction Adjustment] parameter input.
What is important here is that if a replaced Print Head mounted on the machine, too far off from its
original position, is adjusted by TM435 [X-Direction Adjustment] using too large of a parameter input
number in order to move the print image closer to that of the adjacent Print Head, may cause loss of all
the overlaps between all the Print Heads of all the color whenTM437 [Overlap Adjustment] is accessed.
If this happens, the mounting position of the Print Head in question should be physically (mechanically)
readjusted to a location closer to the adjacent Print Head in order to bring down the X-Direction adjustment
parameter numbers on TM435 to enable smaller number input by TM437 to increase the overlap amount.
TM437
TM435
TM435
+65 is the largest parameter
on TM435, so the minimum
possible parameter setting that can
be input on TM437 is +66.
The maximum possible parameter
setting that can be input on TM437
is +3000.
3. Mechanical Adjustments
Print out the specified Test Mode images and scan the printouts.
The machine calculates the parameters from the scanned data and instructs the mechanical adjustment value.
Adjustment Steps:
1. Print the image by test mode No. 423.
2. Scan the printed image with 3mm to 4mm space from the HS4000 scanner table edges, and scanner cover
open.
3. Print the calculated parameter.
4. Turn OFF the machine power and make the adjustment using the Head jig.
< Refer to Chapter 11A for the usage of the Print head jig.>
Adjustment Target = 0
Allowable Range = -1 to +1
Adjustable Step = 1/8 rotations
Adjustment Direction = [+] Clockwise direction (CW)
[--] Counter-Clockwise direction (CCW)
HS4000
scanner table glass.
The print heads are counted from the rear. Parameter print sample
423 HEAD ANGLE ADJUST
Head Jig
Head Jig on Print Head
Print Heads
paper feed direction
Printing Paper
Adjusted
Adjustment Steps:
1. Print the image by test mode No. 424.
2. Scan the printed image with 3mm to 4mm space from the HS4000 scanner table edges, and scanner cover
open.
3. Print the calculated parameter.
4. Turn OFF the machine power and make the adjustment using the Head jig.
< Refer to Chapter 11A for the usage of the Print head jig.>
Adjustment Target = 0
Allowable Range = -1 to +1
Adjustable Range = -0.5 mm / +0.5 mm
Adjustable Step = 1/8 rotations
Adjustment Direction = [+] Clockwise direction (CW)
[--] Counter-Clockwise direction (CCW)
HS4000
scanner table glass.
The print heads are counted from the rear. Parameter print sample
424 HEAD POSITION ADJUSTMENT
Head Jig
Head Jig on Print Head
Print heads
Paper feed direction
Adjusted
Adjustment Steps:
1. Print the image by test mode No. 421.
2. Scan the printed image with 3mm to 4mm space from the HS4000 scanner table edges, and scanner cover
open.
3. Print out or write down the displayed parameter after scanning.
The printout only prints the parameter as displayed on the operation panel, so printing out is not really required.
4. Using the test mode, or by manually (after turning the machine power OFF), lower the Transfer belt down.
5. Making sure that the machine power is OFF, make the adjustment as per described on the next page.
< Caution: Proper adjustment cannot be made unless the Transfer belt is lowered down, out of the positioning pin
located under the print head carriage. >
Adjustment Target = 0
Paper Orientation on ComColor External Paper Feed Tray: Allowable Range = 0
ComColor 9050/7050/7010 Adjustable Range =
A3, A4R (long edge feed) or Letter (short edge feed) -15 scale / +15 scale
ComColor 3050/3010 Adjustable Step = 1 scale = 0.032 mm
A4 (short edge feed) or Letter (short edge feed) Adjustment Direction =
[+] Counter-Clockwise direction (CCW)
[--] Clockwise direction (CW)
3mm to 4mm
HS4000
scanner table glass.
Transfer belt
Adjusted
Registration roller
[ 11B-20 ] x1 series ComColor (Revision 1.1)
Ink Flow Section: Image Adjustment
Instruction:
1. Lower the Transfer belt (BP Unit).
Proper adjustment cannot be made unless the Transfer belt is lowered down, out of the positioning pin
located under the print head carriage, as the positioning pin will hit on the Transfer belt unit.
2. Loosen the center screw, as indicated on the top photograph.
3. Rotate the Hex head shaft to make the adjustment. The white plastic arm will rotate together.
Align the center dip on the white plastic arm against the scale line. Long scale lines exist after every four short
scale lines. There are total of 30 scale lines.
4. Paper ejection side of the Transfer belt will swing to the back when the Hex head shaft is rotated to the right.
The unit will swing to the front when the Hex head shaft is rotated to the left.
Refer to the next page for the sketches showing the Transfer belt swing direction in accordance with the Hex
head shaft turning direction.
Refer to the parameters displayed on the operation panel for the amount of the scale notches the white plastic
arm should swing.
5. After the adjustment is made, tighten the center screw which was loosened in step-2 of this instruction to
complete the adjustment.
The following sketches are view from the top, looking down on the Transfer belt.
When the parameter is (-) number. When the parameter is (+) number.
If the Hex head shaft is rotated If the Hex head shaft is rotated
to the right (clockwise), the to the left (counterclockwise),
Transfer belt will swing in the the Transfer belt will swing in
direction shown below. the direction shown below.
Adjustment Steps:
1. Print the image by test mode No. 422.
2. Scan the printed image with 3mm to 4mm space from the HS4000 scanner table edges, and scanner cover
open.
3. Print out or write down the displayed parameter after scanning.
The printout only prints the parameter as displayed on the operation panel, so printing out is not really required.
4. Using the test mode, or by manually (after turning the machine power OFF), lower the Transfer belt down.
5. Making sure that the machine power is OFF, make the adjustment as per described on the next page.
[ + ] number on the parameter reading indicates that the Gap should be decreased. (+) = Decrease gap.
[ - ] number on the parameter reading indicates that the Gap should be increased. (--) = Increase gap.
Adjustment Target = 0
Allowable Range = -0.1 mm to +0.1 mm
Adjustable Range = -1 mm / +1 mm
Adjustable Step = Use thickness gauge (feeler gauge)
Adjustment Direction = [+] Reduce the gap
[--] Widen the gap
HS4000
scanner table glass.
Procedure:
1. Making sure that the machine power is OFF, make the following adjustment.
2. Using a thickness gauge, measure the present gap. <Let’s say that the present gap is 1.0mm for the
explanation to follow.>
3. Loosen the two screws, as shown on the photograph above.
The adjusting mechanism includes a spring. When the two screws are loosened, the loosened plate is pulled by
the spring and the gap becomes 0 mm. (The plate slides to the right and touches against the
round disc.)
Pushing the plate (indicated by light-blue on the above photograph) to the left will increase the gap.
4. Pretending that the existing gap before the adjustment was 1.0mm, the parameter reading on the sample
parameter reading (previous page) was +0.2 mm, so the adjustment to make is to insert 0.8 mm thick thickness
gauge in the area-to-adjust to make the gap 0.8 mm. (1.0 - 0.2 mm = 0.8 mm gap)
5. While the thickness gauge is inserted keeping the gap at 0.8 mm, tighten the two screws.
< If the adjustment parameter reading was a (--) number, the gap should be increased for that amount. >
6. Remove the thickness gauge to complete the adjustment.
Spring
The GAP
The relationship between the Registration roller position adjustment and the paper skew direction.
When the plate is slid to the left (When the operator side of the Registration roller is shifted to the left).
When the plate is slid to the right (When the operator side of the Registration roller is shifted to the right).
E R
PAP > The paper feeds through under the print
ire ction
ed D heads with the leading edge of paper skewed
< Fe
towards the back (away from the operator).
Print out the specified Test Mode images and scan the printouts.
The machine calculates the parameters from the scanned data and automatically revises the test mode setting
within the machine by itself.
Some of the test mode settings need to have the serviceman enter the parameter selections.
Adjustment Steps:
1. Print the image by test mode No. 420.
< Select either 1 or 2 prints on the LCD display before pressing the Print button on the display.>
2. Scan the printed image edge to edge against the HS4000 scanner table edges (no space), and scanner cover
closed.
3. Close the test mode after the specified number of the prints are scanned.
< Since the machine takes only the average of the number of prints scanned, it does not matter which prints are
scanned first when quantity of 2 prints are selected on the LCD panel.>
No space
HS4000
scanner table glass.
Adjustment Steps:
1. Print the image by test mode No. 425.
< Select either 4 or 5 prints on the LCD display before pressing the Print button on the display.>
2. Scan the printed image with 3mm to 4mm space from the HS4000 scanner table edges, and scanner cover
open.
3. Close the test mode after the specified number of the prints are scanned.
< Since the machine takes only the average of the number of prints scanned, it does not matter which prints are
scanned first.>
HS4000
scanner table glass.
Row 1 Row 2 Row 3 Row 4 Row 5 Row 6 Row 1 Row 2 Row 3 Row 4 Row 5 Row 6
ADJUSTMENT
Adjustment Steps:
1. Print the image by test mode No. 426.
< Select either 4 or 5 prints on the LCD display before pressing the Print button on the display.>
2. Scan the printed image with 3mm to 4mm space from the HS4000 scanner table edges, and scanner cover
open.
3. Close the test mode after the specified number of the prints are scanned.
< Since the machine takes only the average of the number of prints scanned, it does not matter which prints are
scanned first.>
3mm to 4mm
HS4000
scanner table glass.
Too much overlap between the two print heads, resulting in a vertical dark line.
Adjustment
Proper overlap amount between the two print heads, resulting in a smooth even solid color.
Adjustment Steps:
1. Activate test mode No. 442.
2. Push the correct print head color button on the LCD display panel.
< K = Black, C = Cyan, M = Magenta, Y = Yellow >
3. Push the correct position of the print head.
< 1 = No.1 print head, 2 = No.2 print head, 3 = No.3 print head, 4 = No.4 print head, 5 = No.5 print head,
6 = No.6 print head. > [No.1 & No.6 print heads do not exist on ComColor models 3050 and 3010.]
4. Input the correct AL parameters for the specific print head.
One head has two AL parameter numbers, since one 300 dpi print head = two 150 dpi print heads put together.
5. Input the correct Voltage parameters for the specific print head.
One head has two Voltage numbers, since one 300 dpi print head = two 150 dpi print heads put together.
6. Press the OK button on the LCD panel display to set the newly input parameters onto the machine to
complete this test mode.
No printing / No scanning
Adjustment Steps:
1. Activate test mode No. 427 and press the Print button on the LCD display panel.
< Only 1 sheet is printed.>
2. Scan the printed image edge to edge against the HS4000 scanner table edges (no space), and scanner cover
closed.
3. After the scanning, if the LCD display indicates OK in the bottom box, close the test mode to finish the
adjustment. If NG is displayed in the box, repeat the test mode adjustment until OK is displayed.
No space
Test pattern print sample
TOP
< Scanner Rear >
No space
Printed Image Top
HS4000
scanner table glass.
When NG is displayed, the test mode adjustment still When OK is displayed, the head density adjustment
need to be repeated. Each time the test mode is is completed.
repeated, the machine keeps on adjusting the print Close the test mode to complete this adjustment.
density.
When the correct adjustment result is achieved, the
machine automatically changes to display OK, as per
photograph on the right.
Adjustment Steps:
1. Activate test mode No. 443.
2. Start by selecting black color (K).
3. Press Print button on the LCD display.
< Only 1 sheet for the selected color is printed.>
4. On the printed image, select the best Head edge density by making a mark on the sheet.
The prints will not be scanned, so any kind of marking is OK. The marking will be for your reference only.
< Refer to the sketch on the next page for the sample view of the printed image. >
5. The selection is from 1 to 20. For each overlap column printed, select the one which shows the least binding
line in the center. Too light (white line) or too dark (dark line) is not good.
< This test mode is not adjusting the overlap amount. It is to adjust the darkness of the overlapped area.>
6. After selecting the best overlap area density, input the selected numbers and press OK button.
7. Then activate this Test Mode No.443 and proceed to the next color and repeat the process until all four colors
are finished.
Press the box for the overlap area 1 (between head No.1 & No.2)
and highlight the box.
Then using the UP/DOWN scroll key on the LCD display or using
the number keys on the operation panel, input the number you
selected referring to the print.
After all the boxes are filled, press the OK button on the LCD
display panel.
Enter into test mode No. 443 again and then repeat the procedure
for the Cyan (C), Magenta (M) and Yellow (Y).
TOP
1
Input the selected numbers in the LCD
2 display boxes.
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
BOTTOM
If images with either all white lines in the center or all dark lines in the center
are printed out, end the Test Mode No. 443 and redo Test Mode No. 437
Manual Overlap Adjustment, and then come back to Test Mode No.443.
Adjustment Steps:
1. Activate test mode No. 433 and press the Print button on the LCD display panel.
< Only 1 sheet is printed.>
2. Scan the printed image with 3mm to 4mm space from the HS4000 scanner table edges, and scanner cover
open.
3. The adjustment is automatically done by scanning, so close the test mode after the printed image is scanned.
HS4000
scanner table glass.
5-1. Print Start and End Position Adjustment (Test Mode No. 428)
< Leading Edge Print Start Position Adjustment >
<Trailing Edge Print End Position Adjustment >
Explanation:
This test mode adjusts the Leading edge print start position and Trailing edge print end position.
The adjustment is made in relation with the Top Edge Sensor 1 and Top Edge Sensor 2.
Unless this adjustment is done correctly, the ink will be dropped before the paper or after the paper, resulting in ink
landing on the Transfer belt.
[Sensor 1] = Top Edge Sensor 1, [Sensor 2] = Top Edge Sensor 2.
The adjustment of the Top and Trailing End of [Sensor 1] must be completed before going into [Sensor 2]
adjustment.
Adjustment Steps:
1. Activate Test Mode No. 428 and press the Proof button on the LCD panel for the [Sensor 1].
Refer to the sample printout attached on the next page for the adjustment parameters.
2. First, enter the parameter for the Top print position.
Press the Proof button, measure the printout and confirm that the adjustment is made correctly.
If not, repeat with this parameter input until the correct measurement is obtained.
When correctly adjusted, press the OK button on top of the LCD display panel.
3. Then go to the Trailing end mask length adjustment. Enter the necessary parameter and press the Proof
button for the [Sensor 1]. Measure the printout and confirm that the adjustment is made correctly.
If not, repeat with this parameter input until the correct measurement is obtained.
When correctly adjusted, press the OK button on top of the LCD display panel.
4. After the above is completed, go to the [Sensor 2] adjustment and repeat the same procedure.
Adjustment Target:
Top Print Position = 5 mm from the leading edge of the paper to the printed horizontal line.
< Increasing the number will increase the gap distance. Decreasing the number will decrease the gap distance.>
Trailing End Mask Length = 0.5 mm from the end tip of the 4 color lines and the trailing edge of the paper.
< Increasing the number will decrease the gap distance. Decreasing the number will increase the gap distance.>
Adjusting Units: 1 = 0.1 mm
BOTTOM
white margin
0.5 mm
Adjustment Steps:
1. Activate Test Mode No. 432 and press the Proof button on the LCD panel.
2. By adjusting the position of the printed black line will automatically adjusts the side mask margin for the
remaining colors, C, M and Y.
3. Measure the left and right white margin on the print. There should be 0.5 mm white margin from the edge of
the paper to the start of the black line.
Refer to the sample printout attached on the bottom of this page.
4. If the measurement is larger or less than 0.5 mm, make adjustment by changing the parameter on the
highlighted box.
5. Press the Proof button and measure the margin again, If the margin is not 0.5 mm, repeat the process.
6. Press the OK button when both the left and right margin are adjusted correctly.
Left Right
Plus (+) number increases the margin.
+ +
Minus (-) number decreases the margin
_ _
< Adjusting Units: 1 = 0.1 mm >
Adjustment Steps:
1. Activate Test Mode No. 435 and press the Proof button on the LCD panel.
2. Check the printout and confirm that no space exists between the Black and other 3 colors (C,M,Y).
3. To make the adjustment, highlight the box for the specific head and type in the new parameter number.
Plus (+) number moves the print position to the left. Minus (-) number moves the image to the right.
Increment of 1 moves the print position 0.001 mm. Example: 1000 moves the print position 1 mm.
4. After the parameter input is done, press the Proof button to check the result. Repeat the process if necessary.
5. Press the OK button to end the adjustment.
Adjustment Steps:
1. Activate Test Mode No. 436 and press the Proof button on the LCD panel.
2. Check the printout and confirm that Black, Cyan, Magenta and Yellow (K, C, M, Y) lines up straight in horizontal
direction. Refer to the sample printout on the next page.
3. To make the adjustment, highlight the box for the specific head and type in the new parameter number.
Plus (+) number moves the print position down. Minus (-) number moves the image up.
Increment of 1 moves the print position 0.0026 mm. Example: 378 moves the print position 1 mm.
4. After the parameter input is done, press the Proof button to check the result. Repeat the process if necessary.
5. Press the OK button to end the adjustment.
Paper Orientation on ComColor External Paper Feed Tray:
ComColor 9050/7050/7010
A3, A4R (long edge feed) or Letter-R (long edge feed)
ComColor 3050/3010
A4 (short edge feed) or Letter (short edge feed)
Explanation:
Two 150 dpi heads are combined in offset position
to make one 300 dpi Print Head.
If the ink is dropped on correct timing from both of
the 150 dpi heads, a straight line is printed for that
Print Head. If the ink drop timing is off between the
two, two separate lines are printed. In that case, the
correction is made by using the AB Control button.
Example:
M1: No.6 Head = - 95 < Good >
If changed to
< Not Good >
M1: No.6 Head = -195
M2: No.6 Head = - 22
Enlarged
K
K/C
K/M
K/Y
Adjustment Steps:
1. Activate Test Mode No. 437 and press the Proof button on the LCD panel.
2. Check the printout and confirm the overlap amount for the each color.
3. To make the adjustment, highlight the box for the specific head and type in the new parameter number.
Plus (+) number reduces the overlap. Minus (-) number increases the overlap.
Increment of 1 changes the overlap amount 0.001 mm. Example: 1000 changes the overlap amount 1 mm .
4. After the parameter input is done, press the Proof button to check the result. Repeat the process if necessary.
5. Press the OK button to end the adjustment.
NOTE:
If the overlap amount cannot be adjusted well enough, the print head position is out of the adjustable range.
The print head position needs to be mechanically adjusted using Test Mode No. 424 (refer to page 11B-16).
Adjustment Steps:
1. Activate Test Mode No. 438 and press the Proof button on the LCD panel.
2. Check the printout and confirm the density between the print heads for each color.
3. To make the adjustment, highlight the box for the specific head and type in the new parameter number.
4. After the parameter input is done, press the Proof button to check the result. Repeat the process if necessary.
5. Press the OK button to end the adjustment.
Plus (+) number makes the density darker. Minus (-) number makes the density lighter.
Increment of 1 increases the Print Head voltage by 0.02 Volts.
If the adjustment is not correctly done, the print density in the horizontal direction on the printouts differ in density.
If more than one or two heads per color needs to be adjusted, it is difficult to achieve even density across the 6
print heads. In that case, doing the density adjustment by the Auto-adjustment is recommended.
NOTE:
Refer to the following two pages for the sample of the printouts.
K (Black) C (Cyan)
M (Magenta) Y (Yellow)
YC (Yellow/Cyan) YM (Yellow/Magenta)
6-1. Explanation
When the HS4000 is not connected to ComColor, Canon LiDE Scanner and PC become necessary to execute the
Automatic Image Adjustment.
A special application software <Image ADJ Tool> is also needed for this process.
6-3. Connection
Laptop PC
Canon USB cable with scanner LAN cable
LiDE Connection driver and Connection
special Image ComColor
Scanner adjustment
software
installed.
The recommended Operating Software of the PC is Windows XP, Vista 32bit & 64bit and Windows 7 32bit & 64bit.
6-4. Instruction
• P re-install the special application software [Image ADJ Tool] in the Laptop PC.
• Pre-install the Canon LiDE Scanner driver in the Laptop PC.
Following Canon LiDE Scanners can be used: Series 35, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, 100, 110 and succeeding models to 110.
• S et the IP address of the Laptop PC with which it can communicate with ComColor.
• Refer to the next page for the paper size, paper orientation on the ComColor external paper feed tray, and the
scanning resolution for the each manual image adjustment.
• Refer to the pages on the Automatic Image Adjustment for the detailed information and instruction on each of
the image adjustment test modes.
Operation steps:
NOTE:
• Even though incorrect IP address of the ComColor is typed in Step-4 on the previous page (ref: Sketch #2
below), the display on the PC proceeds to Step-5 on the previous page (ref: Sketch #3 below). In that case,
press the Return button in the PC display (ref: Sketch #3 below) and return to Sketch #2, and retype the correct
IP address.
• Where there are more than one sheet to scan, repeat the steps 8 though 11 on the previous page for each
sheet printed.
Sketch #1 Sketch #2
Select Source Network Config
Sources:
Canon LiDE 6.0
Select
Cancel
IP Address 0 . 0 . 0 . 0
Sketch #3
300 dpi A4
400 dpi Letter
Return Close
LiDE Scanner
No space
Chart #1: Canon LiDE Scanner (Image ADJ Tool) List of image adjustment items.
Note:
Refer to the pages on the Automatic Image Adjustment for the detailed information on each of the image adjustment
test modes.
Paper Size and Paper Feed Direction on ComColor
Test Mode Scanning
List of Adjusting Items ComColor 9050/7050/7010 ComColor 3050/3010
No. Resolution
Millimeter MC Inch MC Millimeter MC Inch MC
423 Head Angle Adjustment. 400 dpi A4-R Letter-R A4 Letter
424 Head Position Adjustment 400 dpi A4-R Letter-R A4 Letter
421 Transfer Belt Direction Adj.. 400 dpi A4 Letter A4 Letter
422 Registration Roller Direction Adj. 400 dpi A4 Letter A4 Letter
420 Print Timing Rough Adjustment 400 dpi A4-R Letter-R A4 Letter
425 Print Timing Fine Adjustment 400 dpi A4-R Letter-R A4 Letter
426 Overlap Width Adjustment 400 dpi A4-R Letter-R A4 Letter
442 Head Replace Parameter < Neither scanner nor paper needed.>
427 Head Density Adjustment 300 dpi A4-R Letter-R A4 Letter
443 Head Edge Density Adjustment No Scanner A4-R Letter-R A4 Letter
433 Image Elongation Adjustment 400 dpi A4-R Letter-R A4 Letter
Note: MC = machine
Feed Direction
Paper orientation A4, A3, Letter = short edge feed. PAPER
Feed Direction
PAPER
Paper orientation A4R, Letter-R = A4 & Letter rotated = long edge feed.
Contents
1. Mechanisms...................................................................................... 12-2
1-1. Head Maintenance Mechanism............................................... 12-2
2. Disassembly..................................................................................... 12-7
2-1. Maintenance Unit.................................................................... 12-7
2-8. Waste Ink Tank & Waste Ink Tank Holder............................ 12-16
1. Mechanisms
Head holder
Printing (head carriage)
Maintenance unit
BP Unit
Stopper
1) The belt platen moves from the printing position to the lower limit position.
BP Unit to
lower limit
BP unit elevates down
position
Maintenance
unit on the Maintenance unit rides
over the PB Unit.
BP Unit
The Operation position sensor and Storage position sensors are cut by the sensor actuator on the Maintenance unit
arm.
Sensor actuator
Operation position sensor
4) The Maintenance unit arm comes into contact with the stopper on the main unit, and the maintenance unit
stops.
5) After a specified time has elapsed from activation of the operation position sensor in step 3), the Maintenance
unit slide motor stops.
6) The BP Unit elevates to the maintenance position (head cleaning position).
Maintenance
(head cleaning)
position
BP Unit elevates up
7) The maintenance unit positioning pin goes into the hole on the Head carriage.
The BP unit stops when the Maintenance unit and the Head carriage hits.
The height of the Maintenance unit in Print head wiping action is controlled by the Maintenance unit hitting
against the Head carriage.
Letter Name
A Waste ink tank sensor 1
B Waste ink tank sensor 2
C Waste ink tank
D Waste ink tank holder
E Compression spring
F Waste ink tank cap
F
C
Sensors
MEMO
2. Disassembly
Re-use band
Connector
FRONT REAR
Note: Be careful not to drop the clip and sleeve during removal or installation.
6. Pull out left and right hinge pins, from the inner side.
7. Push-in the pins on the waste ink tube mount with your fingers and remove the plastic mount from the machine.
8. Manually rotate the gear (the second gear of the four, looking from the rear of the machine) in counter-
clockwise direction. Rotate the gear until the Maintenance unit arm moves to the position shown on the second
photograph, below, so that the maintenance unit can be pulled out.
9. With only the waste ink tube connected, pull out the maintenance unit out of the machine and place it on the
floor. Make sure to put something on top of the floor, before putting the Maintenance unit down, to protect the
floor from getting dirty with ink.
Maintenance unit
(Ink pan)
10. Unplug the waste ink tube off the maintenance unit.
Caution in assembly:
In putting the Maintenance unit back in the machine, make sure that the waste ink tube is not twisted.
The maximum twist on the waste ink tube on the Maintenance unit is maximum 90 degrees.
If the tube is twisted more than 90 degrees, untwist the tube before finishing the assembly.
Moulded rib on the waste ink tube. Moulded rib on the waste ink tube.
No twist on the waste ink tube is the best. Maximum of 90 degrees twist on the tube is allowed.
Refer to the next page for further detailed information on the CAUTION in assembly.
Following photographs show the GOOD and BAD examples of how the waste ink tube should be when the Cap is
placed on the Waste ink tank or when the Maintenance unit (ink pan) is put back in the machine.
If the Waste ink tube is twisted or bent, it may rip, crack or unplugged and leak ink.
Also a large twist may cause the Waste ink tube to be pulled inside the machine, causing the Open/Close
movement of the Tray 1 to hit on the Waste ink tube and crack open the tube.
Spring
Connector
7. Remove the motor unit while undoing the wire from the 3 wire saddles.
8. Remove the maintenance unit slide motor from the motor unit. (IT screw 3x6 (2 pcs))
Motor unit
4. Detach the KG Roller evacuating plate (rear). <Use small flat-head driver to remove, but be careful not to
deform the part.>
5. Unplug the wire connector. (Cut the wire band to free the wire.)Remove the gears from the arm shaft.
6. Unhook the two wiper motor hooks and remove the motor from the maintenance unit with the screw shaft
attached to the motor.
MOTOR HOOK
MOTOR HOOK
Wiper motor
7. Manually rotate the two screw shafts by and to remove the wiper from the screw shafts from the ends opposite
from the motors.
Wiper HP sensor
Connector
Screw to remove
Caution in assembly:
In putting the cap on the Waste ink tank, make sure that the waste ink tube is not twisted nor bent (folded).
< Refer to the next page for the photographs of GOOD example and BAD example.>
The photographs show the GOOD and BAD examples of how the waste ink tube should be when the Cap is placed
on the Waste ink tank or when the Maintenance unit (ink pan) is put back in the machine.
If the Waste ink tube is twisted or bent, the tube may rip, crack or unplugged and leak ink.
Also a large twist may cause the Waste ink tube to be pulled inside the machine, causing the Open/Close
movement of the Tray 1 to hit on the Waste ink tube and crack open the tube.
Following photographs show the GOOD and BAD examples of how the waste ink tube should be when the Cap is
placed on the Waste ink tank or when the Maintenance unit (ink pan) is put back in the machine.
If the Waste ink tube is twisted or bent, it may rip, crack or unplugged and leak ink.
Also a large twist may cause the Waste ink tube to be pulled inside the machine, causing the Open/Close
movement of the Tray 1 to hit on the Waste ink tube and crack open the tube.
MEMO
Contents
1. GDI Controller Specifications......................................................... 13-2
Screening Error diffusion (default) and dot screen (70 and 100 lines)
Lightness, chroma, and contrast (each in a range of -25 to +25)
Gamma Control
Red, green, and blue (each in a range of -25 to +25)
Line Processing Line smoothing
Print Density 0 (standard) and adjustable in a range of -1 to +2
Original Mode Photo-based and line-based
Color (using all four colors of CYMK), black and white (using K only),
Color Mode Options
mono-cyan (using C only), and mono-magenta (using M only)
Duplex Printing Short edge and long edge
N-up multiple (2, 4, or 8 pages), N-up single (2, 4, or 8 pages), and
Imposition (N-up)
booklet
[A3W], [A3], [A4], [A5], [A6], [B4], [B5], [B6], [Foolscap], [Tabloid],
[Ledger], [Legal], [Letter], [Statement], [C4], [C5], [C6], [DL-R], [Envelope
Original Size Options 1], [Envelope 2], [No.10 envelope], [custom]
Portrait and Landscape
Mixed original sizes (when N-up is OFF)
Output Paper Size
Same as original
Options
[Auto], [Feed tray1] - [Feed tray3], [Standard tray] or the optional [High
Input Tray Options
capacity feeder]
Unspecified-[Any] (Default paper type of "Any" setting on the
Printing Functions
[Environment] tab.
Specified:
Types of Paper
[Plain], [IJ paper], [Matt coated]-Select one of these when using IJ paper
or similar paper.
[High-quality], [Card-IJ]
[Print], [Print & Save to folder], [Save to folder], [Save to USB flash drive],
Output Options
[Save as a file]
Rotation Auto, 0º, 90º, 180º, and 270º
Front and back independent (horizontally and vertically in a range of -20
Image Position
to +20 mm)
Collate (group or sort), slip sheet (OFF, between sets, or between jobs),
Finishing add cover (front cover or back cover), and binding side (bind left, bind
right, bind top)
Finishing (with
Offset output, booklet, stapling, hole punching, folding, and selection of
Ejection Options
output tray
Connected)
Program, printing on blank paper, continuous output (with ejection options
Programmed Printing connected), watermark, page or date printing, and confidential printing
(set PIN code)
Registration of print settings
Management Functions
Acquisition of printer data
Mode Options Printer mode, copy mode, and scan mode
RISO Microsoft® Internet Explorer 6.0 (SP1 or later) and Windows® Internet
Supported Browsers
Console Explorer 7.0 and Windows® Internet Explorer 8.0
Functions Monitoring, meter display, and other printer and scanner functions
Cntroller
PC
Cntroller
PC
The unit supports 10BASE-T, 100BASE-TX, and 1000BASE-T Ethernet connections. Note that the transfer rate
may vary depending on the computer, hub, and UTP cable connected. Check the equipment carefully.
In some cases, the unit may be connected to a computer directly, without a hub, but if so, use a crossover cable.
However, when the unit is connected to a computer conforming to 1000BASE-T specifications, a full
crossovercable is required.
[ 13-4 ] x1 series ComColor (Revision 1.1)
GDI Controller
?
Status Front door release Admin mode Settings
?
Status Front door release Admin mode Settings
Admin
In the Admin. Settings menu, locate
Logout K C M Y
Network setting.
Admin. Settings
To finish, press the MODE key.
Login setting
Address 0. 0. 0. 0
Port 8080
User name
Password
If the customer place utilized with
IPv6 IP address system, need to set
IPv6 network setting instructed by
the administrator.
Network setting (IPv6) Cancel OK
Manual: Enter IP address and
Printer name
Gateway address manually.
RISO PRINTER
Stateless address: One of auto-
Manual Stateless address Stateful address configuration (Automatically
configure by communicating between
IP address Prefix length
the host and the router (IPv6) in the
0000:0000:0000:0000:0000:0000:0000:0000 / 64
network.)
Gateway address Stateful address: One of auto-
0000:0000:0000:0000:0000:0000:0000:0000
configuration (Automatically
configure by the DHCP server (IPv6)
in the network.)
Source application
Text Illustrations
Photos
Redering data
Spooler
Data in RINC/C III format
GDI
at
Windows OS
Computer running Windows
Print jobs are processed as follows and then transferred to the printer.
1. Print job data created by programs installed on the Windows computer are passed to the operating system's
Graphical Device Interface (GDI) as rendering data and converted to bitmap data based on information in the
installed printer driver.
Text (outlined fonts) and graphics are converted to bitmaps matching the printer driver resolution, and the
rendering data comprised of this bitmap data is converted according to the selected screening type (error
diffusion or 70- or 100-line dot screen).
2. The printer driver compresses the bitmap data to make it smaller for transfer.
For this unit, the compressed bitmap data is in a format called RISO RINC/C III, and a controller that
understands the RISORINC/C III format must be in the printer or this data cannot be printed.
3. Data in RISO RINC/C III format is spooled temporarily in the operating system and transferred when the
printer is ready to receive it.
4. When the printer receives print jobs in RISO RINC/C III format, the data is either expanded by the controller
PCB unit to the original bitmap data and sent to the unit that creates data for storage, or it is temporarily saved
on the hard disk in RISO RINC/C III format.
192.168.1.200
If the test page was not printed, check the physical connection and network settings.
Also check the information entered manually during printer selection, and ensure the correct printer was selected
if multiple printers were listed.
Continue the process of installation until a test page is successfully printed.
In the properties of the installed printer, open the port and confirm that it is correct.
Click Configure Port and confirm that the port protocol is Raw and the port number is 9100.
RISO_192.168.1.200
RISO ComColor EX9050
192.168.1.200
192.168.1.200
Exisitin port:
If the port has already been created on the computer, select
COM2:
proper port on the list.
COM3:
COM4:
FILE:
RISO_192.168.1.200
Local Port
Standard TCP/IP port
https://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/ipp/lp
Local Port
Standard TCP/IP port
https://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/ipp/lp
IPP port:
To create an IPP port, describe proper IPP port information in
LPT1:
the column.
LPT2:
LPT3:
COM1:
For example, enter http://192.168.1.200/ipp/lp as an IPP port
COM2:
name.
After this, perform remaining steps, to complete the port
Local Port
Standard TCP/IP port
installation.
https://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/ipp/lp
MEMO
Contents
1. Overall Structure of Boards............................................................ 14-3
X3-OPTION-PCB
Controller
Decouple
PCB PCB
X3-ENGINE-PCB
X3-IP-PCB
X3-I-PF
-PCB
Power suuply Unit
PS25-NWW
Other board components include the panel control PCB (PNL-1126A-PCB) in the operation panel unit, mode
button PCB (MODEKEY-PCB), numeric keypad PCB (TENKEY-PCB), and LED backlight for the LCD panel.
Additionally, there are head control PCBs 1 and 2 (OR2 HDR_PCB1-2), paper feed relay PCB (PF-RELAY-PCB),
paper feed tray PCB, (PF-TRAY-PCB), ink cartridge RFID PCB for ink detection, machine code RFID PCB for
model detection, and ink circulation PCB for ink circulation.
LCD
SD
78KO
Scanner
Decouple PCB
LVDS
USB RFID-PCB
UART Controller PCB
USB
UART CPU
SIO Memory
USB
LAN Chipset
USB CIS
S-ATA
Power Supply Unit
CIS
A/D
RMGA2
FRAM Paper feed
SDRAM relay PCB Sensor
FPGA
SDRAM SDRAM Inter
lock
Driver
Sensor Inter
FLASH I/F lock
Recording data generating PCB FLASH
Driver
Paper feed
MCU Sensor
tray PCB
Head control PCB1 DSP
Sensor Internal paper feed
Head control PCB2
I/F drive PCB
Actuator
Driver
Sensor
I/F
Driver
Driver
Inter
Driver
Inter
Driver
Driver
Inter
High Capacity Feeder Offset Stapler Tray High Capacity Stacker Mail Maker Perfect Binder
2. Board Components
F003
F014
/ 500V
CN10
7
T3.15AL/250V
1
F008
CN11
5
T3.15AH
T3.15AL/250V
/ 500V
F002
+30VA/+30VB/+30VOP1
F007
5 CN12 1
1
CN13
F12
F001
/ 500V
F13
4
+24V/30V/41V
1
CN1
7 1
+5VSP
CN3
CN49)
- PCB CN3)
2 1 4
(To X3-I-PF
CN4
+5VSP
Control PCB
6 CN6 1
(To X3-IP-
PCB CN3
& Engine
T3.15AH
CN49)
F005
+5V
/ 500V
(To Decouple
T3.15AH
1
F004
PCB CN1)
/ 250V
CN2 7 CN5
(To Panel control
6 1 +12V
15A/ 250V
(intermediate
-12V/+5VSB
connector)
PCB CN1)
F006
CNAC2 CNAC1
3 1 3 1 For PSU cooling fan
CN008 For PSU cooling fan CN007
PSU
Changeable Rated Corresponding
Voltage System Connector Control Actuator Parts
Fuse Name Value Board or Unit
Pin No.
F006 15A AC Input
30V for needs related to optional
F007 3.15A 30VOP CN12_1 Option PCB_CN1
equipment
24V voltage for needs related to optional
F008 3.15A 24VOP CN11_4&5 Option PCB_CN1
equipment
Head control
F010 8A 41VA CN13_5 For C and K head control
PCB1(CK)_J16_1
Head control
F011 8A 41VB CN13_6 For C and K head control
PCB1(CK)_J16_3
Head control
F012 8A 41VC CN13_7 For M and Y head control
PCB2(MY)_J16_1
Head control
F013 8A 41VD CN13_8 For M and Y head control
PCB2(MY)_J16_3
Circulation pump motors, Ink supply
Engine control valves, Pressurized ink tank air valve,
F014 3.15A 24VA CN10_8
PCB_CN14_1 Negatively pressurized ink tank air valve
and Ink cooling fan
No. of DIAG
Name Voltage Connected To
Pins page
CNAC1 3 Primary AC Power Switch & AC Pwer Inlet 43
CNAC2 3 Primary AC Power Socket 43
CN1 7 Voltage Control Engine control PCB CN6 43
CN2 6 5VSB, Voltage Control Panel Control PCB CN2 43
CN3 4 5VSP Engine control PCB CN49 43
CN4 2 5VSP Internal paper feed Drive PCB CN3 43
CN5 7 12V DECOUPLE-PCB CN1 43
Recording data Generating PCB CN3, Engine control PCB
CN6 6 5V 43
CN49
CN007 2 Power Supply Cooling Fan 43
CN008 2 Power Supply Cooling Fan 43
CN10 7 24VA, VB, VC, VD Engine control PCB CN5 &14, 24V Ink Heater 43
CN11 5 24VE, OP1, OP2 Internal paper feed Drive PCB CN3, Option PCB CN1 43
Engine control PCB CN18, Option PCB CN1, Internal paper
CN12 5 30VA, VB, OP1 43
feed Drive PCB CN3
CN13 4 41VA, VB, VC, VD Head control PCB J16 43
+3.3V +5VSP CPU (SH2A), auxiliary CPU (F2MC), memory, and other uses
20
To X3-I-PF-PCB CN1 To RFID
4
+5V/+5VSP (PSU CN3/6) To PF-relay Unused
(PSU CN3/6) -PCB CN2 PCBs
Unused
LED5
CN2
LED8
LED7
1
FU8
To various motors
CN64
LED4
Electronic Compnents
FU7 AC250V/2.5A
1 CN44 11
AC250V/2.5A
Unused
LED1
1
LED2
LED3
14 CN45
DSP
1
5
To X3-OPTION PCB CN11
LED6
CPU
LED9
(SH2A)
CN18
Reset
switch
1
+30V (PSU-CN12)
X3-ENGINE-PCB
80
2
CN51
1
[ 14-8 ]
motor power
Transfer belt
ENGINE CONTROL PCB
CN9
2 1
14
13
To +30V heater
Reset switch
CN43
CN1
Flash
To X3-IP PCB CN4
CN3
Memory
1
26
1
PCB version No.
sensors
RMGA2
To PF-relay-PCB CN10
1
11 CN53 1 10 CN66 1
To BP unit parts
4
To BP hit detection
18
19
drive motor
1
To various sensors
18
To Panel PCB CN5
1 CN74 10 1 CN70 16
17
B9 B1 To Negatively
A1
CN52 A9
pressurized
CN69
CN75
(Be careful not to press during data transfer)
CN60
(PSU-CN1)
1
36
24V/30V/41V
To Elevator motor
1
To Ink path motor
No. of DIAG
Name Silk-Screened on PCB Connected To
Pins page
CN70 16 CRCLTE-SNR2 Negative pressure ink tank ink sensor (CMYK) 50
Wiper motor HP sensor, Ink pan storage sensor, Ink pan
CN71 24 MAINTE-SNR 49
operating position sensor, Waste ink tank sensors 1 and 2
BP upper and lower limit sensors, Flipper sensor, Paper
CN72 32 CRCLTE-SNR3 elevation IN sensor, Authorization cam HP sensor, Ink cartridge 48
detection sensor (CMYK)
Transfer belt motor, Belt HP sensor, Belt shaft FG sensor (driven
CN73 17 FRNT-SNR 48
roller)
CN74 10 CRCLTE-ACT2 Bellows arm drive motor 50
CN75 18 BP-FAN Transfer belt fans 1-6 48
Changeable
Rated Value Voltage System Control Actuator Parts
Fuse Name
FU7 2.5A/250V 30V-IL For External paper feed motor
FU8 2.5A/250V 30V-IL For Registration motor
LED1 Red MPU-HB Flashing Indicates the CPU (SH2A) status (heartbeat)
LED2 Red ERROR OFF Indicates the CPU (SH2A) status (error)
LED3 Green STATUS OFF Indicates the CPU (SH2A) status
LED4 Red VCC5SP ON For +5VSP voltage
LED5 Red VCC5 ON For +5V voltage
LED6 Red DSP-HB Flashing Indicates the DSP status (heartbeat)
LED7 Red F2-HB Flashing Indicates the auxiliary CPU status (heartbeat)
ǡ ǡ ǡ ǡ
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Values etited by using the “Data Editing” test modes listed in Chapter 17, Section 6, are stored in the memory
of the engine control PCB. For this reason, execute test mode 00415 (store test mode setting values) when
replacing the engine control PCB to send the settings data to the hard disk. After replacement, you must execute
test mode 00416 (restore test mode setting values) to apply the setting values.
Fan
8 J4 1
8
40
J3 2
J2
39 1
To Decouple PCB CN4
1 To Decouple PCB CN8
5
To Decouple PCB CN2
HDD power
J22
Memory
CPU
LAN2
(CN9)
Controller PCB
CONTROLLER-PCB
LAN1 To Decouple PCB CN4
2 14 9 1
1 J1 13 10 J17 2
Chip set
USB
Controller PCB
7 CN9 1
1 CN2 50
To CIS paper width
40 CN6 1
To Head control PCB 2 (MY) J1
1 CN1 40
1
Controller PCB
No. of DIAG
Name Connected To
Pins page
J1 14 Decouple PCB CN4 (For Panel Control) 45
J2 8 Decouple PCB CN2 (For Panel Control) 45
J3 40 Decouple PCB CN8 (For Panel Control) 45
J4 8 Decouple PCB CN4 (For Panel Control) 45
J17 10 Decouple PCB CN4 (For Panel Control) 45
CN4-7 4 USB (Scanner Unit, IC Card Authentication Kit, etc.) 45
CN9 8 External Controller 45
No. of DIAG
Name Connected To
Pins page
CN1 40 Head control PCB 1 (CK) J1 44
CN2 50 Head control PCB 1 (CK) J2 44
CN3 2 Power Supply Unit CN6 (+5V) 44
CN4 80 Engine control PCB CN43 44
CN6 40 Head control PCB 2 (MY) J1 44
CN7 50 Head control PCB 2 (MY) J2 44
CN9 7 CIS paper width detection sensor (rear) 44
CN10 8 CIS paper width detection sensor (front) 44
CPU
The central processing unit, for data processing.
This CPU is directly mounted on the control PCB.
It is an Intel® AtomD510 processor (1.66 GHz) or equivalent.
Memory
1GB memory (Max 2GB).
Called main memory, this is RAM or ROM storage media that is directly accessed by the CPU to read or
write data.
Chipset
ICH8-M Chipset
Groups of circuits that control exchanges between the CPU and memory or peripheral components.
HDD Drive
2.5 inch 350 GB or equivalent.
LAN controller
Controls network communication.
Dual 10BASE-T, 100BASE-TX, and 1000BASE-T Ethernet channels are provided for communication with
connected equipment.
External interfaces
Controls the interface with peripheral equipment (connection and communication control).
LAN1
For connection to a computer
LAN2
For connection to an external controller (PS)
USB (four USB 2.0 ports)
For connection to a scanner, USB memory devices, and similar equipment
RGB output (analog)
Normally not used
PC For connection to a PC
(2)
Scanner
(1)
RISORINC/CIII format data
Recording data
generating PCB
13
CN2 24 1 CN11 14
12 1
To Engine control PCB CN45
To Finisher
I/F unit To Engine control PCB CN43
To Finisher
CN3 1
80 CN12 1
I/F unit
14
ejection motor
To FU paper
1
CN16
(voltage)
To X3-IP-PCB CN4
CN13
2
80 1
22
CN512 14
11 13
To FU paper ejection To FU paper
ejection unit
To Card/Coin
CN4
(sensors &
Vendor unit
motors)
1 3
2 4
12
11
1
14
15
Option PCB
CN14
To one of option
CN21
X3-OPTION-PCB
7
26
28
To Auto control
1
CN7
13
CN11/12)
CN18 4
5
1
CN1
1 CN6 8
28
CN19 15 28
CN23 15 A1
CN17
A5
No. of DIAG
Name Silk-Screened on PCB Connected To
Pins page
CN1 5 POWER Power supply unit CN11/12 (24VOP, 30VOP voltage supply) 54
Finisher IF PCB P8002, Decurler motor CN2 (signal) & IF unit
CN2 24 FINISHER 55
door interlock switch 2
CN3 14 FIN POWER Finisher IF PCB P8001 & Decurler motor CN1 (voltage) 55
PCB)
2-5-1. Internal Paper Feed Drive PCB
Controls operation of sensors, switches, motors, and clutches involved with the internal paper feed system.
Operation of components in the internal paper feed system is controlled by this PCB, as they are driven by a
signal from the engine control PCB (CN37 and 57) and the required voltage is supplied from the power supply
unit.
26
8
CN1
1
To Engine control PCB CN37
CN3
CN2
14
13
1
X3-I-PF-PCB
CN7
2
To Vertical paper feed sensors
(+30V)
1
1
1
To Tray paper detection sensors
& Tray upper limit sensors
16
CN4
CN11
15
4
CN12
interlock switch
18
1
1
To Tray paper size detection sensors
36
10
paper feed clutches
1
CN6
CN9
18
1 CN8 6
17
No. of DIAG
Name Connected To
Pins page
CN1 23 Engine control PCB CN57 (Control signals for various motors and clutches) 46
CN2 19 Engine control PCB CN37 (Control signals for various sensors) 46
CN3 8 Power supply unit CN4/6/11/12 (5V, 5VSP, 24VE & 30V) 43
CN4 15 Vertical paper feed sensors 52
CN5 18 Tray (1-3) paper detection sensors & Tray (1-3) upper limit sensors 52
CN6 10 Internal paper feed clutches & Vertical paper feed clutches 52
CN7 2 Internal paper feed motor power supply (+30V) 51
CN8 6 Tray (1-3) elevator motors 51
CN9 17 Internal paper feed motor & Tray (1-3) paper volume detection sensors 51
CN10 36 Tray (1-3) paper size detection sensors (1-4) 51
CN11 16 Tray (1-3) interlock switches 51
CN12 4 Internal feed paper jam door interlock switch 52
13 1
14
CN1 26
10
Paper feed relay PCB
CN2
PF-RELAY-PCB
20
1
19
17
To various sensors & switch
To various sensors & switch
5 CN5 1
To various sensors
1
No. of DIAG
Name Connected To
Pins page
CN1 26 Engine control PCB CN3 (Control signals for various sensors & 5V) 46
CN2 10 Engine control PCB CN68 (Control signals for various sensors) 46
CN3 N/A Unused N/A
CN4 17 BP wire loose detection switch & various sensors 53
CN5 5 Paper feed tray PCB CN1 53
CN6 20 Paper feed tray elevation switch & various sensors 53
CN7 19 Various sensors 53
CN7
1 (LDVS) 19
To Panel control
PCB CN6
DECOUPLE-PCB
To Controller PCB J3
5
To Controller PCB J2
CN1
CN24
To Panel control
PCB CN5
1
1
16 CN3 1
No. of DIAG
Name Connected To
Pins page
CN1 5 Power supply unit CN5 (12V voltage supply) 45
CN2 4 Controller PCB J2 45
CN3 16 Panel control PCB CN5 45
CN4 14 Controller PCB J1/4/17 45
CN7 19 Panel control PCB CN6 45
CN8 20 Controller PCB J3 45
2-5-7. Mode Button PCB, Numeric Keypad PCB, and LED backlight
The mode button PCB is a board with wired input devices. It manages input from mode, counter, and shortcut
buttons 1-3.
The numeric keypad PCB controls key input from the interrupt, power, and wake-up buttons, among others. It
also controls display for the main power, regular power, wake-up, start, error, data reception, and interrupt LEDs,
among others.
LED backlight, controlled by the panel control PCB, illuminates backlighting required for display by the LCD.
3. Interlock Circuit
The interlock circuit prevents user injury from touching moving parts (gears and the like) when users reach
inside the unit to remove paper jams or in other situations.
Interlock switches are arranged on the front door and elsewhere. When users open a door, the power supply to
areas that pose a risk of injury is cut.
This circuit controls four systems for particular purposes. Refer to each section for a description: 3-1. Printer
Interlock Circuit, 3-2. Internal Paper Feed Interlock Circuit, 3-3. External Paper Feed Interlock Circuit, and 3-4.
Switchback Section Interlock Circuit.
3-1. Printer Interlock Circuit
Cuts the power driving actuators in the paper path in the printer, the belt platen, and used for head maintenance.
The right front door interlock switch (1) and the front door interlock switch (2) are arranged in this main unit
system. Switches for interlock also reset the printer after interlock. The switches detect opening of printer doors
in parallel.
3-1
FDឃ⚕࡙࠾࠶࠻
10 㕙៝ㅍ࡙࠾࠶࠻
3-4 ⚕
2
3-3
ࡋ࠶࠼ࡎ࡞࠳࡙࠾࠶࠻
↪⚕ォ࡙࠾࠶࠻B
1 ៝ㅍ
䊒䊥䊮䊃䊓䉾䊄
↪⚕⟎ᬌ
9
ࠟࠗ࠼᧼ASSY()
࡙࠾࠶࠻
8
ࠟࠗ࠼᧼ASSY(ਅ)
ࡌ࡞࠻ࡊ࠹ࡦ࡙࠾࠶࠻
࡙࠾࠶࠻A
ㅍ
❑៝ㅍ
3 ࠻ࠗ1ࠛࡌ࠲ASSY
❑៝ㅍ 䊃䊧䉟1
࡙࠾࠶࠻B
3-2
6 4 ࠻ࠗ2ࠛࡌ࠲ASSY
䊃䊧䉟2
5 ࠻ࠗ3ࠛࡌ࠲ASSY
䊃䊧䉟3
4-1. Sensor
Negatively pressurized ink tank ink sensor C Ink Path Engine CN70-1_4 35E 50
Negatively pressurized ink tank ink sensor K Ink Path Engine CN70-5_8 35F 50
Negatively pressurized ink tank ink sensor M Ink Path Engine CN70-9_12 35G 50
Negatively pressurized ink tank ink sensor Y Ink Path Engine CN70-13_16 35H 50
Paper feed tray paper length detection sensor External P/F PF-Tray CN2-1_3 27E 53
Paper feed tray paper volume detection sensor 1 External P/F PF-Relay CN4-1_3 27B 53
Paper feed tray paper volume detection sensor 2 External P/F PF-Relay CN4-4_6 27C 53
Paper feed tray upper limit sensor A External P/F PF-Relay CN6-4_6 27G 53
Paper feed tray upper limit sensor B External P/F PF-Relay CN6-7_9 27H 53
Paper lift detection sensor Registration PF-Relay CN4-10_12 30C 53
4-2. Switches
Switch name Connected pin Referred page
Section PCB name
(alphabetical order) no. Fig. DIAG
BP wire loose detection switch BP Unit PF-Relay CN4-13_14 31C 53
Internal feed paper jam door interlock switch Registration I-PF CN12-1_4 29F 52
Left front door interlock switch Main Unit Engine CN56-1_4 25B 47
Paper feed tray elevation switch External P/F PF-Relay CN6-10_11 27N 53
Paper feed tray lower safety switch External P/F Engine CN55-7_10 27P 47
Paper feed tray paper width potentiometer External P/F PF-Tray CN2-7_9 27Q 53
Paper feed tray upper safety switch External P/F Engine CN55-7_10 27O 47
Right front door interlock switch Main Unit Engine CN56-5_8 25A 47
Stripper Unit Interlock Switch Main Unit Engine CN55-7_10 27R 47
Switchback door interlock switch Switchback Engine CN55-1_4 34D 47
Tray 1 interlock switch Internal P/F I-PF CN11-1_4 28V 50
Tray 2 interlock switch Internal P/F I-PF CN11-7_10 28W 50
Tray 3 interlock switch Internal P/F I-PF CN11-13_16 28X 50
4-3. Motors
Circulation pump C motor (via pump drive PCB) Ink Path Engine CN60-1_4 35U 50
Circulation pump K motor (via pump drive PCB) Ink Path Engine CN60-5_8 35V 50
Circulation pump M motor (via pump drive PCB) Ink Path Engine CN60-9_12 35W 50
Circulation pump Y motor (via pump drive PCB) Ink Path Engine CN60-13_16 35X 50
Elevator motor External P/F Engine CN54-1_2 27T 47
External paper feed motor External P/F Engine CN64-5_6 26B 47
FD paper ejection fence motor FD Paper Eject Engine CN66-1_4 33G 49
FD paper ejection motor FD Paper Eject Engine CN65-1_2 33F 49
Internal paper feed motor Internal P/F I-PF CN9-10_16 26C 51
Maintenance unit slide motor Ink Path Engine CN61-15_16 39F 49
Paper elevation motor Upper Transfer Engine CN52-1_7 26D 47
Re-feed motor Switchback Engine CN64-9_14 26G 47
Registration motor Registration Engine CN64-7_8 27S 47
Switchback motor Switchback Engine CN64-15_20 26F 47
Transfer belt motor BP Unit Engine CN73-11_17 30H 48
Tray 1 elevator motor Internal P/F I-PF CN8-1_2 28Y 50
Tray 2 elevator motor Internal P/F I-PF CN8-3_4 28Z 50
Tray 3 elevator motor Internal P/F I-PF CN8-5_6 28AA 50
Upper transfer motor Upper Transfer Engine CN53-1_7 26E 47
Wiper motor 1 Ink Path Engine CN61-11_14 39D 49
Wiper motor 2 Ink Path Engine CN61-5_8 39E 49
4-4. Actuators
Actuator name Connected pin Referred page
Section PCB name
(alphabetical order) no. Fig. DIAG
Counter Main Unit Engine CN54-5_6 25C 47
FD paper ejection flipper solenoid FD Paper Eject Engine CN65-5_6 33H 49
Head drive IC cooling fan 1 Ink Path Engine CN61-1_2 38A 49
Head drive IC cooling fan 2 Ink Path Engine CN61-3_4 38B 49
Heater (+30V) Ink Path Engine CN09-1_2 N/A 47
Ink cooling fan Ink Path Engine CN59-19_20 35T 50
Ink supply valve C Ink Path Engine CN59-1_2 35Q 50
Ink supply valve K Ink Path Engine CN59-3_4 35P 50
Ink supply valve M Ink Path Engine CN59-5_6 35O 50
Ink supply valve Y Ink Path Engine CN59-7_8 35N 50
Internal paper feed clutch 1 Internal P/F I-PF CN6-1_2 26J 52
Internal paper feed clutch 2 Internal P/F I-PF CN6-3_4 26K 52
Internal paper feed clutch 3 Internal P/F I-PF CN6-5_6 26L 52
Negatively pressurized ink tank air valve Ink Path Engine CN59-11_12 35S 50
Pressurized ink tank air valve Ink Path Engine CN59-9_10 35R 50
Transfer belt fan 1 BP Unit Engine CN75-1_3 30I 48
Transfer belt fan 2 BP Unit Engine CN75-4_6 30J 48
Transfer belt fan 3 BP Unit Engine CN75-7_9 30K 48
Transfer belt fan 4 BP Unit Engine CN75-10_12 30L 48
Transfer belt fan 5 BP Unit Engine CN75-13_15 30M 48
Transfer belt fan 6 BP Unit Engine CN75-16_18 30N 48
Vertical paper feed clutch 1 Registration I-PF CN6-7_8 26H 52
Vertical paper feed clutch 2 Registration I-PF CN6-9_10 26I 52
B Left front door interlock switch Engine CN56-1_4 Micro switch 1180 47
C Counter Engine CN54-5_6 Electromagnetic counter 1690 47
D Machine code RFID PCB Engine CN63-1_6 PCB 8004 47
D E
H
I
C J K L
A S
F N
O
H J
B
C
U K
Q
E
T
P
D G
I
R
M
PCB Connected Relevant DIAG
Name Type
name pin no. Test mode page
A Registration motor FG sensor PF-Relay CN7-5_7 Interrup type 1024 53
P-F tray paper volume detection
B PF-Relay CN4-1_3 Interrup type 1036 53
sensor 1
P-F tray paper volume detection
C PF-Relay CN4-4_6 Interrup type 1037 53
sensor 2
D P-F tray lower limit sensor PF-Relay CN4-15_17 Interrup type 1002 53
E P-F tray paper length detection sensor PF-Tray CN2-1_3 Reflection type 1010 53
G P-F tray upper limit sensor A PF-Relay CN6-4_6 Interrup type 1000 53
H P-F tray upper limit sensor B PF-Relay CN6-7_9 Interrup type 1001 53
I P-F tray paper detection sensor PF-Tray CN2-4_6 Reflection type 1006 53
J Top edge sensor 1 (receive) PF-Relay CN7-10_11 Transmission type 1102 53
K Top edge sensor 1 (send) PF-Relay CN7-3_4 Transmission type 1102 53
L Registration sensor (receive) PF-Relay CN7-8_9 Transmission type 1025 53
M Registration sensor (send) PF-Relay CN7-1_2 Transmission type 1025 53
N P-F tray elevation switch PF-Relay CN6-10_11 Push switch 1035 53
O P-F tray upper safety switch Engine CN55-7_10 Micro switch N/A 47
P P-F tray lower safety switch Engine CN55-7_10 Micro switch N/A 47
B
E
C
F
M
L
JK
Q
OP
N
U
T
RS
X AA W Z V Y
G Tray 1 paper volume detection sensor I-PF CN9-1_3 Interrup type 1038 51
H Tray 2 paper volume detection sensor I-PF CN9-4_6 Interrup type 1039 51
I Tray 3 paper volume detection sensor I-PF CN9-7_9 Interrup type 1040 51
J Tray 1 paper size detection sensor 1 I-PF CN10-1_3 Interrup type 1011 51
K Tray 1 paper size detection sensor 2 I-PF CN10-4_6 Interrup type 1012 51
L Tray 1 paper size detection sensor 3 I-PF CN10-7_9 Interrup type 1013 51
M Tray 1 paper size detection sensor 4 I-PF CN10-10_12 Interrup type 1014 51
N Tray 2 paper size detection sensor 1 I-PF CN10-13_15 Interrup type 1015 51
O Tray 2 paper size detection sensor 2 I-PF CN10-16_18 Interrup type 1016 51
p Tray 2 paper size detection sensor 3 I-PF CN10-19_21 Interrup type 1017 51
Q Tray 2 paper size detection sensor 4 I-PF CN10-22_24 Interrup type 1018 51
R Tray 3 paper size detection sensor 1 I-PF CN10-25_27 Interrup type 1019 51
S Tray 3 paper size detection sensor 2 I-PF CN10-28_30 Interrup type 1020 51
T Tray 3 paper size detection sensor 3 I-PF CN10-31_33 Interrup type 1021 51
U Tray 3 paper size detection sensor 4 I-PF CN10-34_36 Interrup type 1022 51
V Tray 1 interlock switch I-PF CN11-1_4 Micro switch 1185 51
W Tray 2 interlock switch I-PF CN11-7_10 Micro switch 1186 51
X Tray 3 interlock switch I-PF CN11-13_16 Micro switch 1187 51
Y Tray 1 elevator motor I-PF CN8-1_2 DC motor 1425 51
Z Tray 2 elevator motor I-PF CN8-3_4 DC motor 1426 51
AA Tray 3 elevator motor I-PF CN8-5_6 DC motor 1427 51
5-6. BP unit
B
K D
I M
A F
C
E G
N
L
J
H
5-7. BP elevation
A G
H
C F E
5-10. Switchback
D
A
P
O
Q
N
C
D
B
A
R
H
V G
U F
E
S X
Z
I AA
AB
AC
Y W
J
K
L
M
See next page for parts details
K Bellows arm upper position sensor Engine CN69-25_27 Interrup type 2104 50
Two way
O Ink supply valve M Engine CN59-5_6 2140 50
solenoid valve
Two way
p Ink supply valve K Engine CN59-3_4 2138 50
solenoid valve
Two way
Q Ink supply valve C Engine CN59-1_2 2139 50
solenoid valve
Three way
R Pressurized ink tank air valve Engine CN59-9_10 2142 50
solenoid valve
Three way
S Negatively pressurized ink tank air valve Engine CN59-11_12 2143 50
solenoid valve
T Ink cooling fan Engine CN59-19_20 DC axial fan 2305 50
Brushless DC
U Circulation pump C motor Engine CN60-1_4 2175 50
motor
Brushless DC
V Circulation pump K motor Engine CN60-5_8 2174 50
motor
Brushless DC
W Circulation pump M motor Engine CN60-9_12 2176 50
motor
Brushless DC
X Circulation pump Y motor Engine CN60-13_16 2177 50
motor
Brushless DC 2400, 2401,
Y Bellows arm drive motor Engine CN74-1_9 50
motor 2404
Z C pump drive PCB Engine CN60-1_4 PCB 50
AA K pump drive PCB Engine CN60-5_8 PCB 50
AB M pump drive PCB Engine CN60-9_12 PCB 50
AC Y pump drive PCB Engine CN60-13_16 PCB 50
E B G A
H F
J I C
D
C B
A
E
D
F
C
Bellows arm drive motor Paper feed relay PCB Paper feed tray lower limit sensor
CN74
[ 14-42 ]
Circulation pump C motor (via pump drive PCB) CN3 CN1 CN6 External paper feed motor FG sensor
Control signals
Circulation pump K motor (via pump drive PCB) PF-RELAY-PCB Paper feed tray PCB Paper lift detection sensor
CN60 for various
Circulation pump M motor (via pump drive PCB) CN5 CN1 PF-TRAY-PCB CN2
sensors, BP wire loose detection switch
Circulation pump Y motor (via pump drive PCB) +5V signal
BP upper limit sensor CN4 Registration motor FG sensor
BP lower limit sensor Registration sensor (send)
CN68 CN2 CN7
Flipper sensor Control signals Top edge sensor 2 Top edge sensor 1 (send; also for multiple paper feed detection)
Paper elevation IN sensor for various CN3 Registration sensor (receive)
Unused
CN72 sensors Top edge sensor 1 (receive; also for multiple paper feed detection)
Authorization cam HP sensor
Ink cartridge detection sensor C Vertical paper feed sensor 1
Ink cartridge detection sensor K
Internal paper feed Vertical paper feed sensor 2
Ink cartridge detection sensor M drive PCB CN4 Vertical paper feed sensor 3
Tray 1 paper detection sensor
Ink cartridge detection sensor Y Vertical paper feed sensor 4
X3-I-PF-PCB Tray 1 upper limit sensor
Vertical paper feed sensor 5
Transfer belt fan 1 Tray 2 paper detection sensor
CN57 CN1 CN5 Tray 2 upper limit sensor
Transfer belt fan 2 Control signals Internal paper feed clutch 1
Transfer belt fan 3 for various Tray 3 paper detection sensor
Internal paper feed clutch 2
Transfer belt fan 4 CN75 motors and Tray 3 upper limit sensor
CN6 Internal paper feed clutch 3
Transfer belt fan 5 clutches
Vertical paper feed clutch 1
Transfer belt fan 6 Vertical paper feed clutch 2 Tray 1 paper size detection sensor 1
Tray 1 paper size detection sensor 2
CN10
Power supply unit CN10 To ink heater (+24V) Tray 1 paper size detection sensor 3
Tray 1 elevator motor
Tray 1 paper size detection sensor 4
CN5 CN8 Tray 2 elevator motor
+24V(A,B,C,D,B-IL) CN10 CN37 CN2
CN10 CN14 Control signals Tray 3 elevator motor
for various Tray 2 paper size detection sensor 1
Power supply control CN1 CN6 sensors Tray 1 paper volume detection sensor Tray 2 paper size detection sensor 2
+5VSP CN3 CN49 Tray 2 paper volume detection sensor Tray 2 paper size detection sensor 3
PS25-NWW CN9
+5V CN6 Tray 3 paper volume detection sensor Tray 2 paper size detection sensor 4
CN7/CN43/CN45 Internal paper feed motor
+30V CN12 CN18 See Overall Block Diagram 2
CN2/CN5/CN13/ CN7 Internal paper feed motor power supply (+30V) Tray 3 paper size detection sensor 1
+30V CN12
CN14/CN16 CN3 Tray 1 interlock switch Tray 3 paper size detection sensor 2
+5VSP CN4
See +5V CN6 CN11 Tray 2 interlock switch Tray 3 paper size detection sensor 3
Internal feed paper jam door interlock switch CN12
Overall Block Diagram 2 +24V-E CN11 Tray 3 interlock switch Tray 3 paper size detection sensor 4
CN6 CN3
CN7
[ 14-43 ]
+5V CN13 CN12
TFT LCD
CN11
Option PCB
See Finisher I/F unit wiring diagram
X3-OPTION-PCB
CN2
Finisher I/F unit
CN3 CN4 LED Back Light
FU paper ejection wing motor
FU paper
FU paper ejection flipper
ejection unit FU paper ejection jump motor
FU paper ejection motor FG sensor
CN4 CN19
FU paper ejection wing HP sensor For Options Mode button PCB
See Otion PCB wiring FU paper ejection sensor CN21 CN2 CN1 MODEKEY-PCB
diagram
CN14
FU paper ejection motor
CN16
CN5
Numeric keypad PCB
Card/Coin Vendor unit CN9
CN007 CN1 TENKEY-PCB
CN008 Warning light CN6
CN23 Offset Stapler unit
Cooling Fan
Auto control stacking tray unit CN7
GND (+5V) 8
I-PF-DRIVE-PCB NC 1
DECOUPLE-PCB
1 GND (+5V) +12V 2 1 +12V
2 GND (+5V) +12V 3 2 +12V
3 GND (+5V) GND 4 3 GND
Recording data 4 +5V CN6 CN5 CN1
GND 5 4 GND
5 +5V GND 6 5 GND
Generating PCB 6 +5V NC 7
1 +30VOP1
X3-IP-PCB 2 +30VB
Relay connector
3 GND (+30VOP1)
4 GND (+30VB) Option AC control signal 1 6 1
5 +30VA PMS-12V control signal 2 5 2
6 GND CN12 Standby signal (5VSP control) 3 4 3
7 GND GND (+5VSB) 4 3 4 See Controller PCB to Panel PCB
Engine control PCB 8 GND CN2 GND (+5VSP) 5 2 5 wiring diagram
X3-ENGINE-PCB 9 NC +5VSB 6 1 6 (To Panel Control PCB CN2)
+5VSP 1 10 +30VA
GND(+5VSP) 2
CN49 3
[ 14-44 ]
+5V
GND(+5V) 4
1
41V_Overheat_Detection 1 7 41V_Overheat_Detection 2
24V-30V_ON 2 6 24V-30V_ON 3
CN6 24VD_ON 3 5
AC Power Socket
24VD_ON CN1 4
41V_ON 4 4 41V_ON
Power_Cooling_Fan_ON 5 3 Power_Cooling_Fan_ON 1 L
NC 6 2 2 N
1
2
3
NC CNAC2
GND 7 1 GND 3 E
AC Power Switch
1
2
3
Relay connector
Ink_Heater_Connection_Detection 1
NC 2
CN5
+24VA 1
+24VB 2 Grounded to main unit frame
+24VC 3 1 +24V(B)-IL E
CN14 4 2 N
GND(+24VA) GND(+24VA)
L
GND(+24VB) 5 3 GND(+24VB)
GND(+24VC) 6 4 GND(+24VC)
+24V(B)-IL 7 5 NC Grounded to main unit frame
6 NC
CN10 CN007
AC Power Inlet
7 Ink_Heater_Connection_Detection
8 +24VA
9 +24VB
10 +24VC
+24VD 1 11 +24VD
+24VD 3 12 +24VD
CN008
2 13 GND(+24VD)
+24V Ink Heater GND(+24VD)
GND(+24VD) 4 14 GND(+24VD)
(Interwired)
[ 14-45 ]
D_GND GND 33 18 GND D_GND 13
13 HD-ENC-N 32 19 HD-ENC-N HD-ENC-N 19 32 HD-ENC-N
14 K<1-6>_H_H(1)SDO HD-ENC-P 20 31 HD-ENC-P Y<1-6>_H_H(1)SDO 14
6-4. Recording data generating PCB (X3-IP-PCB)
HD-ENC-P 31 20 HD-ENC-P
15 D_GND HD-PSTRG-N 21 30 HD-PSTRG-N D_GND 15
HD-PSTRG-N 30 21 HD-PSTRG-N
16 K<1-6>_H_H(1)SCK HD-PSTRG-P 22 29 HD-PSTRG-P Y<1-6>_H_H(1)SCK 16
HD-PSTRG-P 29 22 HD-PSTRG-P
17 D_GND HD-EN-N 28 23 HD-EN-N HD-EN-N 23 28 HD-EN-N D_GND 17
18 K<1-6>_H_H(1)INITX HD-EN-P 27 24 HD-EN-P HD-EN-P 24 27 HD-EN-P Y<1-6>_H_H(1)INITX 18
K<1-6>_H_H(1)RSTX GND 26 25 GND GND 25 26 GND Y<1-6>_H_H(1)RSTX 19
19
K<1-6>_H_H(1)CFDNO HD-INT-N 25 26 HD-INT-N HD-INT-N 26 25 HD-INT-N Y<1-6>_H_H(1)CFDNO 20
20
HD-INT-P 24 27 HD-INT-P HD-INT-P 27 24 HD-INT-P Y<1-6>_H(2)TH 21
21 K<1-6>_H(2)TH
HD-REQ-N 23 28 HD-REQ-N HD-REQ-N 28 23 HD-REQ-N
22 A_GND A_GND 22
HD-REQ-P 22 29 HD-REQ-P HD-REQ-P 29 22 HD-REQ-P
23 N.C N.C 23
HD-ACT-N 21 30 HD-ACT-N HD-ACT-N 30 21 HD-ACT-N
24 D_GND HD-ACT-P D_GND 24
HD-ACT-P 20 31 HD-ACT-P HD-ACT-P 31 20
25 D_GND HD-SCPURST HD-SCPURST D_GND 25
HD-SCPURST 19 32 HD-SCPURST 32 19
26 K<1-6>_H(2)VAA HD-RST 33 18 HD-RST Y<1-6>_H(2)VAA 26
HD-RST 18 33 HD-RST
27 K<1-6>_H(2)VAA GND 34 17 GND Y<1-6>_H(2)VAA 27
GND 17 34 GND
28 K<1-6>_H(2)VAA HD-D6-N 35 16 HD-D6-N Y<1-6>_H(2)VAA 28
HD-D6-N 16 35 HD-D6-N
29 K<1-6>_H(2)VCC HD-D6-P 15 36 HD-D6-P HD-D6-P 36 15 HD-D6-P Y<1-6>_H(2)VCC 29
30 K<1-6>_H(2)VCC HD-D5-N 14 37 HD-D5-N HD-D5-N 37 14 HD-D5-N Y<1-6>_H(2)VCC 30
31 D_GND HD-D5-P 13 38 HD-D5-P HD-D5-P 38 13 HD-D5-P D_GND 31
HDDVDD HD-D4-N 12 39 HD-D4-N HD-D4-N 39 12 HD-D4-N HDDVDD 32
32
HD-D4-P 11 40 HD-D4-P HD-D4-P 40 11 HD-D4-P D_GND 33
33 D_GND
GND 10 41 GND GND 41 10 GND
34 K<1-6>_H_H(2)SDO Y<1-6>_H_H(2)SDO 34
HD-D3-N 9 42 HD-D3-N HD-D3-N 42 9 HD-D3-N
35 D_GND D_GND 35
HD-D3-P 8 43 HD-D3-P HD-D3-P 43 8 HD-D3-P
36 K<1-6>_H_H(2)SCK HD-D2-N Y<1-6>_H_H(2)SCK 36
HD-D2-N 7 44 HD-D2-N HD-D2-N 44 7
37 D_GND HD-D2-P HD-D2-P D_GND 37
HD-D2-P 6 45 HD-D2-P 45 6
38 K<1-6>_H_H(2)INITX HD-D1-N 46 5 HD-D1-N Y<1-6>_H_H(2)INITX 38
HD-D1-N 5 46 HD-D1-N
39 K<1-6>_H_H(2)RSTX HD-D1-P 47 4 HD-D1-P Y<1-6>_H_H(2)RSTX 39
HD-D1-P 4 47 HD-D1-P
40 K<1-6>_H_H(2)CFDNO GND 48 3 GND Y<1-6>_H_H(2)CFDNO 40
GND 3 48 GND
NC 2 49 NC NC 49 2 NC
HD-DET-3 1 50 HD-DET-3 HD-DET-3 50 1 HD-DET-3
Wire_Harness J3 J3 Wire_Harness
1 1 C1_HCIRTH C1_HCIRTH 1 1
2 2 GND CN9 GND 2 2
3 NC NC 3
4 NC 1 R_CIS_IN NC 4
2 R_CIS_GND
Wire_Harness Relay connector Wire_Harness 3 R_CIS_VCC
1 R_CIS_IN 1 1 14 4 R_CISSI
2 R_CIS_GND 2 2 13 5 R_CISCLK
CIS paper width detection 3 R_CIS_VCC 3 3 12 6 R_LED_ON To Power Supply Unit CN6 pin1, 4
4 R_CISSI 4 4 11 1
7 R_LED_POWER +5V line
sensor (rear) 5 R_CISCLK 5 5 10
CN3 2
6 R_LED_ON 6 6 9 See Power Supply Unit wiring diagram
7 R_LED_POWER 7 7 8 1 F_CIS_IN
2 F_CIS_GND
1 F_CIS_IN 1 8 7 3 F_CIS_VCC To Engine control PCB CN43 or Option PCB CN13
2 F_CIS_GND 2 9 6 4 F_CISSI CN10 1-80 +5V line
3 F_CIS_VCC 3 10 5 5 F_CISCLK
CN4
CIS paper width detection 4 See OPTION PCB to boards wiring diagram
4 F_CISSI 4 11 6 F_LED_ON
sensor (front) 5 F_CISCLK 5 12 3 7 F_LED_POWER
6 F_LED_ON 6 13 2 8 NC
7 F_LED_POWER 7 14 1
GND 14 14 GND G0 15
DATA1+ 15 5 DATA1+ GND 15 15 GND G1 16
NC 16 6 GND
DATA1- GND 16 16 GND G2 17
17 7 DATA1-
NC 18 L VCC 17 17 L VCC GND 18
8 GND
GND 19 L VCC 18 18 L VCC G3 19
9 DAT0+
GND 20 10 GND L_VCC 19 19 L_VCC G4 20
J3
DAT0+ 21 11 DATA0-
CN8 CN7 G5 21
NC 22 12 GND GND 22
DATA0- 23 RXD<- 16 1 RXD<- B0 23
13 CLK-
NC 24 TXD-> 15 2 TXD-> B1 24
14 GND
GND 25 15 CLK+ GND 14 3 GND B2 25
GND 26 16 GND CTS-> 13 4 CTS-> GND 26
USB Cable 1 VBUS CLK+ 27 17 DDC_CLK RTS<- 12 5 RTS<- B3 27
IC Card DC_SW 11 DC_SW B4 28
2 D- NC 28 18 L VCC 6
Authentication 3 D+ CN4-CN7 CLK- 29 19 DDC_DATA NC 10 7 NC B5 29
Kit 4 GND NC 30 20 L_VCC CN3 GND 9 8 GND GND 30
NC 31 GND 8 9 GND CN5 HSYNC 31
USB NC 32 GND 7 10 GND GND 32
6-5. Controller PCB to Panel PCB
[ 14-46 ]
+12v 7
NC 8 INTLED 8
KIN1 9
KIN2 10
KIN3 11
NC 1 1 RXD1 CN9 KIN4 12
TXD1 2 2 TXD1 KOUT1 13
GND 3 3 GND KOUT2 14
RTS 4 4 RTS KOUT3 15
NC 5 5 CTS KOUT4
J17 16
RXD1 6 6 NC KOUT5 17
NC 7 7 NC
CN4 WAKEUPINT 18
NC 8 8 Power_ON POWERINT 19
CTS 9 9 GND
1 LAN-MDI0+ Reset SW- (GND) 20
Polarizing Key 10 NC
2 LAN-MDI0- 10 Power SW+ 21
LAN-MDI1+ 11 Power SW- (GND) TIMERLED 22
LAN Cable 3
External 4 LAN-MDI1- 1 12 GND
CN9 Wire_Harness
5 LAN-MDI2+ PS_ON 2 13 Back Light ON
Controller 14
6 LAN-MDI2- NC 3 +12V KIN5 1 Mode button PCB
7 LAN-MDI3+ Reset SW- (GND) 4 KOUT1 2
8 LAN-MDI3- 5 KOUT2 3 MODEKEY-PCB
CN2 KOUT3 4
6
Ethernet 7 KOUT4 5
Connect LAN cable J1 KOUT5 6
8
to the port marked 9 Wire_Harness
[Controller] NC 10
Engine control PCB Wire_Harness
Power SW+ XR_RIGHT 1
11 ENGINE_READY 1 1 ENGINE_READY TOUCH PANEL
4 ENGINE_READY 1 YD_BOTTOM 2
Power SW- (GND) 12 2
Spare Output 3 Spare Output 2 2 Spare Output XL_LEFT 3
Polarizing Key 13 CN7 3
Starting mode signal 2 Starting mode signal 3 3 Starting mode signal CN8 YU_TOP 4
NC 14 4 1 4
GND GND 4 GND
CN3 Wire_Harness
VLED1+ 1
GND 1
X3-ENGINE-PCB VLED2+ 2
NC 2 LED Backlight
Wire_Harness VLED3+ 3
NC 3
CN4 VLED4+ 4
NC 4 Option AC Control Option AC Control
J4 1 6 NC 5
NC 5 Standby (+5VSP control)
Standby (+5VSP control) 2 5 VLED1- 6
Back Light ON 6
PMS-12V control 3 4 PMS-12V control VLED2- 7
NC 7
GND 4 3 GND VLED3- 8
+12V 8
GND 5 2 GND CN1 VLED4- 9
+5VSB 6 1 +5VSB
2 9 31 GND 50
GND
1 10 32 D3 49
33 D2 48
34 D1 47
35 D0 46
Internal paper feed PCB 36 GND 45
Wire_Harness 37 44
X3-I-PF-PCB WAIT
GND 38 Interrupt signal 43
13 1
Tray 1 elevator motor control 1 39 GND 42
12 2
GND 40 RESET 41
11 3 CN4
40
[ 14-47 ]
10 Tray 2 elevator motor control 1 CN43 41 GND
4
GND 42 WR 39
9 5
Tray 3 elevator motor control 1 43 RD 38
8 6
GND 44 GND 37
7 7
Vertical paper feed clutch 2 45 RD/WR 36
6 8
Internal paper feed clutch 3 46 CS 35
5 9
Internal paper feed clutch 1 47 GND 34
4 10
Internal paper feed motor_CLK 48 A24 33
3 11
Internal paper feed motor_DIR 49 A23 32
2 12 CN57
Internal paper feed motor_ON 50 A22 31
1 13
CN1 GND 51 A21 30
26 14
Internal paper feed motor_LOCK 52 GND 29
25 15
Internal paper feed motor_GAIN 53 A20 28
24 16
GND 54 A19 27
23 17
Internal paper feed clutch 2 55 A18 26
22 18
Vertical paper feed clutch 1 56 A17 25
21 19
GND 57 GND 24
20 20
Tray 3 elevator motor PWM 58 A16 23
19 21
Tray 3 elevator motor control 2 59 A15 22
18 22
Tray 2 elevator motor PWM 60 A14 21
17 23
Tray 2 elevator motor control 2 61 A13 20
16 24
Tray 1 elevator motor PWM 62 GND 19
15 25
Tray 1 elevator motor control 2 63 A12 18
14 26
64 A11 17
65 A10 16
GND 66 A9 15
19 1
Internal paper feed PCB (I-PF-DRIVE-PCB) connection detection 67 GND 14
18 2
Internal feed paper jam door interlock CLOSE 68 A8 13
17 3
Tray 3 paper detection sensor 69 A7 12
16 4
Tray 2 paper detection sensor 70 A6 11
15 5
Tray 1 paper detection sensor 71 A5 10
14 6
Tray 3 upper limit sensor 72 GND 9
13 7
Tray 2 upper limit sensor 73 A4 8
12 8
Tray 1 upper limit sensor 74 A3 7
11 9
CN2 Vertical paper feed sensor 5 75 A2 6
10 10
Vertical paper feed sensor 4 CN37 76 A1 5
9 11
Vertical paper feed sensor 3 77 GND 4
8 12
Vertical paper feed sensor 2 78 Spare output 2 3
7 13
Vertical paper feed sensor 1 79 CONCT1 2
6 14
SENCLK 80 1
5 15
4 SENLAT
16
3 SENDATA2
17
2 SENDATA1
18
1 GND
19
Wire_Harness +5VSP 1 4 1 4 1
CN52 1 Switchback door interlock
CN2 NC 8 GND 2 3 2 3 2 䇭㩷3
FG 7 1 Paper elevation motor_FG GND 3 2 3 2 3 switch
LOCK 6 2 Paper elevation motor_LOCK Switchback door interlock switch 4 1 4 1 4
CLK 5 3 Paper elevation motor_CLK NC 5
Relay connector Wire_Harness Relay connector
DIR 4 4 Paper elevation motor_DIR NC 6
Paper elevation motor ON 3 5 Paper elevation motor_ON +24VC 7 4 1 4 1 Paper feed tray lower safety
1
GND 2 6 GND GND 8 3 2 3 2
䇭㩷3 switch
+5V 1 7 +5V GND 9 2 3 2 3
8 NC Interlock switch 10 1 4 1 4
CN1 Relay connector Relay connector
+30V-IL 1 9 NC NC 11
GND 2 9 1 10 BP elevation motor_FG NC 12 4 1
8 2 11 BP elevation motor_LOCK 3 2
7 3 12 BP elevation motor_CLK 2 3
Wire_Harness
6 4 13 BP elevation motor_DIR 1 4
14 BP elevation motor_ON Relay connector Relay connector
5 5
CN1 4 6 15 GND 4 1 4 1
1
FG 9 3 2 3 2 Stripper unit interlock switch
3 7 16 +5V 䇭㩷3
LOCK 8 2 3 2 3
2 8 17 GND
CLK 7 1 4 1 4
1 9 18 +24VB-IL
DIR 6
BP elevation motor ON 5
GND 4 Relay connector Relay connector
+5V 3 17 1 4 1 Paper feed tray upper safety
1
GND 2 16 2 3 2
䇭㩷3 switch
+24VB-IL 1 15 3 2 3
14 4 1 4
13 5
12 6
11 7
Wire_Harness CN53
CN2 NC 8 10 8
CLK 7 1 9 9
Upper transfer motor_CLK
GAIN 6 8 10
2 Upper transfer motor_GAIN
7 11
NC 5 3 NC Refer PF-Relay-PCB CN6 6 12
[ 14-48 ]
LD 4 4 Upper transfer motor_LD
Upper transfer motor 5 13
ON 3 5 Upper transfer motor_ON 4 14
+5V 2 6 +5V 3 15
GND 1 7 GND 2 16
CN1 8 Authorization cam motor OUT1 1 17
+30V-IL 1 9 Authorization cam motor OUT2
GND 2 10 NC (+24VC) CN56 Wire_Harness
11 NC (Switchback clutch signal) Relay connector
Left front door interlock switch 1 4 1
1
GND 2 3 2 Left front door interlock switch
1 2 䇭㩷3
Authorization cam motor +24VC GND 3 2 3
2 1 +5VSP 4 1 4
+5VSP 5
GND 6 Relay connector
GND 7 4 1
Right front door interlock switch 8 1
3 2 Right front door interlock switch
䇭㩷3
Wire_Harness CN64 2 3
1 4
1 +30V-IL
2 GND
3 +30V-IL
CN63
4 GND
1 1 5 External paper feed motor (+) Machine code RFID_+5V 1 6
External paper feed motor +30V-IL Machine code RFID_GND 2 5
2 2 6 External paper feed motor (-)
Machine code RFID_TxD 3 4
6-7. Engine Control PCB to Parts (CN9_10_52_53_54_55_56_63_64)
1
+30V-IL
3
5
Switchback motor 7
9
11
[ 14-49 ]
Relay connector Relay connector
2 3 Transfer belt fan 2
1 Transfer belt fan 1 (+24VC) 1 18 1 18 1 1 4 White
Ink cartridge detection sensor Y 2 GND 2 17 2 17 2
3 Transfer belt fan 1 PWM control signal 3 16 3 16 3
Transfer belt fan 2 (+24VC) 4 15 4 15 4
Relay connector
GND 5 14 5 14 5
Red +24VC
Transfer belt fan 2 PWM control signal 6 13 6 13 6 4 1
CN62 Transfer belt fan 3 (+24VC) 7 12 7 12 7 3 2
Blue
Wire_Harness Wire_Harness 2 3 Transfer belt fan 3
Relay connector GND 8 11 8 11 8
6-8. Engine Control PCB to Parts (CN51_62_72_73_75)
1 4
White
6 A01 A12 1 C-RFID_+5V Transfer belt fan 3 PWM control signal 9 10 9 10 9
5 A02 A11 2 C-RFID_GND Transfer belt fan 4 (+24VC) 10 9 10 9 10
4 A03 A10 3 C-RFID_TxD GND 11 8 11 8 11
Ink RFID PCB C 3 A04 A09 4 C-RFID_RxD Transfer belt fan 4 PWM control signal 12 7 12 7 12
Transfer belt fan 5 (+24VC) 13 13 Relay connector
2 A05 A08 5 C-RFID_RESET 6 6 13
GND 14 5 14 5 14 Red +24VC
1 A06 A07 6 C-RFID_RUN 4 1
Transfer belt fan 5 PWM control signal 15 4 15 4 15 3 2
Blue
A07 A06 7 K-RFID_+5V
A08 A05 8 K-RFID_GND Transfer belt fan 6 (+24VC) 16 3 16 3 16 2 3 Transfer belt fan 4
GND 17 2 17 2 17 1 4
White
6 A09 A04 9 K-RFID_TxD
A10 A03 10 K-RFID_RxD Transfer belt fan 6 PWM control signal 18 1 18 1 18
5
4 A11 A02 11 K-RFID_RESET
Ink RFID PCB K 3 A12 A01 12 K-RFID_RUN Relay connector
2 B01 B12 13 M-RFID_+5V
Red +24VC
1 B02 B11 14 M-RFID_GND 4 1
B03 B10 15 M-RFID_TxD 3 2
Blue
B04 B09 16 M-RFID_RxD 2 3 Transfer belt fan 5
1 4
White
6 B05 B08 17 M-RFID_RESET
5 B06 B07 18 M-RFID_RUN
4 B07 B06 19 Y-RFID_+5V
Ink RFID PCB M 3 B08 B05 20 Y-RFID_GND
2 B09 B04 21 Y-RFID_TxD Relay connector
1 B10 B03 22 Y-RFID_RxD Red +24VC
4 1
B11 B02 23 Y-RFID_RESET 3 2 Blue
B12 B01 24 Y-RFID_RUN 2 3 Transfer belt fan 6
6 1 4
White
5
4
Ink RFID PCB Y 3
2
1
9 7 9 +5V 3 2 Blue
10 6 10 GND 2 3 Head drive IC cooling fan 2
11 5 11 FD paper ejection full sensor signal 1 4
White
12 4 12 +5V
13 3 13 GND Wire_Harness
3 2 FD paper ejection sensor signal CN61
FD paper ejection motor FG 14 14
2 1 +5V Relay connector
sensor 15 15
1 Head drive IC cooling fan 1(+24V A) 1 1 2
GND 2 +24VB-IL Maintenance unit slide motor
2 1
Head drive IC cooling fan 2 (+24V A) 3
GND 4
3 Wiper motor 2 phase A 5
FD paper ejection full sensor 2 Wiper motor 2 phase B 6
1 Wiper motor 2 phase /A 7
Wiper motor 2 phase /B 8
Wire_Harness +24VB 9 Wire_Harness Wire_Harness
Relay connector Motor to increase pressure Relay connector Relay connector Relay connector +24VB-IL
10
3 1 3 Wiper motor 1 phase A 11 4 1 11 1 4 1 4
FD paper ejection sensor 2 2 2 Wiper motor 1 phase B 12 3 2 10 2 3 2 3
3 1 Wiper motor 1 phase /A 2 3 9 3 2 3
Wiper motor 1
1 13 2
Wiper motor 1 phase /B 14 1 4 8 4 1 4 1
Maintenance unit slide motor 1 (+24V B-IL) 15 7 5
4 1
Maintenance unit slide motor 2 (+24V B-IL) 16 3 2 6 6
2 3 5 7 Relay connector +24VB-IL
Wire_Harness Relay connector CN66 4 8
+24VB-IL 1 4 4
9 4 1
3
6 1 7 1 FD paper ejection fence motor_phase A Relay connector 3 2 3 Wiper motor 2
2 10
5 2 6 2 FD paper ejection fence motor_phase B 2 3 2
1 11
4 3 5 3 FD paper ejection fence motor_phase /A 1 4 1
FD paper ejection fence motor 3 4 4 4 FD paper ejection fence motor_phase /B Relay connector
2 5 3 5 GND 3 1
1 6 2 6 FD paper ejection fence HP sensor signal 2 2
7 1 7 +5V 1 3
[ 14-50 ]
8 GND
3
9 FD paper ejection paper detection sensor signal
2 Wiper motor HP sensor
10 +5V
1
3 CN71
6-9. Engine Control PCB to Parts (CN61_65_66_71)
[ 14-51 ]
1 B14 B05 32 Detection of missing pressurized 4 GND
+5V 7 4 7 3 +5V
ink tank ink sensor Y
GND 8 3 8 2 GND
4 B15 B04 +24VB 9 2 9 1 +24VB
33 GND
Pressurized ink tank ink 3 B16 B03 NC 10 1 10 +24V
34 GND
sensor K 2 B17 B02 35 Pressurized ink tank ink sensor K
1 B18 B01 36 Detection of missing pressurized
ink tank ink sensor K CN60 Wire_Harness Wire_Harness
Relay connector Relay connector
+24VA 17 1 4 +24VA
6-10. Engine Control PCB to Parts (CN59_60_69_70_74)
1 4 1
GND 2 16 2 3 2 3 GND Circulation pump C motor
+24VA
Circulation pump C motor_LP 3 15 3 2 3 2 Pump_LP signal (Pump drive PCB C)
Circulation pump C motor_ON 4 14 4 1 4 1 Pump_ON signal
+24VA 5 13 5
GND 6 12 6
Circulation pump K motor_LP 7 11 7 Relay connector
Circulation pump K motor_ON 8 10 8 4 1 4 +24VA
+24VA 9 9 9 3 2 3 GND Circulation pump K motor
GND 8 10 2 3
+24VA
10 2 Pump_LP signal (Pump drive PCB K)
Circulation pump M motor_LP 11 7 11 1 4 1 Pump_ON signal
Circulation pump M motor_ON 12 6 12
+24VA 13 5 13
CN70 GND 14 4 14 Relay connector
Relay connector Circulation pump Y motor_LP 15 3 15
4 1 4 +24VA
4 1 16 1 GND Circulation pump Y motor_ON 16 2 16 Circulation pump M motor
3 2 3 GND +24VA
Negatively pressurized ink tank 3 2 15 2 GND GND 17 1 17 2 3 (Pump drive PCB M)
2 Pump_LP signal
ink sensor C 2 3 14 3 Negatively pressurized ink tank ink sensor C 1 4 1 Pump_ON signal
1 4 13 4 Detection of missing negatively pressurized ink tank ink sensor C
5 12 5 GND
4 6 11 6 GND Relay connector
3 7 10 7 Negatively pressurized ink tank ink sensor K
Negatively pressurized ink tank 4 1 4 +24VA
2 8 9 8 Detection of missing negatively pressurized ink tank ink sensor K
ink sensor K 3 2 3 GND Circulation pump Y motor
1 9 8 9 GND 2 3 +24VA
2 Pump_LP signal (Pump drive PCB Y)
10 7 10 GND 1 4 1 Pump_ON signal
11 6 11 Negatively pressurized ink tank ink sensor M
4 12 5 12 Detection of missing negatively pressurized ink tank ink sensor M
Negatively pressurized ink tank 3 13 4 13 GND
ink sensor M 2 14 3 14 GND
1 15 2 15 Negatively pressurized ink tank ink sensor Y
16 1 16 Detection of missing negatively pressurized ink tank ink sensor Y
4
Negatively pressurized ink tank 3
ink sensor Y 2
1
sensor 2 3
1 9 4 9 +5V GND 2 2 Tray 1 paper volume detection
10 3 10 GND GND 3 1 sensor
11 2 11 Tray1 paper size detection sensor 4 signal Tray 1 interlock switch 4
12 1 12 +5V NC 5
Tray 1 paper size detection 3 NC 6
2 Tray 2 interlock switch 7
sensor 3
1 GND 8 Tray 2 elevator assembly
GND 9 Relay connector
Tray 2 interlock switch 10
NC 11 1 2
2 1
Tray 2 elevator motor
Tray 1 paper size detection 3 NC 12
2 Tray 3 interlock switch 13
sensor 4
1 GND 14 Relay connector
GND 15 4 1
1
Tray 3 interlock switch 16 3 2 Tray 2 interlock switch
Wire_Harness 䇭㩷3
Relay connector 2 3
3 1 12 13 GND 1 4
Tray 2 paper size detection
2 2 11 14 Tray2 paper size detection sensor 1 signal
sensor 1 15 +5V
1 3 10
4 9 16 GND
17 Tray2 paper size detection sensor 2 signal 3
5 8 Tray 2 paper volume detection
18 +5V 2
6 7
19 GND 1 sensor
Tray 2 paper size detection 3 7 6
sensor 2 2 8 5 20 Tray2 paper size detection sensor 3 signal
1 9 4 21 +5V
10 3 22 GND
6-11. I-PF-PCB to Parts (CN7_8_9_10_11)
[ 14-52 ]
Relay connector
3 4 1
Tray 2 paper size detection 1
3 2 Tray 3 interlock switch
sensor 4 2 䇭㩷3
2 3
1
1 4
4
Vertical paper feed unitB 3
Wire_Harness
CN4 2 Internal paper feed clutch 3
Relay connector
3 1 3 1 +24V
1 GND
Vertical paper feed sensor 1 2 2 2 2 Vertical paper feed sensor 1 signal
1 3 1 3 +5V
Relay connector Relay connector
1 4 1 4
[ 14-53 ]
Internal feed paper jam door 1
2 3 2 3
interlock switch 3
3 2 3 2
4 1 4
4 1
3
Wire_Harness Relay connector 2 Vertical paper feed clutch 1
3 1 3 4 GND 1 +24V
Vertical paper feed sensor 2 2 2 2 5 Vertical paper feed sensor 2 signal
1 3 1 6 +5V
CN12
1 Internal feed paper jam door interlock switch
Vertical paper feed unit A 2 GND
3 GND
Wire_Harness Relay connector 4 Internal feed paper jam door interlock switch
3 1 3
Vertical paper feed sensor 5 2 2 2
1 3 1
Relay connector 12 6
Relay connector 13 GND 6 1
1 4 GND 1 11 1 11 7 5 2
14 BP wire loose detection switch
2 3 sensor signal 2 10 2 10 8 4 3
15 GND
External paper feed motor 3 2 +5V 3 9 3 9 9 3 4 3
16 Paper feed tray lower limit sensor signal
FG sensor 4 1 GND 4 8 4 8 10 2 5 2 Paper feed tray upper limit
17 +5V
Paper feed tray upper limit sensor A signal 5 7 5 7 11 1 6 1 sensor B
Wire_Harness +5V 6 6 6 6 12
Part of Paper position Wire_Harness
Relay connector Relay connector GND 7 5 7 5 13
detection unit Paper feed tray upper limit sensor B signal 8 4 8 4 14
3 1 3 1 3
+5V 9 3 9 3 15 Relay connector
Paper lift detection sensor 2 2 2 2 2 Paper feed tray elevation
GND 10 2 10 2 16 1 2
1 3 1 3 1
Paper feed tray elevation switch 11 1 11 1 17 2 1 switch
Wire_Harness Wire_Harness
Relay connector Relay connector
1 1 2 1 2 Relay connector
Part of Switchback unit A
BP wire loose detection switch 2 2 1 2 1
GND 12 6 1 3
Re-feed sensor signal 13 5 2 2 Re-feed sensor
+5V 14 4 3 1
GND 15 3 4
Switchback sensor signal 16 2 5 Relay connector
3 +5V 17 1 6 3 1 3
Paper feed tray lower limit 2 2 2 2
GND 18 Switcback sensor
sensor 1 Upper transfer OUT sensor signal 19 1 3 1
+5V 20
[ 14-54 ]
CN7 Wire_Harness Wire_Harness
Relay connector Relay connector 3
+5V 1 2 1 2 1 2 Registration sensor (send)
Registration sensor (send) 2 1 2 1 2 1
+5V 3
Top edge sensor 1 (send) 4
GND 5
Registration motor FG sensor 6 Wire_Harness Wire_Harness
Relay connector 3 Top edge sensor 1 (send)
+5V 7 2
2 1 2 2 (Also used for multiple paper
Registration sensor (receive) 8 1 1 1
1 2 feed detection
+5V 9
Top edge sensor 1 (receive) 10
Paper feed tray unit +5V 11
PF-TRAY-PCB +5V 12
Top edge sensor 2 (receive) 13
Top edge sensor 2 (send) 14 Relay connector
CN2 CN1 CN5 +5V 15 4 1
Wire_Harness Wire_Harness
NC 16 3 2
3 1 GND 1 NC 17 2 3 Registration motor FG sensor
Paper feed tray paper length 1 GND
2 2 Paper feed tray paper length detection sensor 2 NC 18 1 4
2 Paper feed tray paper length detection sensor
detection sensor 1 3 +5V 3 NC 19
3 Paper feed tray paper detection sensor
4 GND 4 4 Paper feed tray paper width potentiometer
5 Paper feed tray paper detection sensor 5 5 +5V
6 +5V
7 GND Wire_Harness Wire_Harness
3 8 Paper feed tray paper width potentiometer Relay connector Relay connector 3
Paper feed tray paper
2 9 +5V 2 1 2 1 2 Registration sensor (receive)
detection sensor 1 1 2 1 2 1
Wire_Harness Wire_Harness
Relay connector Relay connector 3 Top edge sensor 1 (receive)
3 1 2 1 2 (Also used for multiple paper
3 2 2 1 2 1
Paper feed tray paper width 2 feed detection
1 3
potentiometer 1
53 D7 D7 28
28 28
52 D6 D6 29
29 29
51 D5 D5 30
30 30
50 D4 D4 31
31 31
49 GND GND 32
32 32
48 D3 D3 33
33 33
47 D2 D2 34
34 34
46 D1 D1 35
35 35
45 D0 D0 36
36 36
44 GND GND 37
37 37
43 WAIT WAIT 38
38 38
42 Interrupt signal Interrupt signal 39
39 39 CN43
41 GND CN12 GND 40
40 CN13 40
CN4 40 RESET RESET 41
41 41
39 GND GND 42
42 42
38 WR WR 43
43 43
37 RD RD 44
44 44
36 GND GND 45
45 45
35 RD/WR RD/WR 46
46 46
34 CS CS 47
47 47
33 GND GND 48
48 48
32 A24 A24 49
49 49
31 A23 A23 50
50 50
30 A22 A22 51
51 51
29 A21 A21 52
52 52
28 GND GND 53
53 53
27 A20 A20 54
54 54
26 A19 A19 55
55 55
[ 14-55 ]
25 A18 A18 56
56 56
24 A17 A17 57
57 57
23 GND GND 58
58 58
22 A16 A16 59
59 59
21 A15 A15 60
60 60
20 A14 A14 61
61 61
19 A13 A13 62
62 62
18 GND GND 63
63 63
17 A12 A12 64
64 64
16 A11 A11 65
65 65
15 A10 A10 66
66 66
14 A9 A9 67
67 67
13 GND GND 68
68 68
12 A8 A8 69
69 69
11 A7 A7 70
70 70
10 A6 A6 71
71 71
9 A5 A5 72
72 72
8 GND GND 73
73 73
7 A4 A4 74
74 74
6 A3 A3 75
75 75
5 A2 A2 76
76 76
4 A1 A1 77
77 77
3 GND GND 78
78 78
2 Spare output 2 Spare output 2 79
79 79
1 CONCT1 CONCT1 80
80 80
Wire_Harness
NC 1 2 2 2 GND
P8003 GND 2 3 3 3 GND CN3
GND 6 8 GND NC 3 4 4 4 GND
CN2
6-15. Finisher IF Unit
[ 14-56 ]
NC 4 11 23 Spare sensor
NC 3 12 1 24 +5V
P8005 NC 2
NC 1
1
2
3 5V-IL
NC 8
IF unit door interlock switch 1 IF unit decurler motor_CLK 7
Wire_Harness IF unit decurler motor_GAIN 6
IF unit decurler motor_DIR 5
1A 1A 4 4 IF unit decurler motor_LOCK 4
2A 2A 3 3 IF unit decurler motor_ON 3
1B 1B 2 2 +5VSP 2
2B 2B 1 1 CN2 GND 1
21 2 21 GND GND 22 5 22 22
22 1 22 FU paper ejection unit connect detect signal NC 23 4 23 23
Auto control stacking tray
NC 24 3 24 24
Connection detect 25 2 25 25
3 NC 26 1 26
FU paper ejection motor FG
2
sensor 1
[ 14-57 ]
CN14
CN2 NC 8
CLK 7 1 FU paper ejection unit transport motor_CLK
GAIN 6 2 FU paper ejection unit transport motor_GAIN
DIR 5 3 FU paper ejection unit transport motor_DIR
FU paper ejection unit LD 4 4 FU paper ejection unit transport motor_LD
transport motor ON 3 5 FU paper ejection unit transport motor_ON
+5V 2 6 +5V
GND 1 7 GND CN23
CN1 Wire_Harness Offset stapler unit
+30V 1 NC 14
+30VOP GND 2 NC 13
NC 12 CN1
CN16 NC 11 Relay connector
Input signal (Interrupt) 10 1 10 1 Input signal (Interrupt)
1 +30V NC 9 2 9 2 NC
2 GND Paper ejection signal 8 3 8 3 Paper ejection signal
Input port 2 7 4 7 4 Input port 2
Input port 1 6 5 6 5 Input port 1
Output port 2 5 6 5 6 Output port 2
Output port 1 4 7 4 7 Output port 1
NC 3 8 3 8 NC
GND 2 9 2 9 GND
Paperfeed siganal 1 10 1
CN5
1 +5V NC 28 CN2
2 NC 27 Relay connector
Paper feed signal
3 Paper ejection signal +5V 26 1 12 1 +5V
4 Copy busy signal CAN (+) 25 2 11 2 CAN (+)
5 Copy enable signal CAN (-) 24 3 10 3 CAN (-)
6 Size detection signal Power ON signal 23 4 9 4 Power ON signal
7 Color detection signal Output signal (Interrupt) 22 5 8 5 Output signal (Interrupt)
8 Duplex signal Connection detection 21 6 7 6 Connection detection
9 Serial TXD signal NC 20 7 6 7 NC
10 GND NC 19 8 5 8 NC
11 Serial RXD signal NC 18 9 4 9 NC
or
NC 10 3
LAN-MDI3- 8
Controller
Relay connector
1 3 CN8 JP1 Ethernet
Scanner fan 2 2
3 1 1 GND 08 07 Connect to the port marked [Controller]
2 TXD 09 06
For 3 /RTS 10 05
4 RXD
debugging 5 /CTS 11 04
6 +3.3V 12 03
7 GND 13 02
14 01
CN4 Jumper settings
JP1-01:TCK
1 SGND JP1-02:/TRST
2 SGND JP1-03:TD0
3 +5V
JP1-04:/ASEBREAK
[ 14-58 ]
4 +5V
5 PGND JP1-05:TMS
6 PGND JP1-06:TD1
7 +24V JP1-07:/RESET
8 +24V JP1-08:GND
JP1-09:GND
CN5 JP1-10:GND
JP1-11:+3.3V
1 RXD JP1-12:GND REMOTE 1
2 TXD JP1-13:GND GND 2
3 /CTS JP1-14:GND GND 3
4 /RTS +5V 4
5 RDS +5V 5
Duplex AF Unit
6 NC PGND 6
7 EMPS PGND 7
8 SGND +24V 8
9 NC +24V 9
1
2
3 Power Supply Unit
4
REMOTE 9
GND 8
AC Power Switch 1 GND 7
2 +5V 6
3 +5V 5
PGND 4
AC Power Inlet PGND 3
+24V 2
+24V 1
E
N
L
LVD-01P 22 22 /RESET
24 24
SGND 23 23 SGND
25 25
LVD-00N 24 24 SDE-NB
26 26
LVD-00P 25 25 SDE-CLK Anode
27 27 1 1
SGND 26 26 SD-IN
28 28 Anode
HOME_POSITION_SENSOR 27 27 SD-OUT 2 2
29 29 Anode
SGND 28 28 SGND
30 30 3 3
LED_R 29 29 Cathode
LED_G 30 30 4 4
SGND 31 31 Cathode
32 32 CN2 CN2 5 5
SD_LATCH Cathode
SD_IN 33 33 L+24V 6 6
SGND 34 34 1 1
2 L+24V 2
+5V 35 35 L+24V
+5V 36 36 3 3
4 L+24V 4
SGND 37 37 L+24V
+24V 38 38 5 5
6 L_GND 6
+24V 39 39 L_GND
SGND 40 40 7 7
8 L_GND 8
SGND 41 41 L_GND
LED_PWM 42 42 9 9
10 L_GND 10
SGND 43 43 SGND
SD-IN 44 44 11 11
12 SGND 12
/SDEN8 45 45 +5V
SGND 46 46 13 13
14 +5V 14
SGND 47 47 +5V
SGND 48 48 15 15
16
+5V 16
SGND 49 49 SGND
SGND 50 50 17 17
18
SGND 18
SGND 51 51 SGND
SGND 52 52 19 19
20
+3.3V 20
SGND 53 53 +3.3V
SGND 54 54 21 21
22
+3.3V 22
SGND 55 55 +3.3V
SGND 56 56 23 23
24
SGND 24
SGND 57 57 SGND
SGND 58 58 25 25
26
SGND 26
SGND 59 59 +10V
SGND 60 60 27 27
28
+10V 28
SGND 61 61 SGND
SGND 62 62 29 29
SGND
[ 14-59 ]
SGND 63 63 30 30
SGND 64 64
SGND 65 65
SGND 66 66
SGND 67 67 CN6
SGND 68 68
HOME POSITION SENSOR LED 69 69 +5V 1 3 1
SGND 70 70
71 71 Original size detection sensor 7 signal 2 2 2 Original size detection sensor 7
SGND
SGND 72 72 SGND 3 1 3
SD_CLK 73 73 4
SGND 74 74
+5V
+5V 75 75 Original size detection sensor 6 signal 5
+5V 76 76 SGND 6 3 1
SGND 77 77 2 2 Original size detection sensor 6
+24V 78 78 +5V 7
+24V 79 79 Original size detection sensor 5 signal 8 1 3
SGND 80 80 9
SGND
3 1
2 2 Original size detection sensor 5
1 3
PBA, LED CN3 CN4
SGND 1 1 SGND +5V 1 3 1
LED_G 2 2 LED_G Original size detection sensor 2 signal 2 2 2 Original size detection sensor 2
LED_R 3 3 LED_R SGND 3 1 3
4 Home position sensor LED +5V 4
5 SGND Original size detection sensor 3 signal 5
6 Home position sensor signal SGND 6 3 1
+5V 7 2 2 Original size detection sensor 3
Original size detection sensor 4 signal 8 1 3
SGND 9
NC 10
3 1
3 2 2 Original size detection sensor 4
Scanner home position sensor 2 1 3
1
CN7
SGND 1
Paper sensor signal 2 Paper sensor
+5V 3
78KO
SD
(7)
(8) (9)
(6)
Various options
USB
Decouple PCB
USB Option PCB
USB
memory RMGA2 RFID
Controller PCB
Power supply
unit
Memory (3)
CPU
CIS FLASH
Sensors, switches, motors
HDD (CPU)
(1)
& actuators
FPGA (5)
FLASH
(FPGA)
(2)
Paper feed
relay PCB
& actuators
Sensors & switches
UConfirm
01423 ⛎⚕บ㒢⟎⒖േ 㐽ߓࠆ UDownloading the firmware
01423 ⛎⚕บ㒢⟎⒖േ 㐽ߓࠆ
Safe to remove the USB flash drive.
Current version New version
ᱛਛ SNALL 10.10.10
ᱛਛ
20. 0.01
SNALL 10.10.10 SNALL 20. 0.01
-SNPS 20.20.20 30. 0.01
-SNPS 20.20.20 -SNPS 30. 0.01
-SNEG 0.10. 1 0.20. 1
-SNEG 0.10. 1 -SNEG 0.20. 1
-SNPL 0.20. 1 0.30. 1
-SNPL 0.20. 1 -SNPL 0.30. 1
BSM 1.10. 1 1.20. 1
BSM 1.10. 1 BSM 1.20. 1
BAF 1. 1. 1 1. 2. 1
BAF 1. 1. 1 BAF 1. 2. 1
Downloading Completed
When the firmware downloading completes, the machine automatically reboots.
8. PCB Replacements
X3-OPTION-PCB
Controller
Decouple
PCB PCB
X3-ENGINE-PCB
X3-IP-PCB
X3-I-PF
-PCB
Power suuply Unit
PS25-NWW
Controller BOX
Recording data
generating PCB
When the HDD or Engine Control PCB is replaced, same version firmware must be installed on the replaced
HDD or Engine Control PCB.
If it happens that the machine does not boot up and there is no reference as to which machine firmware was in
the machine, following procedure will show the machine firmware version right after the HDD or Engine Control
PCB is replaced.
1. Confirm that the machine power stays OFF when the HDD or Engine Control PCB is replaced.
2. With the machine power still OFF, insert USB memory stick into the USB port on the machine, which contains
the SNALL machine firmware version, which is guessed to be the one previously installed on the machine.
3. Turn ON the machine power.
4. The machine starts to communicate with the USB memory stick and then displays the following panel display.
UConfirm
01423 ⛎⚕บ㒢⟎⒖േ 㐽ߓࠆ
5. The machine firmware version listed on the left-hand side <Current version> is the version now in the
machine, and those listed on the right-hand side <New version> is the version in the USB memory stick, as
per described on page 15-47 of this Chapter.
6.
> When the HDD is replaced :
Compare the firmware version of the Engine control PCB between the Current and New.
If the firmware program version for the Engine control PCB are the same between the two, the firmware to
install is the one in the USB memory stick.
If the two are different, the correct SNALL firmware program package version must be searched.
The chart given on the next page can be referred to find the SNALL machine firmware program package
version from the Engine control PCB firmware version.
> When the Engine control PCB is replaced :
The procedure will be the same as when the HDD is replaced, except that now the firmware version for the
HDD needs to be referred.
The same chart given on the next page can be used to find the SNALL machine firmware program package
version from the HDD firmware version.
7. If the USB memory stick contains the correct machine firmware version, proceed with the firmware
installation.
8. If the USB memory stick does not contain the correct machine firmware, press the RESET Key to cancel the
firmware downloading.
Press the Power button on the machine operation panel and turn OFF the machine.
Remove the USB memory stick from the machine.
Insert USB memory stick, with the correct SNALL machine program firmware package, on the machine and
install the machine firmware.
CAUTION:
At any time until the correct machine firmware installation is completed, do not perform any operation on the machine,
such as test mode mechanical operation, normal printing operation, etc.
If replacing the HDD due to it being unstable, but still operational, Test Mode No. 460 [HDD Value Store] and No.
461 [HDD Value Restore] are two test modes to consider using to save and restore the Admin. user settings on
the machine <refer to the test mode chapter of this technical manual.>
Brand new Hard Disk (spare part HDD) should be used for the replacement.
1. Turn OFF the machine power.
2. Open the Controller box top cover.
3. Remove the Hard Disk with the brackets attached, from the Controller box. (Shouldered screws x 4 pcs)
4. Remove the Hard Disk from the brackets. (Shouldered screws x 4 pcs)
5. Mount the new Hard Disk on the machine
6. install machine firmware for the Controller (PMS).
Caution:
Install the same version firmware as the previous Hard Disk.
The firmware package version must match with that of the Engine Control PCB or the machine may face problem with
its performance.
< Refer also to page 15-47 for the RESTRICTION information in upgrading the machine firmware.>
7. The machine reboots automatically and the Setup Wizard starts. Go through the Setup Wizard.
If the Setup Wizard starts up in Japanese Language, follow the instruction given on pages from 15-55 to 15-60
[Hard Disk (HDD) Replacement - Supplementary Information]
- This procedure should be done before going into next step to ensure that if any error message displays from
the next step on, the error message is in understandable language.
< Disregard pages from 15-53 to 15-58 if the Setup Wizard starts up in English Language.>
8. After the machine starts up, upgrade the machine firmware package version to 5.12 or above in order to
activate Test Mode No. 0510 (next step).
< Disregard this step-8 if the machine firmware program package version is already SNALL 5.12.2 or above.>
9. After confirming that the machine firmware is SNALL 5.12.2 or above, activate Test Mode No. 0510.
< Make sure to activate Test Mode No. 0510 in this step-9 regardless of whether the Setup Wizard came out in English or in
Japanese Language in above step-6. Test Mode No. 0510 checks whether the machine is International Mode or Japanese Model
and sends the information to the HDD. >
Counters Counters
2-1 : Hard Disk (HDD) replaced and if machine powered back ON without firmware
< Brand new Spare Part >
downloading.
Default Admin. settings & User settings Adjustment Parameter Backup Area
< Factory Default of the very early Firmware> Test Mode setting on Engine Control PCB
Image Adjustment Parameter Backup Area by (Image adjustment Test Modes included)
Test Mode No. 440.
Counters
Image Adjustment Parameter
2-2 : Hard Disk (HDD) replaced and if correct machine firmware downloaded <before
auto-reboot>.
Counters Counters
Default Admin. settings & User settings Adjustment Parameter Backup Area
< Factory Default of the very early Firmware> Test Mode setting on Engine Control PCB
Image Adjustment Parameter Backup Area by (Image adjustment Test Modes included)
Test Mode No. 440.
Counters
Image Adjustment Parameter
Default Admin. settings & User settings Adjustment Parameter Backup Area
< Factory Default of the Firmware just installed.> Test Mode setting on Engine Control PCB
Image Adjustment Parameter Backup Area by (Image adjustment Test Modes included)
Test Mode No. 440.
Counters
Image Adjustment Parameter
The data lost in replacing the Hard Disk. <There are no backup data for these items>
• Test Modes dedicated to the Controller (Test Mode Numbers 07xx).
• Admin. settings and other User settings.
• <Test Mode No. 460 before and No. 461 after the HDD replacement, if the former HDD is still
operational before the replacement, can restore the Admin. and User settings.>
• User data (Users, Print jobs, Folder data, Scaner files).
When turning the machine power ON for the first time, after the new spare part Hard Disk replacement, the
machine touch panel shows the display in Japanese Language (Setup Wizard display).
The panel display is converted into English Language only after the English Language is selected on the Setup
Wizard.
Make sure that the English Language or your selection of language is selected during the Setup Wizard input
procedure through the Japanese Language Setup Wizard screen.
If done correctly, the machine will display the selected Language thereafter.
The first display to show up on the operation panel of the ComColor, after the replacement of the Hard Disk, is a
Setup Wizard display in Japanese Language.
In order that the Japanese Language Display is understood, Japanese & English display comparison follows on
the next page.
The Japanese Language display, shown on the left hand side of the page, will display when the ComColor
machine is powered ON for the first time after the Hard Disk replacement.
The English Language display, shown on the right hand side of the page, is the English reference of the
Japanese Language display on the left.
2. Select English or the Language of your choice, and then push the Next button on the following display.Since the
spare part Hard Disk contains low version machine firmware, you may not get your selection of language. In that
case, select your choice from those available, and re-select your language from the Admin setting after updating
the firmware on the machine.
CAUTION ! : If you do not select English or selection of your language, or if you press the Cancel button on this
display, you will be stuck with the Japanese Language again. Select the choice of your language and press the Next
button.
3. Select inch and then push the Next button on the following display.
NOTE: It is of no problem if the Next button is pushed with a wrong selection. Use test mode No. 505 [SETUP WIZ-
ARD INITIALIZE] later and choose the correct selection or go into the Admin to make the selection.
4. Select the correct Time Zone and then push the Next button on the following display.
NOTE: It is of no problem if the Next button is pushed with a wrong selection.
Use test mode No. 505 [SETUP WIZARD INITIALIZE] later and choose the correct selection.
5. Input the correct Clock/Date and then push the Next button on the following display.
NOTE: It is of no problem if the Next button is pushed with wrong input.
Use test mode No. 505 [SETUP WIZARD INITIALIZE] later and input the correct Clock/Date or go into the Admin to
set the Clock/Date.
6. Input the Network Setting and then push the Next button on the following display.
NOTE: It is of no problem if the Next button is pushed without the network information.
The network information can be input in the machine later. Use test mode No. 505 [SETUP WIZARD INITIALIZE]
later and input the network setting or go into the Admin to input the network setting.
7. Input the Function Key Entry and then push the Next button on the following display.
NOTE: It is of no problem if the Next button is pushed without entering the Function Key Entry selection.
Use test mode No. 505 [SETUP WIZARD INITIALIZE] later and input the Function Key entry or go into the Admin to
input the Function key setting.
CAUTION ! : Do not press the Cancel button.
The Setup Wizard display closes and you will be stuck with the Japanese Language again.
8. Input the Color Mode and then push the Next button on the following display.
NOTE: It is of no problem if the Next button is pushed without making the Color Mode selection.
Use test mode No. 505 [SETUP WIZARD INITIALIZE] later and make the Color Mode selection if needed.
The selection can also be made on the user mode display.
9. Select the Output Tray and then push the Next button on the following display.
NOTE: It is of no problem if the Next button is pushed without making the Output Tray selection.
Use test mode No. 505 [SETUP WIZARD INITIALIZE] later and make the selection or go into the Admin to input the
selection.
CAUTION ! : Do not press the Cancel button.
The Setup Wizard display closes and you will be stuck with the Japanese Language again.
10. Make the Feed Tray auto/manual selection and then push the Next button on the following display.
NOTE: It is of no problem if the Next button is pushed without making the selection.
Use test mode No. 505 [SETUP WIZARD INITIALIZE] later and make the selection.
The setting can also be made on the user mode display.
CAUTION ! : Do not press the Cancel button.
The Setup Wizard display closes and you will be stuck with the Japanese Language again.
11. Select the Login Setting and then push the Next button on the following display.
NOTE: It is of no problem if the Next button is pushed without making the selection.
Use test mode No. 505 [SETUP WIZARD INITIALIZE] later and make the selection or go into the Admin to make the
setting selection.
12. Select the Security Level and then push the Next button on the following display.
NOTE: It is of no problem if the Next button is pushed without making the selection.
Use test mode No. 505 [SETUP WIZARD INITIALIZE] later and make the selection.
13. Select the User Category and then push the OK button on the following display.
14. The Setup Wizard ends and the user operation display is shown.
NOTE: The operation panel language is changed to the Language you have selected. (Below is a sample of English
Language.)
After the above [Select Operation mode] panel display appears, turn OFF the machine power, and then proceed
with the machine Firmware upgrading procedure.
- END -
screw screw
Memory
CPU
LAN
LAN
USB USB USB USB
ICH
Controller PCB
LineOut
Controller PCB
screw screw
Screw Screw
Since the machine, on which the machine power is never turned ON, the HDD has not communicated with the Engine
Control PCB, and therefore has no backup test mode settings saved from the Engine Control PCB.
For this reason, the factory default test mode setting data is installed in the HDD when the machine is shipped.
IMPORTANT:
Test Mode No. 451 should not be applied on a machine on which the machine power had turned ON once and ma-
chine had booted correctly.
HDD then already has communicated with the Engine Control PCB and has the test modes settings copied from the
Engine Control PCB.
screw screw
screw
Option PCB
screw (if mounted) screw
screw
screw
Engine Control PCB
screw screw
screw
Counters Counters
Step 2 : Engine control PCB replaced, but machine power still OFF.
Counters Counters
Counters Counters
Counters Counters
Au re
are restored
to st
Same data
from HDD.
m or
at ed
ic
al
ly
screw
screw
screw
screw
screw
screw
Contents
To understand the nature of errors, you can find the error point and variation code in the section "Error Code
Display Details," organized by error type.
S04 2130
S04-2130
!!System Error!!
Reboot by press the Sub Power Key
If recovery has failed,
call service.
S98 1811 1
Variation Code
X Jam Errors
Details A problem has occurred that prevents normal paper transfer.
Solution Users resolve these errors.
Users are only notified in modes where there is a possibility that the relevant unit
may be used. If users switch to a mode in which the unit is not used, notification is
Notification
canceled. Note that even in modes where the unit is not used, error status can be
checked by referring to error LEDs.
Only operating modes that do not use the unit can be accessed until the error is
Operation
cleared.
Resuming Jobs It is possible to resume jobs interrupted by the error.
Mechanical operations are promptly stopped when these errors occur, to avoid
Other
causing other damage.
Y Supply Errors
Details Consumables must be replaced or waste material must be removed.
Resuming Jobs It is possible to resume jobs interrupted by the error.
After the condition of the error occurs, normal operation is continued to the extent
Other
possible until a convenient time to stop processing.
I Information
A situation has occurred that users must be informed about, such as the time for
Details
regular part replacement.
Users respond to the tip, which can be cleared by users through panel operations.
Solution
However, a permanent solution will require service by a service technician.
Users are only notified in modes where there is a possibility that the relevant unit
may be used. If users switch to a mode in which the unit is not used, notification is
Notification
canceled. Note that even in modes where the unit is not used, information status can
be checked by referring to error LEDs.
Operation Conditions for information messages do not affect current processing.
W Warnings
Details A problem has occurred that users must be warned about.
Solution Users respond to warnings, which can be cleared by users through panel operations.
Users are only notified in modes where there is a possibility that the relevant unit
may be used. If users switch to a mode in which the unit is not used, notification is
Notification
canceled. Note that even in modes where the unit is not used, warning status can be
checked by referring to error LEDs.
After the condition of the warning occurs, normal operation is continued to the extent
Operation
possible until a convenient time to stop processing.
It is possible to resume jobs interrupted by the warning. (However, some warnings
Resuming Jobs
prevent jobs from being resumed.)
H13
H15
H8
H9 H6
H11 H7
H5 H14
H1
H10
2-3. Requirements to Clear Jams, with Respect to Positions of Paper Still in Printer
Button in
Group Point Requirement to Clear Jam
Display
Open/close front door and deactivate registration sensor, top edge sensor, and FU
H5 B
paper ejection sensor
H6 Unused
H7 C Open/close front door and deactivate paper elevation IN sensor
H8 D Open/close front door and deactivate flipper sensor and FD paper ejection sensor
H9 E Open/close front door and deactivate upper transfer OUT sensor
Open/close front door and deactivate vertical paper feed sensors 4 and 5
Front door H10 A
(When the paper feed was made from tray 1)
H16 C Open/close front door and deactivate FD paper ejection sensor
Open/close front door and deactivate paper elevation IN sensor and FU paper
H17 C ejection sensor
(H17 appears only when [H7] and [H16] occur simultaneously)
Open/close front door and deactivate vertical paper feed sensors 4 and 5
H18 A
(When the paper feed was made from tray 2 or tray 3)
H2 J Open/close tray 1
Tray H3 K Open/close tray 2
H4 L Open/close tray 3
H1 N Deactivate the registration sensor and press Refresh on the panel
H13 M Deactivate the FD paper ejection sensor and press Refresh or Close on the panel
Paper supply Deactivate the FD paper ejection sensor and press Refresh or Close on the panel
and ejection H14 P Note: When a finisher is installed, this error corresponds to Group 1. (Refer to the
information on clearing jams from the finisher.)
H15 F Deactivate the switchback sensor and press Refresh or Close on the panel
Switchback H11 G Open/close jam release door 5 and deactivate the re-feed sensor
Vertical paper
H12 H Open/close jam release door 6 and deactivate vertical paper feed sensors 1–3.
feed
X??-???? Refresh
Paper has jammed. To display the removal method,
touch the button shown in the figure below.
3-3. Warnings
Warnings Warnings
Page Page
Type Name Type Name
W01 AF communication warning 53 W56 Check paper size setting 64
W02 Specified paper not loaded 53 W57 Adjustment values not saved 65
W03 No paper loaded (all trays) 53 W58 CIS auto adjustment failed 65
W04 No paper loaded (paper feed tray) 54 W59 CIS operation check failed 65
W05 No paper loaded (tray 1) 54 Failed to connect to scanning destination
W06 No paper loaded (tray 2) 54 W60 65
server
W07 No paper loaded (tray 3) 55 W61 Cannot save scan file on server 65
W08 No slip sheet paper loaded 55 W62 Press start key 66
W09 No cover paper loaded 55 W63 Supply main power again 66
W10 Top tray full 55 W64 HDD initialization error 66
W11 Stacking tray full 56 W66 External CI connection error 66
W12 Booklet tray full 56 W67 Remote agent communication error 66
W13 3-fold tray full 56 W68 BP belt stain detection 66
W14 Envelope setting error 56 W69 Paper feed tray not ready 66
W15 No factory setting restore data 56 W70 Test mode non-completion 67
W16 Cannot move for auto stacking 57 W71 Incompletely printed paper ejected 67
W17 Controller hard disk full 57 W72 PB error 67
W18 Specified paper size not supported 57 W73 Paper width confirmation 67
W19 Restart finisher 57 W74 Memory shortage error 67
W20 Scratch sheets in top tray 57 W75 No paper(Tray) 67
W21 Scratch sheets in stacking tray 58 W76 Paper size error(Booklet) 68
W22 Scratch sheets in booklet tray 58 W77 Incorrect download firmware 68
W23 Scratch sheets in 3-fold tray 58 W78 No paper(High capacity feeder) 68
W24 FD paper receiving tray full 58 W79 OST overloaded 68
W25 Stapler unit not connected 58 W80 Not enough coin put in the vendor 68
W26 Puncher unit not connected 58 W81 Reboot the machine power 68
W27 Top tray not connected 59 W82 Print control device error 69
W28 Stacking tray not connected 59 W84 Paper size error(Offset Eject) 69
W29 Booklet tray not connected 59 W85 Security package mismatch 69
W30 3-fold tray not connected 59 W86 Security package installation failed 69
W31 Cannot lower stacking tray 59 W87 Security package key-code error 69
W32 Stapler unit not available 59 W88 Kerberos server error 70
W33 Puncher unit not available 60 W89 LDAP server error 70
W34 Top tray not available 60 W90 External Server error 70
W35 Stacking tray not available 60 W91 Paper size error(Staple/Punch) 70
W36 Booklet tray not available 60 W92 USB memory error 70
W37 3-fold tray not available 60 W93 Email address error 70
W38 Offset Stapler staple over limit 61 W94 Mail server setting error 70
W39 No destination for continuous output 61 W95 Email data size over the limit 71
W40 Paused job deleted 61 W96 Email transmission error(Server) 71
W41 AS paper full detected 61 W97 Email transmission error(User) 71
W42 OST paper remain 61 W98 USB file read error 71
Specified size not loaded in slip sheet W99 Generic consumable warning 71
W43 62
tray W100 PB cover size error 72
W44 Specified size not loaded in cover tray 62 W101 PB cover set error 72
W45 Unsupported combination of paper sizes 62 W102 PB body paper size error 72
W46 No tray for auto ejection 62 W103 PB body/cover unmatched error 72
W47 Image adjustment failed 63 W104 PB body thickness error 72
Duplicate file names on USB memory W105 PB body set error 72
W48 63
W106 Cannot execute mail creation 73
device
W49 USB memory save error 63 W108 HCS tray full detection 73
W50 Insufficient USB memory capacity 63 W109 MM letter number limit error 73
W51 Request to start recovery operations 64 W110 MM original not suitable, no size 73
W52 Check load capacity on tray 64
W53 USB memory mounting error 64
W54 Paper size error(Fold) 64
W55 MM stacker full error 64
Type Z28: Internal paper feed jam door open (BP lower limit)
Display Close the jam release cover (H).
Clear Close the jam release door on the base.
Point Description
1254 The internal paper feed jam release door is open when the belt platen is in the lower limit position.
Code Type Page Code Type Page Code Type Page Code Type Page
0239 W61 65 0314 1-2 W54 64 1053 X26 87 1123 X03 83
0240 W14 56 0315 1-2 W54 64 1054 X10 84 1124 X29 87
0241 1-6 S95 24 0316 1-2 W54 64 1055 1-2 X12 85 1125 X30 87
0242 W64 66 0317 1-2 W76 68 1056 X09 84 1127 W195 82
0243 W66 66 0318 1-2 W84 69 1057 1-3 X12 85 1130 S01 12
0244 1-4 W67 66 0320 I11 100 1058 1-6 X02 83 1131 S01 12
0245 W68 66 0325 1-2 W14 56 1059 X02 83 1132 S01 12
0246 S99 36 0326 1-2 W14 56 1060 X04 83 1140 S37 19
0247 1-4 W70 67 0327 1-2 W14 56 1061 X06 84 1141 S37 19
0248 S98 29 1000 1-2 W04 54 1062 X06 84 1142 S37 19
0250 S98 29 1001 1-2 W05 54 1063 X08 84 1143 S37 19
0251 S98 29 1002 1-2 W06 54 1064 X27 87 1150 W24 58
0252 W70 67 1003 1-2 W07 55 1065 X03 83 1151 W41 61
0253 S98 29 1004 1-2 W45 62 1066 X08 84 1153 S40 20
0255 W47 63 1005 1-2 W02 53 1070 X01 83 1154 W39 61
0256 U01 40 1006 1-2 W18 57 1071 1-3 X11 84 1155 1-2 S99 37
0257 U01 40 1007 Z09 95 1072 X08 84 1160 1-2 S99 37
0260 S94 23 1008 Z10 95 1073 X12 85 1202 S98 29
0261 S94 23 1009 Z11 95 1074 X12 85 1203 S98 29
0262 U90 48 1011 1 W03 53 1075 1-2 X12 85 1204 S98 29
0263 1-3 W88 70 1012 1-2 W08 55 1076 X11 84 1206 S13 15
0264 W89 70 1013 1-2 W09 55 1077 1-3 X11 84 1207 S96 25
0265 W90 70 1014 1-2 W09 55 1078 1-6 X02 83 1208 S96 25
0267 W98 71 1015 1-2 W43 62 1079 X02 83 1209 S96 25
0270 W15 56 1016 1-2 W44 62 1080 X05 83 1210 S96 25
0280 1-9 W49 63 1017 1-2 W44 62 1081 X06 84 1211 Z05 94
0281 S90 22 1018 1-2 W46 62 1082 X07 84 1212 Z05 94
0282 S88 22 1019 1-2 W75 67 1083 X08 84 1213 Z06 95
0283 S89 22 1030 S02 12 1084 X28 87 1215 S12 14
0284 1-4 S99 37 1031 S42 20 1085 X03 83 1216 S12 14
0285 1-4 S99 37 1032 S43 20 1090 Z08 95 1217 S12 14
0286 1-4 S99 37 1033 S44 21 1095 Z21 96 1218 S12 14
0287 1-4 S99 37 1034 S11 14 1096 S02 12 1220 S12 14
0288 W92 70 1035 S10 14 1100 1-6 X32 87 1221 S12 14
0289 W106 73 1036 S10 14 1101 1-6 X32 87 1222 S12 14
0290 W72 67 1037 S11 14 1102 1-5 X14 85 1223 S12 14
0291 W74 67 1038 S01 12 1110 X02 83 1250 Z25 96
0301 1-2 W14 56 1039 S28 15 1111 X12 85 1251 Z26 96
0302 1-2 W14 56 1040 S29 15 1112 X12 85 1252 Z27 96
0303 1-2 W14 56 1041 S30 16 1113 X12 85 1253 Z24 96
0304 1-2 W14 56 1042 S31 16 1114 X09 84 1254 Z28 96
0305 1-2 W14 56 1043 S12 14 1115 X11 84 1255 Z22 96
0306 W14 56 1044 S12 14 1116 X02 83 1256 Z22 96
0307 1-2 W14 56 1045 S42 20 1117 X02 83 1257 Z23 96
0309 1-2 W50 63 1046 S43 20 1118 X05 83 1300 W56 64
0310 1-2 W50 63 1047 S44 21 1119 X06 84 1301 W51 64
0311 1-2 W50 63 1050 X01 83 1120 X07 84 1302 S99 37
0312 1-2 W91 70 1051 1-3 X11 84 1121 X08 84 1303 W73 67
0313 1-2 W91 70 1052 X08 84 1122 X28 87 1310 S98 29
Code Type Page Code Type Page Code Type Page Code Type Page
1311 S98 29 1932 S94 23 2041 S34 16 2112 1-2 Z04 94
1312 S98 29 1933 S94 23 2050 S35 17 2113 1-2 Z04 94
1313 S98 29 1934 S94 23 2051 S35 17 2114 1-2 Z04 94
1400 S98 29 1935 W69 66 2052 S35 17 2115 1-2 Z04 94
1401 S98 29 1936 I09 100 2053 S35 17 2116 X120 92
1402 S99 37 1937 W71 67 2054 S35 17 2117 X120 92
1403 I01 99 1938 X72 90 2055 S35 17 2118 X120 92
1404 1-5 S99 37 1940 1-2 S98 29 2056 S35 17 2119 X120 92
1405 S98 29 1941 S53 21 2057 S35 17 2120 1-6 Z04 94
1406 1-5 S98 29 1942 1-5 S53 21 2058 1-2 S35 17 2121 1-6 Z04 94
1407 S98 29 1943 1-5 S53 21 2060 S35 17 2122 1-6 Z04 94
1408 S98 29 1944 1-5 S53 21 2061 S14 15 2123 1-6 Z04 94
1409 S98 29 1945 1-5 S53 21 2062 I02 99 2124 W99 71
1410 S98 29 1946 1-5 S53 21 2063 S96 25 2125 Z02 94
1411 S98 29 1947 2 W100 72 2064 S35 17 2126 Z02 94
1412 S98 29 1948 2 W101 72 2065 S35 17 2127 Z02 94
1413 S98 29 1949 1-2 W102 72 2066 S35 17 2128 Z02 94
1414 S98 29 1955 W52 64 2067 S35 17 2130 S04 13
1415 S99 37 1956 W52 64 2068 1-4 S36 19 2131 S04 13
1800 1-9 S98 29 1957 W52 64 2069 1-2 S35 17 2132 S04 13
1801 1-6 S98 29 2000 S03 12 2070 1-2 S35 17 2133 S04 13
1801 7-9 S98 29 2001 S03 12 2071 1-2 S35 17 2134 S04 13
1810 S98 29 2002 S03 12 2072 1-2 S35 17 2135 S04 13
1811 1-3 S98 29 2003 S03 12 2073 1-2 S35 17 2136 S04 13
1812 1-3 S98 29 2004 S03 12 2074 1-2 S35 17 2137 S04 13
1813 S90 22 2005 S03 12 2075 1-2 S35 17 2140 1-2 S05 13
1814 I03 99 2006 S03 12 2076 1-2 S35 17 2141 1-2 S05 13
1900 S94 23 2007 1-2 S03 12 2077 S35 17 2142 1-2 S05 13
1901 S94 23 2008 S03 12 2078 1-4 S36 19 2143 1-2 S05 13
1902 S94 23 2009 S03 12 2079 1-4 S35 18 2144 1-2 S05 13
1903 S94 23 2010 S03 12 2080 1-4 S36 19 2145 1-2 S05 13
1904 S94 23 2011 S03 12 2081 1-2 S35 18 2146 1-2 S05 13
1905 S94 23 2012 1-4 S03 12 2082 1-2 S35 18 2147 1-2 S05 13
1906 S94 23 2012 5-8 S03 12 2083 1-2 S35 18 2148 1-2 S05 13
1910 S94 23 2013 S03 12 2084 1-2 S35 18 2149 1-2 S05 13
1911 S94 23 2014 1-5 S03 13 2085 1-4 S35 18 2150 1-2 S05 13
1912 S94 23 2015 1-4 S03 13 2099 1-4 I05 99 2151 1-2 S05 13
1913 S94 23 2015 5-8 S03 13 2100 X120 92 2152 1-2 S05 13
1914 S94 23 2020 S32 16 2101 X120 92 2153 1-2 S05 13
1915 S94 23 2021 S32 16 2102 X120 92 2154 1-2 S05 13
1920 S92 22 2022 S32 16 2103 X120 92 2155 1-2 S05 13
1921 S94 23 2023 S32 16 2104 Z03 94 2156 1-2 S05 13
1922 S94 23 2024 S32 16 2105 Z03 94 2157 1-2 S05 13
1923 S94 23 2025 S32 16 2106 Z03 94 2158 1-2 S05 13
1924 S94 23 2030 S33 16 2107 Z03 94 2159 1-2 S05 13
1925 S94 23 2031 S33 16 2108 1-9 Z04 94 2160 1-2 S05 13
1926 S94 23 2032 S33 16 2109 1-9 Z04 94 2161 1-2 S05 13
1930 S94 23 2033 S33 16 2110 1-9 Z04 94 2162 1-2 S05 13
1931 S94 23 2040 S34 16 2111 1-9 Z04 94 2163 1-2 S05 13
Code Type Page Code Type Page Code Type Page Code Type Page
2164 1-2 S39 19 2230 1-4 S98 30 2291 1-2 S98 30 2376 Z60 98
2170 S07 14 2231 1-4 S98 30 2292 1-2 S98 30 2377 Z60 98
2171 S07 14 2232 1-4 S98 30 2293 1-2 S98 30 2378 Z60 98
2172 S07 14 2233 1-4 S98 30 2294 1-2 S98 30 2520 1-3 U51 45
2173 S07 14 2234 1-4 S98 30 2295 1-2 S98 30 2521 U51 45
2174 S07 14 2235 1-4 S98 30 2296 1-2 S98 30 2522 U51 45
2175 S07 14 2236 1-4 S98 30 2297 1-2 S98 30 2523 1-9 U55 46
2176 S07 14 2237 1-4 S98 30 2298 1-2 S98 30 2524 1-9 U55 46
2177 S07 14 2238 1-4 S98 30 2299 1-2 S98 30 2525 U55 46
2178 S07 14 2239 1-4 S98 30 2300 1-2 S98 30 2526 U55 46
2179 S07 14 2240 1-4 S98 30 2301 1-2 S98 30 2527 1-9 U56 47
2180 S07 14 2241 1-4 S98 30 2302 1-2 S98 30 2528 1-9 U56 47
2181 S07 14 2242 1-4 S98 30 2303 1-2 S98 30 2529 U51 45
2182 S07 14 2243 1-4 S98 30 2304 1-2 S98 30 2530 U51 45
2183 S07 14 2244 1-4 S98 30 2305 1-2 S98 30 2531 U55 46
2184 S07 14 2245 1-4 S98 30 2306 1-2 S98 30 2540 X51 88
2185 S07 14 2246 1-4 S98 30 2307 1-2 S98 30 2541 X51 88
2186 S07 14 2247 1-4 S98 30 2308 1-2 S98 30 2542 X51 88
2187 S07 14 2248 1-4 S98 30 2309 1-2 S98 30 2543 X51 88
2188 S07 14 2249 1-4 S98 30 2310 1-2 S98 30 2544 X51 88
2189 S07 14 2250 1-4 S98 30 2311 1-2 S98 30 2545 X51 88
2190 S07 14 2251 1-4 S98 30 2312 1-2 S98 30 2546 X51 88
2191 S07 14 2252 1-4 S98 30 2313 1-2 S98 30 2547 X51 88
2192 S07 14 2253 1-4 S98 30 2320 1-2 S98 30 2548 X51 88
2193 S07 14 2260 1-2 S98 30 2321 1-2 S98 30 2550 X70 90
2200 S06 13 2261 1-2 S98 30 2322 1-2 S98 30 2560 Z51 97
2201 S06 13 2262 1-2 S98 30 2323 1-2 S98 30 2561 Z54 97
2202 S06 13 2263 1-2 S98 30 2324 1-2 S98 30 2580 1-2 W78 68
2203 S06 13 2264 1-2 S98 30 2325 1-2 S98 30 2581 W191 82
2204 S06 13 2265 1-2 S98 30 2326 1-2 S98 30 2600 W190 82
2205 S06 13 2266 1-2 S98 30 2327 1-2 S98 30 2601 U56 47
2206 S06 13 2267 1-2 S98 30 2328 1-2 S98 30 2602 U55 46
2207 S06 13 2268 1-2 S98 30 2329 1-2 S98 30 2603 U55 46
2208 S06 13 2269 1-2 S98 30 2330 1-2 S98 30 2604 U55 46
2209 S06 13 2270 1-2 S98 30 2331 1-2 S98 30 2605 U55 46
2210 S06 13 2271 1-2 S98 30 2332 1-2 S98 30 2606 U56 47
2211 S06 13 2272 1-2 S98 30 2333 1-2 S98 30 2607 U55 46
2212 S06 13 2273 1-2 S98 30 2334 1-2 S98 30 2608 U55 46
2213 S06 13 2274 1-2 S98 30 2335 1-2 S98 30 2609 U55 46
2214 S06 13 2275 1-2 S98 30 2336 1-2 S98 30 2610 U55 46
2215 S06 13 2276 1-2 S98 30 2337 1-2 S98 30 2611 U55 46
2216 S06 13 2277 1-2 S98 30 2338 1-2 S98 30 2612 U56 47
2217 S06 13 2278 1-2 S98 30 2339 1-2 S98 30 2613 U56 47
2218 S06 13 2279 1-2 S98 30 2340 1-2 S98 30 2614 1-9 U56 47
2219 S06 13 2280 1-2 S98 30 2341 1-2 S98 30 2615 1-9 U56 47
2220 S06 13 2281 1-2 S98 30 2342 1-2 S98 30 2616 1-9 U56 47
2221 S06 13 2282 1-2 S98 30 2343 1-2 S98 30 2617 1-9 U56 47
2222 S06 13 2283 1-2 S98 30 2350 1-4 S98 31 2618 1-9 U56 47
2223 S06 13 2290 1-2 S98 30 2375 Z60 98 2619 1-9 U56 47
Code Type Page Code Type Page Code Type Page Code Type Page
3000 S19 15 3088 U17 44 3173 X21 86 3360 U53 45
3001 S19 15 3089 U17 44 3174 X21 86 3361 U53 45
3002 S20 15 3090 U17 44 3175 X21 86 3362 1-2 U54 46
3003 S20 15 3091 U17 44 3176 X21 86 3363 1-2 U54 46
3004 S20 15 3092 U17 44 3177 X22 86 3364 1-2 U54 46
3005 S20 15 3093 U17 44 3178 X24 86 3365 1-2 U54 46
3006 S20 15 3094 U17 44 3179 X24 86 3366 1-2 U54 46
3007 S20 15 3095 U17 44 3200 1-2 Y03 92 3367 1-3 U54 46
3015 S94 24 3096 U17 44 3201 1-2 Y04 92 3368 1-2 U54 46
3020 S98 31 3097 U17 44 3202 1-2 Y05 92 3369 1-4 U54 46
3021 S98 31 3120 Z14 95 3203 1-2 Y05 92 3370 1-5 U54 46
3022 S98 31 3121 Z16 95 3220 1-2 W10 55 3371 U57 47
3023 S98 31 3122 Z17 95 3221 1-2 W11 56 3372 U57 47
3030 1-2 S99 37 3123 Z18 95 3222 1-2 W11 56 3373 1-2 U54 46
3031 1-9 S99 37 3124 Z20 96 3223 1-2 W12 56 3374 1-2 U54 46
3032 1-5 S99 38 3125 1-2 W31 59 3224 1-2 W13 56 3380 1-2 U58 47
3033 1-3 S99 38 3140 X17 85 3225 W25 58 3388 X52 88
3034 S99 38 3141 X17 85 3226 W26 58 3389 X52 88
3035 S99 38 3142 X18 85 3227 W27 59 3392 X52 88
3036 1-6 S99 38 3143 X18 85 3228 W28 59 3393 X52 88
3037 1-6 S99 38 3144 X18 85 3229 W29 59 3394 X52 88
3060 U11 43 3145 X18 85 3230 W30 59 3395 X52 88
3061 U12 43 3146 X19 85 3231 W20 57 3396 X52 88
3062 U12 43 3147 X19 85 3232 W21 58 3397 X52 88
3063 U12 43 3148 X19 85 3233 W22 58 3398 X52 88
3064 U12 43 3149 X19 85 3234 W23 58 3399 X52 88
3065 U12 43 3150 X19 85 3235 W19 57 3400 X52 88
3066 U12 43 3151 X21 86 3236 1-2 W31 59 3401 X52 88
3067 U12 43 3152 X21 86 3237 W32 59 3402 X52 88
3068 U12 43 3153 X21 86 3238 W33 60 3418 Y07 92
3069 U12 43 3154 X21 86 3239 W34 60 3423 Z52 97
3070 U12 43 3155 X21 86 3240 W35 60 3424 Z53 97
3071 U12 43 3156 X21 86 3241 W36 60 3453 W79 68
3072 U12 43 3157 X21 86 3242 W37 60 3455 W38 61
3073 U12 43 3158 X22 86 3243 W18 57 3456 1-2 W42 61
3074 U12 43 3159 X22 86 3244 1-2 W126 75 3457 W128 75
3075 U12 43 3160 X24 86 3245 1-2 W127 75 3483 1-3 I10 100
3076 U12 43 3161 X24 86 3246 W127 75 3484 I10 100
3077 U12 43 3162 X24 86 3247 W136 76 3485 1-2 I10 100
3078 U12 43 3163 X24 86 3248 W137 76 3486 1 I10 100
3079 U14 44 3164 X17 85 3301 W16 57 3489 U09 42
3080 U14 44 3165 X17 85 3302 W16 57 3490 U09 42
3081 U14 44 3166 X18 85 3304 W16 57 3491 U09 42
3082 U14 44 3167 X18 85 3305 W16 57 3492 U09 42
3083 U14 44 3168 X19 85 3325 U14 44 3493 1-6 S93 23
3084 U16 44 3169 X19 85 3326 U16 44 3494 U09 42
3085 U16 44 3170 X19 85 3327 U19 45 3495 U129 52
3086 U16 44 3171 X21 86 3358 U52 45 3496 U129 52
3087 U17 44 3172 X21 86 3359 U52 45 3497 U09 42
Code Type Page Code Type Page Code Type Page Code Type Page
3498 U09 42 3547 U88 48 3597 X74 91 3654 X54 89
3499 U09 42 3548 U88 48 3598 X74 91 3655 S110 39
3500 U09 42 3549 1-2 U88 48 3599 X74 91 3656 W116 73
3501 U09 42 3550 U88 48 3600 X74 91 3657 W117 73
3502 X54 88 3551 U88 48 3601 X74 91 3658 W118 74
3503 X54 88 3552 U88 48 3602 X74 91 3659 W196 82
3504 X54 88 3553 U88 48 3603 X74 91 3660 1-2 W150 76
3505 X54 88 3554 1-3 U89 48 3604 X74 91 3661 U128 52
3506 X54 88 3555 1-3 U89 48 3605 X74 91 3662 U128 52
3507 X54 89 3556 Z56 97 3606 X74 91 3665 U09 43
3508 X54 89 3557 1-2 W103 72 3607 X74 91 3666 U09 43
3509 X54 89 3558 3-4 W104 72 3608 X74 91 3667 U09 43
3510 X54 89 3559 U105 50 3609 X74 91 3668 U09 43
3511 X54 89 3560 U106 51 3610 X74 91 3669 U09 43
3512 X54 89 3561 Y10 93 3611 X74 91 3670 U09 43
3513 X54 89 3562 1-2 W120 74 3612 X74 91 3671 U09 43
3514 X54 89 3563 W120 74 3613 X74 91 3672 U110 51
3515 X54 89 3564 U88 48 3614 U91 49 3675 S99 38
3516 X54 89 3565 W121 74 3615 U91 49 3676 S99 38
3517 X54 89 3566 W122 74 3616 U91 49 3677 1-5 S99 38
3518 U09 42 3567 W123 74 3617 U91 49 3678 1-5 S99 38
3519 X54 89 3568 W129 75 3618 U91 49 3680 X54 89
3520 X54 89 3569 I15 100 3619 U91 49 3681 X54 89
3521 X54 89 3570 X73 90 3620 U91 49 3682 X54 89
3522 X54 89 3571 X73 90 3621 U91 49 3702 1-2 W157 77
3523 X54 89 3572 X73 90 3622 U91 49 3703 1-2 W158 77
3524 X54 89 3573 X73 90 3623 W130 75 3704 1-2 W161 78
3525 X54 89 3574 X73 90 3624 W108 73 3705 1-2 W162 78
3526 X54 89 3575 X73 90 3625 1-9 S87 22 3710 1-2 W170 78
3527 X54 89 3576 X73 90 3626 Z57 97 3711 1-2 W171 78
3528 X54 89 3578 X73 90 3627 Z61 98 3712 1-2 W172 79
3529 X54 89 3579 X73 90 3628 U125 52 3713 1-2 W173 79
3530 X54 89 3580 X73 90 3629 U129 52 3714 1-2 W174 79
3531 X54 89 3581 X73 90 3630 1-2 U91 49 3715 1-2 W175 79
3532 X54 89 3582 U120 51 3632 Z62 98 3716 1-2 W176 80
3533 X54 89 3582 X73 91 3633 Z63 98 3717 1-2 W177 80
3534 W55 64 3583 X73 91 3634 W119 74 3718 1-2 W186 81
3535 Y08 93 3584 X73 91 3635 X54 89 3719 1-2 W187 81
3536 Z55 97 3585 X73 91 3636 X54 89 3720 W179 80
3537 X54 89 3586 X73 91 3637 X54 89 3732 W182 80
3538 W184 81 3587 Z64 98 3638 X54 89 3733 W183 80
3539 1-2 U88 48 3588 Z65 98 3639 X54 89 3734 1-2 W159 77
3540 U88 48 3590 Y09 93 3640 X54 89 3735 1-2 W160 77
3541 U88 48 3591 1-9 S100 39 3641 X54 89 3736 W188 81
3542 U88 48 3592 1-8 S100 39 3645 W109 73 3737 W189 81
3543 1-3 U88 48 3593 X74 91 3646 W110 73 3760 W105 72
3544 U88 48 3594 X74 91 3649 S100 39 3762 1-2 S107 39
3545 U88 48 3595 X74 91 3650 U92 49 3763 W124 74
3546 U88 48 3596 X74 91 3653 X54 89 3764 W125 75
Code Type Page Code Type Page Code Type Page Code Type Page
3765 U111 51 4143 U98 50 4440 U04 41 5534 S98 31
3800 X120 91 4144 U98 50 4441 U04 41 5535 U115 51
3801 X120 91 4150 U98 50 4442 U04 41 5551 U116 51
3850 W130 75 4160 U99 50 4449 U04 41 5552 U116 51
3851 1-2 W131 76 4180 U98 50 4450 U05 41 5553 U116 51
3853 W130 75 4190 U98 50 4460 W01 53 5554 U127 52
3855 1-9 S87 22 4200 U02 40 4461 U05 41 5555 U127 52
3856 1-9 S87 22 4201 U02 40 4462 U05 41 5556 U127 52
3857 1-9 S87 22 4210 U98 50 4463 U05 41 5557 U127 52
3859 1-2 W132 76 4211 U98 50 4464 U05 41 6010 1-7 S38 19
3860 W132 76 4212 U98 50 4470 U04 41 6011 1-2 W85 69
3861 Z59 97 4213 U98 50 4500 U03 41 6012 1-3 W86 69
3862 1-3 W134 76 4214 U98 50 4501 U03 41 6013 1-2 W86 69
3863 Z58 97 4215 U98 50 4502 U03 41 6014 S65 21
3864 1-2 W135 76 4216 U98 50 4510 U98 50 6015 W87 69
3865 U126 52 4217 U98 50 5001 U93 49
3866 U125 52 4218 U98 50 5002 U93 49
3867 U125 52 4230 U18 44 5003 U93 49
3868 U125 52 4250 U18 44 5004 U93 49
3869 U125 52 4300 U03 41 5005 U93 49
3870 U126 52 4301 U03 41 5006 U93 49
3871 U125 52 4302 U03 41 5007 U93 49
3872 U125 52 4303 U03 41 5008 U93 49
3873 U125 52 4304 U03 41 5009 U93 49
3874 U125 52 4310 U03 41 5010 U93 49
3875 U125 52 4311 U03 41 5500 S60 21
3876 U126 52 4312 U03 41 5501 W80 68
3877 U126 52 4316 U03 41 5502 1-5 S98 31
3880 U91 49 4322 U03 41 5503 S99 38
3881 U91 49 4323 U03 41 5504 S99 38
3882 X54 89 4324 U03 41 5505 W81 69
3883 X54 89 4325 U03 41 5506 W82 69
4100 S95 24 4330 U06 42 5507 1-5 S94 24
4101 S95 24 4340 U98 50 5508 1-5 S94 24
4102 S95 24 4341 U98 50 5509 1-5 S94 24
4103 S95 24 4342 U99 50 5510 1-5 S94 24
4104 S95 24 4350 U98 50 5511 1-5 S94 24
4105 S95 24 4360 U08 42 5512 1-5 S94 24
4106 S95 24 4361 U08 42 5513 S98 31
4120 U01 40 4400 Z01 94 5514 1-5 S98 31
4121 U01 40 4410 X25 86 5516 W115 73
4130 U07 42 4411 X25 86 5518 S98 31
4131 U07 42 4412 X25 86 5520 1-5 S98 31
4132 U07 42 4413 X25 86 5521 1-5 S98 31
4133 U10 43 4414 X25 87 5522 1-5 S98 31
4134 U07 42 4415 X25 87 5530 S98 31
4140 U98 50 4416 X25 87 5531 S98 31
4141 U98 50 4420 U04 41 5532 S98 31
4142 U98 50 4430 U04 41 5533 S98 31
X??-????
㪝㪏
㪝㪎 㪝㪈㪈
㪝㪐 㪝㪈㪇
㪝㪊
㪝㪈 㪝㪉
㪝㪈㪉
㪝㪋
㪝㪈㪋
㪝㪌
㪝㪈㪊
㪝㪍
C1
C2
Button in
Group Point Requirement to Clear Jam
Display
[M] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
OST-1 C1 M
been closed)
[M], [Q] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers
OST-2 C2 M/Q
has been closed)
P3
P1
P2
Printer Unit
High Capacity Feeder
Button in
Group Point Requirement to Clear Jam
Display
[N] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
HCF-1 P1 N
been closed)
[R] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
HCF-2 P2 R
been closed)
[R] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
HCF-3 P3 R
been closed)
A7 A8
A4
A6
A5 A3
A1
A2
Button in
Group Point Requirement to Clear Jam
Display
[A1] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
HCS-1 A1 A1
been closed)
[A2] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
HCS-2 A2 A2
been closed)
[A3] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
HCS-3 A3 A3
been closed)
[A4] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
HCS-4 A4 A4
been closed)
[A5] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
HCS-5 A5 A5
been closed)
[A6] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
HCS-6 A6 A6
been closed)
[A7] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
been closed)
HCS-7 A7 A7
If the distance to the lower limit position is less than 100mm, will be lowered to the
lower limit position.
[A8] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
been closed)
HCS-8 A8 A8
If the distance to the lower limit position is less than 100mm, will be lowered to the
lower limit position.
B6 B7
B2
B8
B1
B3
B4
B5
Button in
Group Point Requirement to Clear Jam
Display
[B1] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
PB-1 B01 B1
been closed)
[B2] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
PB-2 B02 B2
been closed)
[B2] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
PB-3 B03 B2
been closed)
[B2] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
PB-4 B04 B2
been closed)
[B3] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
PB-5 B05 B3
been closed)
[B4] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
PB-6 B06 B4
been closed)
[B5] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
PB-7 B07 B5
been closed)
C10
C1
C9
C2 C8
C4 C7
C5
C3
C6
Button in
Group Point Requirement to Clear Jam
Display
[C1] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
MM-1 C1 C1
been closed)
[C2] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
MM-2 C2 C2
been closed)
[C3] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
MM-3 C4 C4
been closed)
[C4] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
MM-4 C6 C6
been closed)
[C5] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
MM-5 C7 C7
been closed)
[C6] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
MM-6 C8 C8
been closed)
[C7] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
MM-7 C9 C9
been closed)
[C8] Paper jam has been cleared + (Close button has been pressed or all covers has
MM-8 C10 C10
been closed)
Contents
1. Entering into Test Mode.................................................................. 17-3
3-1. Meaning of the Numbers for Each Test Mode Digit................. 17-5
3-2. Example Test Modes............................................................... 17-6
Confirm Confirm
Input the pass code Input the pass code
****
Cancel OK Cancel OK
As you enter the 4-digit pass code "3-2-1-4" using the numeric keypad, the screen changes to the one as shown
on above right. Press the OK or Start key. If the pass code is incorrect, the following screen is displayed. Enter
the correct pass code to access test mode. Once the pass code is entered correctly, the test mode standby
screen shown on the top of next page is displayed.
Confirm
The password is incorrrect.
Input again.
OK
Test mode
To finish, press the Mode key
Test mode No. 00001
Catergory
00406 LOG PRINTOUT
System
00407 REV INFO PRINTOUT
Engine
00408 MANUAL EVENT CODE SETTING
Print head 01/16
00409 PANEL CALIBRATION
Option 1
00412 ADMIN SERVER COMMUNICATION TEST
Option 2
00413 TRANSMIT LOG SAVE
Scanner
Sensor Drive Unit Initialize Data Mon Data Edit
All S M U I C D
To exit test mode, press the Mode key on the operation panel in standby mode or when operation is stopped.
The printer will then be idle in regular mode.
01234
5th Digit 4th Digit 3rd Digit 2nd Digit 1st Digit
01025
Sensor monitoring of the registration sensor (checks sensors for paper feeding and transfer system of the print
engine system)
02305
Drive checking of ink cooling fans (confirms operation of actuators in the ink path of the print engine system)
03400
Unit checking of the auto-control stacking tray (AS) side paper guide (conducts coordinated operation of optional
paper supply and ejection units)
04952
Stapler data editing (selection or adjustment of data when a stapler is installed in the finisher system)
Test mode
To finish, press the Mode key
Test mode No. 00001
Catergory
00406 LOG PRINTOUT
System
00407 REV INFO PRINTOUT
Engine
00408 MANUAL EVENT CODE SETTING
Print head 01/16
00409 PANEL CALIBRATION
Option 1
00412 ADMIN SERVER COMMUNICATION TEST
Option 2
00413 TRANSMIT LOG SAVE
Scanner
Sensor Drive Unit Initialize Data Mon Data Edit
All S M U I C D
To return to the test mode standby screen, press the Stop key on the operation panel.
To return to the test mode standby screen, press the Stop key on the operation panel.
U 01423 PFT UPPER LIMIT POS Close U 01423 PFT UPPER LIMIT POS Close
Processing is executed
In Pause END following details in the
Confirmation Items
column for unit checking
test modes.
Also note information on
stopping operation.
To return to the test mode standby screen, press the Stop key on the operation panel.
I 05501 SCANNER JAM CLEAR Close I 05501 SCANNER JAM CLEAR Close I 05501 SCANNER JAM CLEAR Close
Processing is executed following details in the Confirmation Items column for initialization test modes.
To return to the test mode standby screen, press the Stop key on the operation panel.
EngControl 0.0.0.0
Details in the Confirmation Items
column for data monitoring test
modes are displayed.
To return to the test mode standby screen, press the Stop key on the operation panel.
Changing Values
Enter values in the supported range directly, either by pressing the up or down arrow to increase or
decrease the value or by entering the value with the numeric keypad.
Confirming Settings
To confirm the settings, press the OK button on the screen. To cancel any revisions, press Cancel.
Information on Bottom
min: Indicates the minimum value in the supported range for changes
max: Indicates the maximum value in the supported range for changes.
def: Indicates the factory-set default value.
step: Indicates the increment for changes. (For example, 2 indicates that the value is increased or
decreased by 2.)
Notes
The units and meaning of values (and in particular, selection options) are not defined on the screen. Refer
to the technical manual for details.
Numerical input (Numerical keys available) Numerical input (Numerical keys available)
0 0 according to data editing
test mode details (range
(min/max) and options).
min: -100 max: +100 def: 0 step: 1 min: 0 max: 1 def: 0 step: 1
To return to the test mode standby screen, press the Stop key on the operation panel.
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
687 28 CC C CLEANING CNT EXTR -P 790 37 CC D ENVELOPE DISPLAY SET
688 28 CC C CLEANING CNT STRG -P 791 37 CC D P-FEED CONTROL DIS
689 28 CC C CLEANING CNT NRML -P 792 37 CC D INK DROP CONTROL DIS
690 28 CC C TOTAL CNT DISPLAY -P 793 37 CC D MM SAMPL PRT BTN DIS
691 28 CC C HDD RECOVERY HISTORY 1000 10 CC S PFT U-LIMIT SENSOR A
692 29 CC C ENVELOPE FNSHR COUNT PMS 1001 10 CC S PFT U-LIMIT SENSOR B
695 29 CC C COIN VENDOR FIRM VER 1002 10 CC S P-F-T L-LIMIT SENSOR
696 29 CC C CARD VENDOR FIRM VER 1003 10 CC S TRAY1 U-LIMIT SENSOR
707 33 CC D LOG OUTPUT LEVEL SET 1004 10 CC S TRAY2 U-LIMIT SENSOR
708 33 CC D GMT TIME ZONE SELECT 1005 10 CC S TRAY3 U-LIMIT SENSOR
709 33 CC D AUTO SHUTOFF DISP 1006 10 CC S P-F-T P-DET. SENSOR
710 33 CC D SNMP COM SET (NRM) 1007 10 CC S TRAY1 P-DET. SENSOR
711 33 CC D SNMP COM SET (PRVT) 1008 10 CC S TRAY2 P-DET. SENSOR
712 33 CC D USB DET WAITING TIME 1009 10 CC S TRAY3 P-DET. SENSOR
715 33 CC D CSV FILE ENCODE SET 1010 10 CC S PFT P-LENGTH SENSOR
716 33 CC D IC CARD KY CODE1 SET 1011 10 CC S TRAY1 P-SIZE SENSOR1
717 33 CC D IC CARD KY CODE2 SET 1012 10 CC S TRAY1 P-SIZE SENSOR2
718 33 CC D IC CARD KY CODE3 SET 1013 10 CC S TRAY1 P-SIZE SENSOR3
719 33 CC D MM ENCLOSED NUM MAX 1014 10 CC S TRAY1 P-SIZE SENSOR4
720 33 CC D CLEANG CYCLE MIN QTY 1015 10 CC S TRAY2 P-SIZE SENSOR1
721 33 CC D REV FUCNTION ON/OFF 1016 10 CC S TRAY2 P-SIZE SENSOR2
722 34 CC D REV EVENT EXTNSN SET 1017 10 CC S TRAY2 P-SIZE SENSOR3
723 34 CC D MANL EVNT CODE1 SET 1018 10 CC S TRAY2 P-SIZE SENSOR4
724 34 CC D MANL EVENT CODE2 SET 1019 10 CC S TRAY3 P-SIZE SENSOR1
725 34 CC D MANL EVENT CODE3 SET 1020 10 CC S TRAY3 P-SIZE SENSOR2
726 34 CC D USB PORT ENABLE 1021 10 CC S TRAY3 P-SIZE SENSOR3
727 34 CC D EXTERIOR CNTRLR SELC 1022 10 CC S TRAY3 P-SIZE SENSOR4
728 34 CC D SCANNER CONNCTN SELC 1023 10 CC S 1ST P-F-MTR ENCODER
729 34 CC D SUPLY STCK DSPLY SET 1024 10 CC S REGIST MTR ENCODER
730 34 CC D MONOCLR LIMIT SELECT 1025 10 CC S REGISTRATION SENSOR
731 34 CC D MAIL HEADER ENCODE 1027 10 CC S VERT. P-F SENSOR1
732 35 CC D MAIL FILE ENCODE 1028 10 CC S VERT. P-F SENSOR2
733 35 CC D LW PAPER SET 1029 10 CC S VERT. P-F SENSOR3
734 35 CC D COUNT CNTL:CARTADIS 1030 10 CC S VERT. P-F SENSOR4
735 35 CC D HostResourcesMIB SET 1031 10 CC S VERT. P-F SENSOR5
740 35 CC D REMOT CNTRL FUNC SET 1035 10 CC S P-F-T ELEVATION SW
741 35 CC D COUNT INFORMATION 1036 10 CC S PFT P-VOL DET SNSR 1
742 35 CC D CNT INFO TRANS SET-H 1037 10 CC S PFT P-VOL DET SNSR 2
743 35 CC D CNT INFO TRANS SET-M 1038 10 CC S TRAY1 P-VOLUM SENSOR
744 35 CC D INK VOLUME INFO 1039 10 CC S TRAY2 P-VOLUM SENSOR
745 36 CC D ERROR HISTORY INFO 1040 10 CC S TRAY3 P-VOLUM SENSOR
747 36 CC D COM TIMEOUT (MIN) 1100 10 CC S TRANS BELT ENCODER
748 36 CC D TRANSMIT COMMENT 1102 10 CC S TOP EDGE SENSOR 1
750 36 CC D P-FEED (U1) DISPLAY 1104 10 CC S P-LIFT DETCTN SENSOR
751 36 CC D P-FEED (U2) DISPLAY 1105 10 CC S P-ELEVATION IN SENSR
752 36 CC D P-FEED (U3) DISPLAY 1106 10 CC S FLIPPER SENSOR
753 36 CC D P-FEED (U4) DISPLAY 1107 10 CC S U-TRANSFR OUT SENSOR
754 36 CC D P-FEED (U5) DISPLAY 1108 10 CC S SWITCHBACK SENSOR
756 36 CC D COUNT CHARGE SETTING 1109 10 CC S RE-FEED SENSOR
760 36 CC D SECRTY PAC KEYCODE1 1110 10 CC S BELT HP SENSOR
761 37 CC D SECRTY PAC KEYCODE2 1150 11 CC S FD EJECT MTR ENCODER
762 37 CC D SECRTY PAC KEYCODE3 1151 11 CC S FD EJECT FULL SENSOR
770 37 CC D No name on display 1152 11 CC S FD EJEC P-DET SENSOR
780 37 CC D TECH ACCS BUTN DSPLY 1153 11 CC S FD EJEC FENCE HP SNR
782 37 CC D NETWORK LINK MODE 1154 11 CC S FD EJECTION SENSOR
783 37 CC D Disable FTP port 1155 11 CC S FU EJECTION SENSOR
785 37 CC D No number on display 1156 11 CC S FU EJE WING HP SNSR
786 37 CC D No number on display 1159 11 CC S FD EJE FLIPPER DET
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
1161 11 CC S SW-BACK CLUTCH DET 1463 20 CC U FU EJEC FENCE CUSTOM
1163 11 CC S FU EJEC JMP MTR ECDR 1464 20 CC U FD EJEC FENCE 1 CYCL
1180 11 CC S FRONT L INTER-LCK SW 1465 21 CC U FU EJEC FENCE 1 CYCL
1181 11 CC S FRONT R INTER-LCK SW 1478 21 CC U R-PROFILE PHASE PRNT
1182 11 CC S BP WIRE LOOSE DET 1479 21 CC U R-PROFILE AMP PRINT
1185 11 CC S TRAY1 SET SAFETY SW 1481 21 CC U HEAD TEST PATN PRINT
1186 11 CC S TRAY2 SET SAFETY SW 1482 21 CC U INITIALIZE MOVEMENT
1187 11 CC S TRAY3 SET SAFETY SW 1485 21 CC U No number on display
1189 11 CC S OPT PCB DET SIGNAL 1486 21 CC U No number on display
1190 11 CC S SWITCHBACK INTLCK SW 1494 21 CC U SENSOR AUTO ADJ 1
1191 11 CC S JAM RELEASE DOOR SW 1495 21 CC U SENSOR AUTO ADJ 2
1192 11 CC S VENDOR DETECT SIGNAL 1497 21 CC U ADJ PARAMETER SAVE
1194 11 CC S AUTO RCV TRAY SIGNAL 1498 21 CC U SNSR AUTO ADJ 1 FEED
1195 11 CC S MULTI FINSHER SIGNAL 1502 26 CC I TESTMODE CLR (ENGN)
1196 11 CC S FU EJECTION U SIGNAL 1530 26 CC I ERROR CLEAR (ENGINE)
1225 14 CC M EXTL P-FEED MOTOR-S 1532 26 CC I RECOVERY DATA CLEAR
1226 14 CC M REGISTRATION MOTOR 1533 26 CC I B-ARM FIX-P ERR CLR
1227 14 CC M INTL P-FEED MOTOR 1534 26 CC I INK DETECT ERR CLR
1228 14 CC M EXTL P-FEED MOTOR-V 1540 26 CC I B-STRETCH DATA CLEAR
1229 14 CC M INTL P-FEED CLUTCH 1 1604 29 CC C LEFT CIS STD PAPER
1230 14 CC M INTL P-FEED CLUTCH 2 1605 29 CC C RIGHT CIS STD PAPER
1231 14 CC M INTL P-FEED CLUTCH 3 1606 29 CC C LEFT CIS EDGE DETEC
1232 14 CC M VERT P-FEED CLUTCH 1 1607 29 CC C RIGHT CIS EDGE DETEC
1233 14 CC M VERT P-FEED CLUTCH 2 1608 29 CC C CIS PAPER WIDTH DET
1250 14 CC M TRANS BELT FAN 1&2 1609 29 CC C LEFT CIS PAPER LEVEL
1251 14 CC M TRANS BELT FAN 3&4 1610 29 CC C RIGHT CIS PAPER LEVL
1252 14 CC M TRANS BELT FAN 5&6 1611 29 CC C LEFT CIS BELT LEVEL
1253 14 CC M TRANS BELT FAN ALL 1612 29 CC C RIGHT CIS BELT LEVEL
1256 14 CC M TRANSFER BELT MOTOR 1613 29 CC C L-CIS THRESHOLD
1257 14 CC M PAPER ELEVATION MTR 1614 29 CC C R-CIS THRESHOLD
1258 14 CC M TOP TRANSFER MOTOR 1615 29 CC C L-CIS OFST V - SHDNG
1259 14 CC M FU EJECT FLIPPER SOL 1616 29 CC C L-CIS OFST V - ADJST
1260 14 CC M FD EJECT FLIPPER SOL 1617 29 CC C R-CIS OFST V - SHDNG
1261 14 CC M SB MOTOR (NORMAL) 1618 29 CC C R-CIS OFST V - ADJST
1262 14 CC M SB MOTOR (REVERSE) 1620 29 CC C P-F-T P-WIDTH VOL AD
1263 14 CC M RE-FEED MOTOR 1621 29 CC C P-F-T PAPER VOLUME
1264 14 CC M SWITCHBACK CLUTCH 1622 29 CC C TRAY 1 PAPER VOLUME
1300 14 CC M FD EJECTION MOTOR 1623 29 CC C TRAY 2 PAPER VOLUME
1306 14 CC M FU EJECTION MOTOR 1624 29 CC C TRAY 3 PAPER VOLUME
1309 14 CC M FU EJECT JUMP MOTOR 1625 30 CC C P-F-T PAPER SIZE ID
1381 14 CC M PSU COOL FAN DRIVE 1626 30 CC C TRAY 1 PAPER SIZE ID
1421 20 CC U PFT WIDTH ADJ (WIDE) 1627 30 CC C TRAY 2 PAPER SIZE ID
1422 20 CC U PFT WIDTH ADJ (NRRW) 1628 30 CC C TRAY 3 PAPER SIZE ID
1423 20 CC U PFT UPPER LIMIT POS 1629 30 CC C REGIST SNSR VOLUME
1424 20 CC U PFT LOWER LIMIT POS 1630 30 CC C PFT P-WIDTH DET CHCK
1425 20 CC U TRAY 1 UPPER LMT POS 1640 30 CC C TOP EDGE SNSR 1 EMIT
1426 20 CC U TRAY 2 UPPER LMT POS 1641 30 CC C TOP EDGE SNSR 2 EMIT
1427 20 CC U TRAY 3 UPPER LMT POS 1642 30 CC C TOP EDGE SNSR 2 PEAK
1442 20 CC U BELT PROFILE DATA 1643 30 CC C TRANSFER BELT SPEED
1443 20 CC U ROLLER PROFILE DATA 1650 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 1 (EGN)
1444 20 CC U JAM RECONFIRMATION 1651 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 2 (EGN)
1445 20 CC U JAM CONDITION RENEW 1652 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 3 (EGN)
1447 20 CC U BELT MAINT CNT RESET 1653 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 4 (EGN)
1450 20 CC U BP MOTOR SPD AT ADJ 1654 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 5 (EGN)
1451 20 CC U P-ELV MTR1 SPD AT AJ 1655 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 6 (EGN)
1460 20 CC U FD EJEC FENCE HP MOV 1656 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 7 (EGN)
1461 20 CC U FD EJEC FENCE CUSTOM 1657 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 8 (EGN)
1462 20 CC U FU EJEC FENCE HP MOV 1658 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 9 (EGN)
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
1659 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 10 (EGN) 1767 38 CC D TRAY-1 L ASSIST SPD
1660 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 11 (EGN) 1769 38 CC D TRAY-1 S ASSIST SPD
1661 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 12 (EGN) 1771 38 CC D TRAY-2 L ASSIST SPD
1662 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 13 (EGN) 1773 38 CC D TRAY-2 S ASSIST SPD
1663 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 14 (EGN) 1774 38 CC D TRAY-3 L ASSIST SPD
1664 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 15 (EGN) 1775 38 CC D TRAY-3 S ASSIST SPD
1665 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 16 (EGN) 1776 39 CC D REGIST SENSOR SET
1666 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 17 (EGN) 1780 39 CC D TRAY DESCEND DURATN
1667 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 18 (EGN) 1781 39 CC D TRAY SHIFT TIME SET
1668 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 19 (EGN) 1785 39 CC D PFT DOWN MOV TIM SET
1669 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 20 (EGN) 1786 39 CC D TRANS BLT M SPD ADJ
1670 30 CC C COUNT DSPLY 21 (EGN) 1787 39 CC D P-ELEV. MTR SPD ADJ
1671 30 CC C MAINT CNT PFT (EGN) 1788 39 CC D TOP TRAN MTR SPD ADJ
1672 30 CC C MAINTENANCE CNT HCF (EGN) 1789 39 CC D SWBACK WAIT TIME SET
1673 30 CC C MAINT CNT TRAY 1 - E 1800 39 CC D SWBK ROLL ROTATN SET
1674 30 CC C MAINT CNT TRAY 2 - E 1802 39 CC D REG MOTOR SPEED ADJ
1675 30 CC C MAINT CNT TRAY 3 - E 1803 39 CC D REG MTR STOP POS ADJ
1676 30 CC C MAINT CNT SWBACK - E 1804 39 CC D RE-FEED TIMING SET
1677 31 CC C MAINT CNT FD EJECT-E 1807 39 CC D TOP EDGE SNSR 1 SET
1678 31 CC C MAINT CNT FU EJECT-E 1808 39 CC D TOP EDGE SNSR 2 SET
1679 31 CC C FNSHR CNT DSPLY 1 -E 1809 39 CC D TRANSFR BELT FAN SET
1680 31 CC C FNSHR CNT DSPLY 2 -E 1810 39 CC D T-EDG SR 1 PNA J SET
1681 31 CC C FNSHR CNT DSPLY 3 -E 1811 39 CC D P-ELV IN S PNA J SET
1682 31 CC C FNSHR CNT DSPLY 4 -E 1812 39 CC D FLIPPER S PNA J SET
1683 31 CC C FNSHR CNT DSPLY 5 -E 1813 39 CC D T-TRAN O SNR PNA JAM
1684 31 CC C FNSHR CNT DSPLY 6 -E 1814 39 CC D SWBACK SNSR PNA JAM
1685 31 CC C FNSHR CNT DSPLY 7 -E 1815 40 CC D RE-FEED SNR PNA JAM
1686 31 CC C FNSHR CNT DSPLY 8 -E 1816 40 CC D BELT HP SNR ON/OFF
1687 31 CC C CLEANING CNT EXTR -E 1817 40 CC D BP FAN SPCL SETNG SW
1688 31 CC C CLEANING CNT STRG -E 1818 40 CC D BP FAN SPECIAL DUTY
1689 31 CC C CLEANING CNT NRML -E 1819 40 CC D BP FAN CENTER ON/OFF
1690 31 CC C TOTAL CNT DISPLAY -E 1820 40 CC D TOP EDG SENSOR 1 JAM
1691 31 CC C MAINTENANCE CNT1 PB (EGN) 1821 40 CC D P-ELEV. IN SNR JAM
1692 31 CC C MAINTENANCE CNT2 PB (EGN) 1822 40 CC D FLIPPER SENSOR JAM
1693 31 CC C MAINTENANCE CNT3 PB (EGN) 1823 40 CC D T-TRAN O SENSOR JAM
1694 31 CC C ENVELOPE FNSHR COUNT ENG 1824 40 CC D SWBACK SENSOR JAM
1695 31 CC C TESTMD CNFG PRT2 DSP 1825 40 CC D RE-FEED SENSOR JAM
1696 31 CC C OPTION-PCB FIRMWARE VER 1828 40 CC D T-EDG S 1 PRT ST TMG
1743 38 CC D REG SNR PNA JAM SET 1829 40 CC D T-EDG S 2 PRT ST TMG
1744 38 CC D REG SNSR P JAM SET 1831 40 CC D MULT FD DET TMG SET
1745 38 CC D RE-FEED ASSIST START 1832 40 CC D RCVRY CTL SET(MC)
1746 38 CC D RE-FD ASSIST SPD ADJ 1833 40 CC D RCVRY CTL SET(IN-PF)
1747 38 CC D RE-FD ASSIST STP DIS 1834 40 CC D POST RGST SNR P FEED
1748 38 CC D RE-FEED L SPEED DIST 1837 40 CC D FD RCV TRAY MAX SET
1749 38 CC D RE-FD L-SPD SPD ADJ 1838 41 CC D FU E-JMP MTR SPD COM
1753 38 CC D V-P-FEED CL 1 ON TMG 1839 41 CC D FU EJECTION MTR SET
1754 38 CC D V-P-FEED CL 2 ON TMG 1840 41 CC D FD EJ MTR SPD (SPLX)
1755 38 CC D V-P-FEED START TMG 1841 41 CC D FD EJ MTR SPD (DPLX)
1757 38 CC D VPF SNR1 PNA JAM SET 1842 41 CC D FU EJEC FLPR ON TMG
1758 38 CC D VPF SNR2 PNA JAM SET 1843 41 CC D FU EJEC FLPR OFF TMG
1759 38 CC D VPF SNR3 PNA JAM SET 1844 41 CC D FD EJEC FLPR ON TMG
1760 38 CC D VPF SNR4 PNA JAM SET 1845 41 CC D FD EJEC FLPR OFF TMG
1761 38 CC D VPF SNR5 PNA JAM SET 1846 41 CC D FU EJEC SNSR PNA JAM
1762 38 CC D VPF SNSR 1 P-JAM SET 1847 41 CC D FU EJEC SENSOR JAM
1763 38 CC D VPF SNSR 2 P-JAM SET 1848 41 CC D FD EJEC SNSR PNA JAM
1764 38 CC D VPF SNSR 3 P-JAM SET 1849 41 CC D FD EJEC SENSOR JAM
1765 38 CC D VPF SNSR 4 P-JAM SET 1850 41 CC D FD EJEC MTR OP SELEC
1766 38 CC D VPF SNSR 5 P-JAM SET 1851 41 CC D FD EJEC FENCE POSTN
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
1852 41 CC D FU EJEC W SPFC POSTN 2112 11 CC S NP-TANK INK SENSOR C
1853 41 CC D FD EJECT FULL ON/OFF 2113 11 CC S NP-TANK INK SENSOR M
1855 41 CC D FD EJECT SPEED SET 2114 11 CC S NP-TANK INK SENSOR Y
1856 41 CC D FU EJEC W CSTM POSTN 2115 11 CC S OVERFLOW SENSOR
1858 41 CC D FU EJC MTR SPEED SET 2116 11 CC S W-TNK NEAR FULL SNSR
1859 41 CC D FU E-JMP MTR SPD SET 2117 11 CC S W-TNK FULL SENSOR
1860 41 CC D PRINT QTY SELECTION 2118 11 CC S PAN MOTOR STORE SNSR
1861 41 CC D OUTPUT DESTINATION 2119 11 CC S PAN MOTOR OP POS SNR
1862 41 CC D DUPLEX/SIMPLEX SELEC 2123 12 CC S BP L-POSITION SENSOR
1865 42 CC D PAPER FEED SPEED SET 2124 12 CC S BP U-POSITION SENSOR
1867 42 CC D P-FEED TRAY SELECTN 2126 12 CC S WIPER MOTOR HP SNSR
1870 42 CC D MAINT PWR OFF SELEC 2127 12 CC S 24V A-VOLTAGE DET
1871 42 CC D P-HEAD TEST PAT SELC 2128 12 CC S 24V B-VOLTAGE DET
1878 42 CC D LOW TEMP MAX PRN QTY 2129 12 CC S 24V C-VOLTAGE DET
1879 42 CC D SLT P-FD SLOW TIMING 2131 12 CC S 30-VOLT DETECTION
1880 42 CC D SLT P-FD STOP TIMING 2132 12 CC S COUNTER DETECTION
1881 42 CC D SLT P-FD HIT SPD ADJ 2138 12 CC S INK SPLY VALVE DET K
1884 42 CC D PFT ASSIST TIME ADJ 2139 12 CC S INK SPLY VALVE DET C
1888 42 CC D BELT PROFILE ON/OFF 2140 12 CC S INK SPLY VALVE DET M
1889 42 CC D BLT PROFILE GAIN ADJ 2141 12 CC S INK SPLY VALVE DET Y
1890 42 CC D VENDOR CONNECTION 2142 12 CC S P-TANK AIR VALVE DET
1893 43 CC D ROLL PROFILE ON/OFF 2143 12 CC S NP-TNK AIR VALVE DET
1894 43 CC D ROLL PRFILE GAIN ADJ 2145 12 CC S P-TANK HEATER DET
1895 43 CC D P-EJCT OPTION SET 2146 12 CC S HEAT EXCHANGER DET
1896 43 CC D INK SUPPLY ON/OFF 2151 12 CC S OVRFLW TANK INK DET
1900 43 CC D MAINTENANCE CALL SET 2152 12 CC S NP-TANK SENSOR DET K
1901 43 CC D INTL TRAY CUSTM SET 2153 12 CC S NP-TANK SENSOR DET C
1910 43 CC D B-PRFL DATA INPUT 1 2154 12 CC S NP-TANK SENSOR DET M
1911 43 CC D B-PRFL DATA INPUT 2 2155 12 CC S NP-TANK SENSOR DET Y
1912 43 CC D B-PRFL DATA INPUT 3 2159 12 CC S OR2 IP PCB DETECTION
1913 43 CC D B-PRFL DATA INPUT 4 2160 12 CC S P-TANK SENSOR DET K
1914 43 CC D B-PRFL DATA INPUT 5 2161 12 CC S P-TANK SENSOR DET C
1915 43 CC D B-PRFL DATA INPUT 6 2162 12 CC S P-TANK SENSOR DET M
1916 43 CC D B-PRFL DATA INPUT 7 2163 12 CC S P-TANK SENSOR DET Y
1917 43 CC D B-PRFL DATA INPUT 8 2165 12 CC S INK CARTRIDGE DET K
1918 43 CC D B-PRFL DATA INPUT 9 2166 12 CC S INK CARTRIDGE DET C
1919 43 CC D B-PRFL DATA INPUT 10 2167 12 CC S INK CARTRIDGE DET M
1920 43 CC D B-PRFL DATA INPUT 11 2168 12 CC S INK CARTRIDGE DET Y
1921 43 CC D B-PRFL DATA INPUT 12 2169 12 CC S AUTHORIZE CAM HP SNR
1922 43 CC D B-PRFL CHCK DGT INPT 2170 12 CC S BP HIT DET (RL)
1923 43 CC D R-PROFILE AMP INPUT 2171 12 CC S BP HIT DET (RR)
1924 43 CC D R-PROFILE PHASE INPT 2172 12 CC S BP HIT DET (FL)
1932 43 CC D CIS P-EDGE POSTN STD 2173 12 CC S BP HIT DET (FR)
1933 43 CC D CIS P-EDGE POS EXCL 2174 12 CC S PUMP ERROR DET K
1934 43 CC D BELT STAIN DET FLEQ 2175 12 CC S PUMP ERROR DET C
1945 44 CC D FD EJEC FENCE HP ADJ 2176 12 CC S PUMP ERROR DET M
1946 44 CC D FD EJEC FENCE (CARD) 2177 12 CC S PUMP ERROR DET Y
1947 44 CC D IMG MASK(RIGHT) 2305 14 CC M INK COOL FAN DRIVE
1948 44 CC D IMG MASK(LEFT) 2327 14 CC M HEAD DR IC COOL FAN1
2101 11 CC S BELLOWS SENSOR 2328 14 CC M HEAD DR IC COOL FAN2
2103 11 CC S BELLOWS ARM HP SNSR 2400 21 CC U BELLOWS ARM MOTOR UP
2104 11 CC S BELLOWS ARM U-P SNSR 2401 21 CC U BELLOWS ARM MOTOR HP
2106 11 CC S BELLOWS ARM LW-P SNSR 2402 21 CC U BELLOWS ARM FIX-POS
2107 11 CC S P-TANK INK SENSOR K 2404 21 CC U BELLOWS ARM MTR DWN
2108 11 CC S P-TANK INK SENSOR C 2405 21 CC U BP ELEV MOTOR UP
2109 11 CC S P-TANK INK SENSOR M 2406 21 CC U BP ELEV MOTOR MAINT
2110 11 CC S P-TANK INK SENSOR Y 2407 21 CC U BP ELEV MOTOR DOWN
2111 11 CC S NP-TANK INK SENSOR K 2409 21 CC U BP ELEV MOTOR PUSHUP
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
2411 22 CC U WIPE MOTOR TO FRONT 2730 44 CC D RCVRY CLEANG 1 TIME
2412 22 CC U WIPE MOTOR TO REAR 2731 44 CC D RCVRY CLEANG 2 TIME
2418 22 CC U NORMAL CLEANING 2732 44 CC D RCVRY CLEANG 3 TIME
2419 22 CC U STRONG CLEANING 2733 44 CC D RCVRY CLNG 1 ON/OFF
2420 22 CC U EXTRA CLEANING 2734 44 CC D RCVRY CLNG 2 ON/OFF
2427 22 CC U INK INITIAL FILLING 2735 44 CC D RCVRY CLNG 3 ON/OFF
2428 22 CC U NZL PRESSURE - PRINT 2736 44 CC D RCVRY CLEANG TIMING
2431 22 CC U NZL LOW NGTV PRESSUR 2737 44 CC D BP FIX-POS. PWR OFF
2436 22 CC U WIPING ACTION 2738 44 CC D B-ARM FIX-POS SET
2437 22 CC U INK PAN PAUSE POSTN 2748 44 CC D MD RECOV. PRINT QTY
2438 22 CC U INK PAN STORAGE POS 2749 44 CC D MD RECOV. ACTION QTY
2439 22 CC U INK PAN ON-BELT POS 2759 45 CC D INK CIRC DURATION
2440 22 CC U HEAD GAP ADJ (NORM) 2839 45 CC D MD RECOVERY QUANTITY
2441 22 CC U HEAD GAP ADJ (THICK) 2840 45 CC D RCVRY CLEAN'G MD QTY
2442 22 CC U HEAD GAP ADJ (ENVLP POS1) 2877 45 CC D INTL INK SUPPLY MTHD
2443 22 CC U HEAD GAP ADJ (ENVLP POS2) 2898 45 CC D P-TANK CHECK OP MODE
2451 22 CC U AUTHORIZE CAM MTR HP 2906 45 CC D IMG CTR S-MASK OFF
2452 22 CC U INK CIRC ACTION 2907 45 CC D IMAGE TOP EDGE ADJ
2461 22 CC U L&R CIS SHADING 2908 45 CC D T-EDGE DIFFERNCL ADJ
2462 22 CC U LEFT CIS SHADING 2922 45 CC D CIS SIDE MASK ADJ-L
2463 22 CC U RIGHT CIS SHADING 2923 45 CC D CIS SIDE MASK ADJ-R
2464 22 CC U CIS OPERATION CHECK 2924 45 CC D CIS IMAGE CTR POSITN
2471 23 CC U K-MD RECOVERY ACTION 2925 45 CC D ENV IMG MASK (TOP)
2472 23 CC U C-MD RECOVERY ACTION 2926 45 CC D ENV IMG MASK (BTTM)
2473 23 CC U M-MD RECOVERY ACTION 2927 45 CC D ENV IMG MASK (RIGHT)
2474 23 CC U Y-MD RECOVERY ACTION 2928 45 CC D ENV IMG MASK (LEFT)
2476 23 CC U K-MD RECOVERY 2931 45 CC D CONNECT PROCESS SET
2477 23 CC U C-MD RECOVERY 2932 45 CC D FIXED PRINT POS SET
2478 23 CC U M-MD RECOVERY 2934 45 CC D H-EDGE DNSTY ON/OFF
2479 23 CC U Y-MD RECOVERY 2938 45 CC D BELT STAIN THRESHOLD
2480 23 CC U PRESSURE TNK AIR OPN 2939 45 CC D CIS STD PAPERSET TDG
2481 23 CC U N-PRESS TANK AIR OPN 2940 46 CC D PRINT TIMING ADJ (K)
2482 23 CC U K-SUPPLY VALVE OPEN 2941 46 CC D PRINT TIMING ADJ (C)
2483 23 CC U C-SUPPLY VALVE OPEN 2942 46 CC D PRINT TIMING ADJ (M)
2484 23 CC U M-SUPPLY VALVE OPEN 2943 46 CC D PRINT TIMING ADJ (Y)
2485 23 CC U Y-SUPPLY VALVE OPEN 2944 46 CC D PRNT POSITION PARA K
2486 23 CC U K-PUMP MOTOR ACTION 2945 46 CC D PRNT POSITION PARA C
2487 23 CC U C-PUMP MOTOR ACTION 2946 46 CC D PRNT POSITION PARA M
2488 23 CC U M-PUMP MOTOR ACTION 2947 46 CC D PRNT POSITION PARA Y
2489 23 CC U Y-PUMP MOTOR ACTION 2948 46 CC D OVERLAP WDTH PARA K
2490 23 CC U INK HEATER 24V ACTN 2949 46 CC D OVERLAP WDTH PARA C
2491 23 CC U INK HEATER 30V ACTN 2950 46 CC D OVERLAP WDTH PARA M
2604 31 CC C HEAD AREA TEMP K/C 2951 46 CC D OVERLAP WDTH PARA Y
2605 31 CC C HEAD AREA TEMP M/Y 2952 46 CC D HEAD VOLTAGE PARA K
2606 31 CC C HEAD TEMPERATURE 2953 46 CC D HEAD VOLTAGE PARA C
2607 31 CC C HEAD VOLTAGE 2954 46 CC D HEAD VOLTAGE PARA M
2640 31 CC C B-ENCODER CNT INITL 2955 46 CC D HEAD VOLTAGE PARA Y
2641 31 CC C B-ENCODER CNT ACQU 2956 46 CC D HEAD COR VOLT PARA K
2642 31 CC C B-ENCODER CNT ACQU A 2957 46 CC D HEAD COR VOLT PARA C
2643 31 CC C B-ENCODER CNT ACQU B 2958 46 CC D HEAD COR VOLT PARA M
2644 31 CC C B-ENCODER CNT ACQU C 2959 46 CC D HEAD COR VOLT PARA Y
2646 31 CC C B-MAINT CNT DISPLAY 2960 46 CC D HEAD AL NUMBR PARA K
2673 31 CC C MD RECOV. CNT DSPLY 2961 46 CC D HEAD AL NUMBR PARA C
2701 44 CC D BP PWR OFF POSITION 2962 46 CC D HEAD AL NUMBR PARA M
2710 44 CC D INK TEMP ADJ ON/OFF 2963 46 CC D HEAD AL NUMBR PARA Y
2711 44 CC D HEAD REPLACEMNT MODE 2964 46 CC D OVERLAP CRRCTN AMT
2712 44 CC D HEAD ADJ PRINT MODE 2965 46 CC D OVERLAP CRRCTN AMT K
2713 44 CC D DROP TMG B-STRETCH 2966 46 CC D OVERLAP CRRCTN AMT C
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
2967 46 CC D OVERLAP CRRCTN AMT M 3059 98 OST S OST STP DET. SENSOR
2968 46 CC D OVERLAP CRRCTN AMT Y 3060 98 OST S OST STP SELF CHECK SENSOR
2969 46 CC D CORRECTION DOT GAIN 3061 98 OST S OST STP CHANGE COVER SW
2970 46 CC D CORRECTN DOT GAIN K 3062 98 OST S OST JAM COVER SW
2971 46 CC D CORRECTN DOT GAIN C 3063 103 HCF S HCF P-VOL DET SEN 3
2972 46 CC D CORRECTN DOT GAIN M 3065 108 HCS S HCS ENTRANCE SENSOR
2973 46 CC D CORRECTN DOT GAIN Y 3066 108 HCS S HCS SWITCHBACK SENSOR
2974 46 CC D CORRECTION NZL RANGE 3067 108 HCS S HCS SB SENSOR
2975 46 CC D CORRECTN NZL RANGE K 3068 108 HCS S HCS MID SENSOR
2976 46 CC D CORRECTN NZL RANGE C 3069 108 HCS S HCS FU SENSOR
2977 46 CC D CORRECTN NZL RANGE M 3070 108 HCS S HCS VERTICAL FEED SENSOR
2978 46 CC D CORRECTN NZL RANGE Y 3071 108 HCS S HCS EJECTION SENSOR
2979 46 CC D HRZNTL COLOR CRRCTN 3072 108 HCS S HCS EJECTION MOTOR FG
2980 46 CC D IMG EXPANSION CORREC 3073 108 HCS S HCS TRAY P-DETECTIONSENSOR
2984 46 CC D IMG CTR S-MASK OFF 1 3074 108 HCS S HCS CARD FULL SENSOR
2985 46 CC D IMG CTR S-MASK OFF 2 3075 108 HCS S HCS P-R-T DETECTION SENSOR
2986 46 CC D IMG CTR S-MASK OFF 3 3076 108 HCS S HCS FULL DETECTION SENSOR
3000 13 CC S AS S-FENCE HP SENSOR 3077 108 HCS S HCS OFFSET FULL DETECT SEN
3001 13 CC S AS E-FENCE HP SENSOR 3079 108 HCS S HCS TRAY PAPER JAM SEN 1
3002 13 CC S AS PAPER REMOVE SW 3080 108 HCS S HCS TRAY LOWER LIMITSENSOR
3003 13 CC S AS PAPER DET. SENSOR 3081 108 HCS S HCS SIDE FENCE HP SENSOR
3008 98 OST S OST SWITCH BACK PASS SENSOR 3082 108 HCS S HCS END FENCE HP SENSOR
3009 98 OST S OST STP PRTECT LEVER HP SEN 3083 108 HCS S HCS EJECT WING HP SENSOR
3017 103 HCF S HCF PFT ELEVATION SW 3084 108 HCS S HCS OFFSET GUIDE HPSENSOR
3018 103 HCF S HCF PFT INTER LOCK SW 3085 108 HCS S HCS TRAY SET SENSOR
3019 103 HCF S HCF PFT U-LIMIT SENSOR (SD) 3086 108 HCS S HCS HAND TRUCK SET SENSOR
3020 103 HCF S HCF PFT U-LIMIT SENSOR (TK) 3087 108 HCS S HCS FRONT DOOR 1 SEFETY SW
3021 103 HCF S HCF PFT L-LIMIT SENSOR 3088 108 HCS S HCS FRONT DOOR 2 SAFETY SW
3023 103 HCF S HCF PFT P-VOL DET SEN 1 3089 108 HCS S HCS RCV UPPER LIMIT SENSOR
3024 103 HCF S HCF PFT P-VOL DET SEN2 3090 108 HCS S HCS ELEVATOR UP AND DOWNSW
3026 103 HCF S HCF PFT P-DET. SENSOR 3091 123 MM S MM GUIDE SENSOR
3027 103 HCF S HCF PFT P-LENGTH SENSOR 3092 123 MM S MM END TAMP HP SENSOR
3028 103 HCF S HCF MID EXIT SENSOR 3093 123 MM S MM SIDE TAMP HP SENSOR
3030 103 HCF S HCF JAM RELEASE DOOR SIGNAL 3094 123 MM S MM TAMP NIP HP SENSOR
3033 103 HCF S HCF PU DRIVE MOTOR FG SEN 3095 123 MM S MM BODY FOLD ENTRANCE SEN
3034 103 HCF S HCF MID FEED MOTOR FG SEN 3096 123 MM S MM TOP TAMP HP SENSOR
3035 103 HCF S HCF MID ENTRANCE SEN 3097 123 MM S MM TOP TAMP SENSOR
3037 98 OST S OST MID FEED SENSOR 1 3098 123 MM S MM TAMP EJECT SENSOR
3039 98 OST S OST ENTRANCE SENSOR 3099 123 MM S MM BODY HIT HP SENSOR 1
3040 98 OST S OST EJ-ROLLER ELEV HP SEN 3100 123 MM S MM BODY HIT HP SENSOR 2
3041 98 OST S OST TRAY U-LIMIT SENSOR 3101 123 MM S MM WRAPPING ENTRANCE SEN
3042 98 OST S OST RVE-ROLLER ELEV HP SEN 3102 123 MM S MM WRAPPING STAND-BY SEN
3043 98 OST S OST TRAY ELEV CLK SENSOR 3103 123 MM S MM FORM RECEIVE SENSOR
3044 98 OST S OST TRAY P-DET. SENSOR 1 3104 123 MM S MM FORM REGIST SENSOR
3045 98 OST S OST TRAY P-DET. SENSOR 2 3105 123 MM S MM FORM HORIZONTAL HP SEN
3046 98 OST S OST TRAY P-DET. SENSOR 3 3106 123 MM S MM FORM EDGE DET SENSOR
3047 98 OST S OST TRAY L-LIMIT SENSOR 3107 123 MM S MM FORM HIT HP SENSOR 2
3048 98 OST S OST FOLDER TRAY PAPER SEN 3108 123 MM S MM WRAPPING SENSOR
3049 98 OST S OST RAKE ROLLER ELEV HP SEN 3109 123 MM S MM FORM HIT HP SENSOR 3
3050 98 OST S OST R-GUIDE PLATE HP SENSOR 3110 123 MM S MM GLUING SENSOR
3051 98 OST S OST TRAY SIFT SENSOR 1 3111 123 MM S MM GLUING HP SENSOR
3052 98 OST S OST TRAY P-DET. SENSOR 3112 123 MM S MM FLAP GLUING EJECT SEN
3053 98 OST S OST TRAY SIFT CLK SENSOR 3113 123 MM S MM COMP EJECT SENSOR
3054 98 OST S OST TRAY SIFT SENSOR 2 3114 123 MM S MM EJECT SENSOR
3055 98 OST S OST F-GUIDE PLATE HP SENSOR 3115 123 MM S MM EJCT TRY FULL DET SEN R
3056 98 OST S OST GUIDE PLATE POS SENSOR 3116 123 MM S MM MID EXIT SENSOR
3057 98 OST S OST STP SLID HP SENSOR 3118 123 MM S MM BODY FOLD SET HP SEN
3058 98 OST S OST STP CLINCH HP SENSOR 3119 123 MM S MM WATER LEVEL DET SEN
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
3123 123 MM S MM EJECT ELVE EDGE SENSOR 3313 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(U-S-DW)
3124 123 MM S MM EJECT FENCE POS SEN 3314 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A3-S-UP)
3127 123 MM S MM EJCT TRY FULL DET SEN F 3315 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B4-S-UP)
3139 123 MM S MM FORM NIP HP SENSOR 3316 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A4-S-UP)
3140 123 MM S MM FLAP ENTRANCE SENSOR 3317 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B5-S-UP)
3141 123 MM S MM EXIT FENCE POS SEN F 3318 111 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(A4R-S-UP)
3142 123 MM S MM INTERMEDIATE TAMPER SENSOR 3319 111 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(B5R-S-UP)
3150 103 HCF S HCF NIP RELEASE HP SENSOR 3320 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(U-S-UP)
3152 103 HCF S HCF STRIPPER PAD SAFETY SW 3321 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A3-L-DW)
3170 108 HCS S HCS END GUIDE PLATE SEN 3322 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B4-L-DW)
3171 108 HCS S HCS OFFSET UNIT GUIDE SEN 3323 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A4-L-DW)
3174 108 HCS S HCS TRAY PAPER JAM SEN 2 3324 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B5-L-DW)
3175 108 HCS S HCS OFFSET GUIDE POS SEN 3325 111 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(A4R-L-DW)
3176 108 HCS S HCS ELEVATOR MOTOR CHECK 3326 111 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(B5R-L-DW)
3177 108 HCS S HCS SWITCHBACK MOTOR CHECK 3327 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A5-L-DW)
3215 103 HCF M HCF PU DRIVE MOTOR 3328 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B6-L-DW)
3216 103 HCF M HCF MID TRANSFER MOTOR 3329 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A6-L-DW)
3217 98 OST M OST MID FEED MOTOR 1 3330 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(U-L-DW)
3218 98 OST M OST MID FEED MOTOR 2 3331 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A3-L-UP)
3220 98 OST M OST EJECTION MOTOR 3333 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B4-L-UP)
3222 98 OST M OST EJECTION MOTOR (NORMAL) 3334 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A4-L-UP)
3224 98 OST M OST REVERSE MOTOR 3335 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B5-L-UP)
3232 98 OST M OST PSU COOLING FAN 3336 111 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(A4R-L-UP)
3233 98 OST M OST MID FEED COOLING FAN 3337 111 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(B5R-L-UP)
3245 108 HCS M HCS ENTERING MOTOR 3338 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(U-L-UP)
3246 108 HCS M HCS REVERSE MOTOR NORMAL 3339 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A3-C-DW)
3247 108 HCS M HCS REVERSE MOTOR REVERSE 3340 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B4-C-DW)
3248 108 HCS M HCS MID TRANSFER MOTOR 3341 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A4-C-DW)
3249 108 HCS M HCS RISING MOTOR 3342 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B5-C-DW)
3250 108 HCS M HCS EJECTION MOTOR 3343 112 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(A4R-C-DW)
3251 108 HCS M HCS FLIPPER SOL 3344 112 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(B5R-C-DW)
3258 108 HCS M HCS EJECTION WING MOTOR 3345 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A5-C-DW)
3260 108 HCS M HCS OFFSET GUIDE SOLENOID 3346 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B6-C-DW)
3263 124 MM M MM GUIDE MOTOR 3347 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A6-C-DW)
3264 124 MM M MM BODY FOLD MOTOR 3348 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(U-C-DW)
3265 124 MM M MM WRAPPING FOLD MOTOR 3349 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A3-C-UP)
3266 124 MM M MM NIPPING MOTOR 3350 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B4-C-UP)
3267 124 MM M MM FLAP FOLD MOTOR 3351 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A4-C-UP)
3268 124 MM M MM WRAPPING FEED MOTOR 3352 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B5-C-UP)
3269 124 MM M MM FORM REGISTRATION MOTOR 3353 112 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(A4R-C-UP)
3270 124 MM M MM TAMP FEED MOTOR 3354 112 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(B5R-C-UP)
3271 124 MM M MM EJECTION ELEVATION MOT 3355 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(U-C-UP)
3272 124 MM M MM EJECTION MOTOR 3356 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A3-T-DW)
3273 124 MM M MM GUIDE SET SOLENOID 3357 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B4-T-DW)
3274 124 MM M MM TOP TAMP SOLENOID 3358 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A4-T-DW)
3275 124 MM M MM TAMP COOLING-FAN 3359 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B5-T-DW)
3276 124 MM M MM WRAPPING COOLING-FAN 3360 112 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(A4R-T-DW)
3302 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD SELECT 3361 112 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(B5R-T-DW)
3303 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A3-S-DW) 3362 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A5-T-DW)
3304 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B4-S-DW) 3363 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B6-T-DW)
3305 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A4-S-DW) 3364 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A6-T-DW)
3306 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B5-S-DW) 3365 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(U-T-DW)
3307 111 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(A4R-S-DW) 3366 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A3-T-UP)
3308 111 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(B5R-S-DW) 3367 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B4-T-UP)
3309 103 HCF M HCF NIP RELEASE MOTOR 3368 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A4-T-UP)
3310 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A5-S-DW) 3369 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B5-T-UP)
3311 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B6-S-DW) 3370 112 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(A4R-T-UP)
3312 111 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A6-S-DW) 3371 112 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(B5R-T-UP)
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
3372 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(U-T-UP) 3458 99 OST U OST TRY ELEVATION MOTOR(UP)
3373 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(PCD-DW) 3459 99 OST U OST TRAY ELEV MOTOR(DOWN)
3374 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A3-E-DW) 3460 99 OST U OST RVE-ROLLER ELV MOT(UP)
3375 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B4-E-DW) 3461 99 OST U OST RVE-ROLLER ELV MOT(DOWN)
3376 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A4-E-DW) 3462 99 OST U OST STP SLID MOTOR R-MOVE
3377 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B5-E-DW) 3463 99 OST U OST STP SLID MOTOR F-MOVE
3378 112 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(A4R-E-DW) 3464 99 OST U OST R-TAMP MOTOR MOVE
3379 112 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(B5R-E-DW) 3465 99 OST U OST F-TAMP MOTOR MOVE
3380 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A5-E-DW) 3466 99 OST U OST TRAY SHIFT MOTOR R-MOVE
3381 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(B6-E-DW) 3467 99 OST U OST TRAY SHIFT MOTOR F-MOVE
3382 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(A6-E-DW) 3468 99 OST U OST F-TAMP MOTOR REAR MOV
3383 112 HCS D HCS EJT SPD(U-E-DW) 3469 99 OST U OST F-TAMP MOT FRONT MOVE
3400 24 CC U AS SIDE-FENCE HP POS 3473 109 HCS U HCS ELEVATOR UP-LIMIT POS
3401 24 CC U AS SIDE-FENCE CUSTOM 3474 109 HCS U HCS ELEVATOR LOW-LIMIT POS
3402 24 CC U AS END-FENCE HP POS 3477 109 HCS U HCS END FENCE HP RESET
3403 24 CC U AS END-FENCE CUSTOM 3478 109 HCS U HCS END FENCE 1 CYCLE
3404 24 CC U AS FENCE 1 CYCLE 3480 109 HCS U HCS SIDE FENCE HP RESET
3405 109 HCS U HCS OFFSET POS MOV (UNIT) 3481 109 HCS U HCS SIDE FENCE 1 CYCLE
3406 109 HCS U HCS LOCK RELEASE HP MOV 3483 109 HCS U HCS EJECT WING HP RESET
3407 109 HCS U HCS SHIPPING POS MOV 3484 109 HCS U HCS EJECT WING 1 CYCLE
3408 109 HCS U HCS FENCE CENTER ADJ 3485 110 HCS U HCS OFFSET GUIDE HP RESET
3409 124 MM U MM PAD WET ACTION 3486 110 HCS U HCS OFFSET GUIDE 1 CYCLE
3415 104 HCF U HCF PFT WIDTH ADJ (WIDE) 3487 110 HCS U HCS FLIPPER SOL ON-OFF ACT
3416 104 HCF U HCF PFT WIDTH ADJ (NARW) 3488 99 OST U OST RAKE ROLLER ELEVATION
3417 104 HCF U HCF PFT UPPER LIMIT POS 3489 99 OST U OST EJECT ROLLER ELEV MOTOR
3418 104 HCF U HCF PFT LOWER LIMIT POS 3490 99 OST U OST RVE-ROLLER ELEV MOTOR
3420 124 MM U MM END TAMP MOTOR HP SEN 3491 99 OST U OST STP SLID MOTOR
3421 124 MM U MM SIDE TAMP MOTOR HP SEN 3492 99 OST U OST F-TAMP MOTOR
3422 124 MM U MM TOP TAMP MOTOR HP SEN 3493 99 OST U OST R-TAMP MOTOR
3423 124 MM U MM FORM HTL POS MOT HP DET 3494 100 OST U OST TRAY ELEV MOT (1 CYCLE)
3424 124 MM U MM BODY HIT MOTOR 1 HP DET 3495 100 OST U OST TRAY SHIFT MOTOR
3425 124 MM U MM BODY HIT MOTOR 2 HP DET 3496 100 OST U OST STAPLER CLINCH
3426 124 MM U MM TEST PRINT 3497 100 OST U OST RAKE ROLLER ELEV SOL
3427 124 MM U MM FORM HIT MOTOR 2 HP DET 3498 100 OST U OST STP PROTECT LEVER MOV
3428 124 MM U MM FORM HIT MOTOR 3 HP DET 3499 100 OST U OST ELEVATOR MOTOR MOV
3429 124 MM U MM BDY-FOLD SET MOT HP DET 3510 125 MM I MM ADJ SETTING INITIALIZE
3430 109 HCS U HCS TEST PRINT 3515 100 OST I OST TAMP PLATE ADJ VALUE
3431 124 MM U MM TAMP NIP MOT HP DET 3516 100 OST I OST PRINT QTY SELECTION
3432 124 MM U MM GLUING MOTOR HP DET 3517 100 OST I OST STAPLER JOB QUANTITY
3433 125 MM U MM TAMP UNIT INITIALIZE 3518 100 OST I OST SETTING INITIALIZE
3434 125 MM U MM TAMP STAND-BY POS MOV 3525 104 HCF I HCF EEPROM INITIALIZE
3435 125 MM U MM BODY FOLD UNIT INITIAL 3535 110 HCS I HCS EEPROM INITIALIZE
3436 125 MM U MM BODY FOLD STAND-BY POS 3540 113 HCS D HCS EJT SPD SELECT 2
3439 125 MM U MM WARPING UNIT INITIALIZE 3541 113 HCS D HCS EJ SP(B5-S-DW)2
3440 125 MM U MM WRPING UNIT STANDBY POS 3542 113 HCS D HCS EJ SP(B5R-S-DW)2
3441 125 MM U MM FLAP GLUING UNIT INIT 3543 113 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(B5-S-UP)2
3442 125 MM U MM FLAP GLUING STANDBY POS 3544 113 HCS D HCS EJ SP(B5R-S-UP)2
3443 125 MM U MM FORM ENT NIP MOT HP DET 3545 113 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(B5-L-DW)2
3446 109 HCS U HCS FENCE MOV A3 3546 113 HCS D HCS EJ SP(B5R-L-DW)2
3447 109 HCS U HCS FENCE MOV B5 3547 113 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(B5-L-UP)2
3448 125 MM U MM TAMP UNIT POS ADJUST 3548 113 HCS D HCS EJ SP(B5R-L-UP)2
3449 125 MM U MM FORM EDGE SEN AUTO ADJ 3549 113 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(A3-C-DW)2
3450 104 HCF U HCF NIP RELEASE UNIT 1CYCL 3550 113 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(B4-C-DW)2
3452 104 HCF U HCF NIP RELEASE UNIT R-POS 3551 113 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(A4-C-DW)2
3453 104 HCF U HCF NIP RELEASE UNIT N-POS 3552 113 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(B5-C-DW)2
3454 104 HCF U HCF TRY MAINTENANC POS MOV 3553 113 HCS D HCS EJ SP(A4R-C-DW)2
3456 99 OST U OST EJECT ROLLER MOTOR(UP) 3554 113 HCS D HCS EJ SP(B5R-C-DW)2
3457 99 OST U OST EJECT ROLLER MOTOR(DWN) 3555 113 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(A3-C-UP)2
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
3556 113 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(B4-C-UP)2 3701 47 CC D AS END FENCE POSTN
3557 113 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(A4-C-UP)2 3702 47 CC D AS SIDE FENCE HP
3558 113 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(B5-C-UP)2 3703 47 CC D AS SIDE FEN HP P-CRD
3559 113 HCS D HCS EJ SP(A4R-C-UP)2 3704 47 CC D AS END FENCE HP COM
3560 113 HCS D HCS EJ SP(B5R-C-UP)2 3705 47 CC D AS END FEN HP P-CARD
3561 113 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(B5-T-DW)2 3739 101 OST D OST GUIDE ADJ VALUE
3562 113 HCS D HCS EJ SP(B5R-T-DW)2 3740 101 OST D OST EJCT SPEED SPX L
3563 113 HCS D HCS EJ SPD(B5-T-UP)2 3741 101 OST D OST EJCT SPEED SPX S
3564 113 HCS D HCS EJ SP(B5R-T-UP)2 3742 101 OST D OST EJCT SPEED SPX CL
3565 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(B5-S-DW) 3743 101 OST D OST EJCT SPEED SPX CS
3566 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(B5R-S-DW) 3744 101 OST D OST EJCT SPEED DPX L
3567 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(B5-S-UP) 3745 101 OST D OST EJCT SPEED DPX S
3568 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(B5R-S-UP) 3746 101 OST D OST EJCT SPEED DPX CL
3569 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(B5-L-DW) 3747 101 OST D OST EJCT SPEED DPX CS
3570 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(B5R-L-DW) 3748 101 OST D OST ACCEPT SPD SPX L
3571 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(B5-L-UP) 3749 101 OST D OST ACCEPT SPD SPX S
3572 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(B5R-L-UP) 3750 105 HCF D HCF JAM DETECT SET
3573 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(A3-C-DW) 3751 105 HCF D HCF PU ROLLER SPD ADJ
3574 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(B4-C-DW) 3752 105 HCF D HCF PAPER PITCH SET
3575 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(A4-C-DW) 3755 105 HCF D HCF MF ROLLER SPD ADJ
3576 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(B5-C-DW) 3756 105 HCF D HCF PR ROLLER SPD ADJ
3577 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(A4R-C-DW) 3757 105 HCF D HCF PU ROLLER F-RATE
3578 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(B5R-C-DW) 3758 105 HCF D HCF EVTR MOTOR UP SET
3579 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(A3-C-UP) 3761 114 HCS D HCS OFFSET CON SELCT
3580 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(B4-C-UP) 3762 105 HCF D HCF RGST SNR TIME SET
3581 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(A4-C-UP) 3763 105 HCF D HCF PR ROLLER AST SPD
3582 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(B5-C-UP) 3765 105 HCF D HCF MF ROLLER AST SPD
3583 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(A4R-C-UP) 3768 105 HCF D HCF SERIAL No. SET
3584 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(B5R-C-UP) 3769 105 HCF D HCF LIT-SEN WR SET
3585 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(B5-T-DW) 3771 105 HCF D HCF CS U-LIT DET SET
3586 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(B5R-T-DW) 3772 105 HCF D HCF EV U-LIT DET SET
3587 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(B5-T-UP) 3776 105 HCF D HCF PFT JAM ASIT SET
3588 113 HCS D HCS EJ QTY(B5R-T-UP) 3799 114 HCS D HCS SIDE FENCE POSTN
3600 104 HCF C HCF P-F-T PAPER SIZE (AD) 3801 114 HCS D HCS END FENCE POSTN
3602 104 HCF C HCF PFT GUIDE AD VALUE(297mm) 3817 114 HCS D HCS OFST END-FNC ADJ
3603 104 HCF C HCF PFT GUIDE AD VALUE(105mm) 3821 101 OST D OST ACCEPT SPD SPX CL
3604 104 HCF C HCF PFT P-VOL DIS(%) 3822 101 OST D OST ACCEPT SPD SPX CS
3605 104 HCF C HCF P-F-T PAPER SIZE ID 3823 101 OST D OST ACCEPT SPD DPX L
3606 104 HCF C HCF PFT P-WIDTH DET CHECK 3824 101 OST D OST ACCEPT SPD DPX S
3608 104 HCF C HCF SH MAIN FIRMWARE VER 3825 101 OST D OST ACCEPT SPD DPX CL
3609 104 HCF C HCF SH LOADER FIRMWARE VER 3826 101 OST D OST ACCEPT SPD DPX CS
3612 110 HCS C HCS SH MAIN FIRMWARE VER 3827 101 OST D OST STAPLE POSITION R
3613 110 HCS C HCS SH LOADER FIRMWARE VER 3828 101 OST D OST STAPLE POSITION F
3616 100 OST C OST MAIN MICON FIRMWARE VER 3829 101 OST D OST STAPLE POSITION M
3617 100 OST C OST MAIN MICON LOADER VER 3830 101 OST D OST TRY DESCEND QTY C
3619 125 MM C MM LOADER VERSION CHECK 3831 101 OST D OST EJECT-R DESCEND C
3620 125 MM C MM FIRMWARE VERSION 3832 101 OST D OST EJECT-R DESCEND N
3621 125 MM C MM PAPER PASSING COUNT 3833 101 OST D OST REV-ROLLER SPEED
3622 100 OST C OST PAPER COUNT 3834 102 OST D OST MID MOTOR 1 SPEED
3623 100 OST C OST STAPLER JOB COUNT 3835 102 OST D OST MID MOTOR 2 SPEED
3624 100 OST C OST PRINT QTY SELECTION 3836 102 OST D OST FEED MOTOR SPEED
3625 100 OST C OST STAPLE JOB COUNT(TOTAL) 3837 102 OST D OST EJECT MOTOR SPEED
3626 100 OST C OST STAPLE SLIDE MOV CHECK 3838 102 OST D OST TRY DESCEND TIMNG
3657 110 HCS C HCS FU ROLLER MAINTENANCE 3839 102 OST D OST HRZL SHIFT P-PIT
3658 110 HCS C HCS FD ROLLER MAINTENANCE 3840 102 OST D OST HRZL SHIFT TIMNG
3659 110 HCS C HCS TOTAL MENTENANCE COUNT 3841 102 OST D OST EJCT SPD SET ENV
3673 125 MM C MM TEMP DISPLAY 3842 102 OST D OST ACPT SPD SPX ENV
3700 47 CC D AS SIDE FENCE POSTN 3843 102 OST D OST TRY DSCEND QTY E
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
3866 102 OST D OST NON SORT OFFSET 4058 62 FIN S STACKER NO PAPER SNR
3867 102 OST D OST STAPLE ON/OFF ST 4059 62 FIN S STACK HEIGHT SNR
3868 102 OST D OST STAPLE COPY SET 4060 62 FIN S TRAY HIGHT SNR LOWER
3869 102 OST D OST TK TRY STACK ADJ 4061 62 FIN S MIX STACK SNR
3873 102 OST D OST MAX SET ON/OFF B5 4062 62 FIN S HALF STACK SNR
3882 105 HCF D HCF NIP R-MOTOR R-POS 4063 62 FIN S FULL STACK SNR
3883 105 HCF D HCF NIP R-MOTOR N-POS 4064 62 FIN S STACK HEIGHT SNR 3
3942 114 HCS D HCS SERIAL No. SET 4065 62 FIN S STACKER REAR POSITION SNR
3946 114 HCS D HCS END SEN JAM NUM 4067 62 FIN S LOWER LIMIT SWTCH
3961 114 HCS D HCS OFFSET EJ SPD AJ 4068 62 FIN S STACKER SAFTY SWITCH
3962 114 HCS D HCT OFST P-R-T D(UP) 4069 62 FIN S I/F MODULE FRONT DOOR SW
3963 114 HCS D HCT OFST P-R-T D(DW) 4072 62 FIN S FINISHER FRONT DOOR SW
3964 114 HCS D HCS OFST P-PTCH (UP) 4073 62 FIN S FOLDER ENV TRAY OPEN SW
3965 114 HCS D HCS OFST P-PTCH (DW) 4074 62 FIN S FOLDER ENV TRAY SW
3966 114 HCS D HCS LW-PAR U-LIM SET 4077 62 FIN S MANUAL DEC SW MODULE DETECT
3967 114 HCS D HCS JAM E-FNC HP SET 4078 62 FIN S INTERPORSER TOP COVER SW 24V
3968 114 HCS D HCS LOCK SET 4079 62 FIN S KNIFE HOME SNR
3969 114 HCS D HCS SID-FNC SHIP POS 4080 62 FIN S BOOKLET COMPILE NO PAPER SNR
3970 114 HCS D HCS E-FNC SHIP POS 4081 62 FIN S BOOKLET FOLDER ROLL EXIT SNR
3971 115 HCS D HCS PFT SHIPPING POS 4082 62 FIN S BOOKLET DRAWER SET SNR
3972 115 HCS D HCS ELV DW COUNT SET 4083 62 FIN S BOOKLET STAPLER READY
3973 115 HCS D HCS ELV DWN RNGE SET 4084 62 FIN S BOOKLET STAPLER ERROR
3974 115 HCS D HCS PAPER CONDIT CHK 4085 62 FIN S BOOKLET LOW STAPLE F SW
3979 115 HCS D HCS HAND TRCK SET AJ 4086 62 FIN S BOOKLET LOW STAPLE R SW
4020 61 FIN S DEC IN SNR 4087 62 FIN S FEED OUT SNR
4021 61 FIN S DEC OUT SNR 4088 62 FIN S INTERPORSER PAPER SNR
4022 61 FIN S DEC HOME SNR 4089 62 FIN S LEVEL UP SNR
4025 61 FIN S MANUAL DEC SW 1 4090 62 FIN S BOOKLET TRAY BELT SW
4026 61 FIN S MANUAL DEC SW 2 4091 62 FIN S LENGTH SNR
4027 61 FIN S PUNCH OUT SNR 4092 62 FIN S FOLDER ENTRANCE SNR C
4028 61 FIN S COMPILE EXIT SNR 4096 62 FIN S FOLDER PATH SNR 2
4029 61 FIN S TOP TRAY EXIT SNR 4097 62 FIN S FOLDER PATH SNR 3
4030 61 FIN S BAFFER PATH SNR 4098 63 FIN S ENDGUIDE HOME SNR 1
4031 61 FIN S SIDE REGI SNR 4099 63 FIN S ENDGUIDE HOME SNR 2
4032 61 FIN S PUNCH MOT. SNR 4100 63 FIN S ENVELOP TRAY FULL SNR
4033 61 FIN S PUNCH MOVE HOME SNR 4102 63 FIN S FOLDER PATH SNR 1
4036 61 FIN S PUNCH HOME SNR 4103 63 FIN S FOLDER PATH SNR 4
4037 61 FIN S PUNCH FRONT SNR 4106 63 FIN S IOT EXIT SNR
4038 61 FIN S PUNCH HOLE SELECT SNR 4107 63 FIN S PUNCHER 3 HOLE DETECT
4039 61 FIN S SIDE REGI HOME SNR 4108 63 FIN S FOLDER DETECT
4040 61 FIN S PUNCH BOX SET SNR 4109 63 FIN S BOOKLET DETECT
4041 61 FIN S TOP TRAY FULL SNR 4110 63 FIN S INTERPOSER DETECT
4042 61 FIN S COMPILE TRAY NO PAPER SNR 4111 63 FIN S BOOKLET TAMPER HOME SNR F
4043 61 FIN S SUB PADDLE HOME SNR 4112 63 FIN S BOOKLET IN SNR
4044 61 FIN S STAPLE 50PIN SNR 4113 63 FIN S BOOKLET TAMPER HOME SNR R
4045 61 FIN S TAMPER HOME SNR 4114 63 FIN S BOOKLET END GUIDE HOME SNR
4046 61 FIN S END WALL HOME SNR 4116 63 FIN S BOOKLET NO PAPER SNR
4047 61 FIN S END WALL OPEN SNR 4117 63 FIN S KNIFE FOLDING SNR
4048 61 FIN S SHELF HOME SNR 4118 63 FIN S FOLDER EXIT SNR C
4049 61 FIN S STAPLE CENTER POSITION SNR 4119 63 FIN S IF INTER LOCK SW
4050 61 FIN S STAPLE MOVE HOME SNR 4120 63 FIN S DECURLER HP SNR
4051 61 FIN S STACK HEIGHT SNR 2 4230 63 FIN M DECURLER TRANS MOT
4052 61 FIN S LO STAPLE SNR 4231 63 FIN M FIN T/P MOT HIGH FRD
4053 61 FIN S SELF PRIMING SNR 4232 63 FIN M FIN T/P MOT MID FRD
4054 61 FIN S STAPLE HOME SNR 4233 63 FIN M FIN T/P MOT LOW REV
4055 61 FIN S MANUAL DEC SW 3 4234 63 FIN M COMPILE EXIT H FRD
4056 61 FIN S EJECT UP SNR 4235 63 FIN M COMPILE EXIT MID FRD
4057 61 FIN S EJECT SNR 4236 63 FIN M COMPILE EXIT LOW FRD
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
4237 63 FIN M COMPILE EXIT HIG REV 4430 65 FIN U SHELF MOTOR EJECT
4238 63 FIN M COMPILE EXIT LOW REV 4431 65 FIN U SHELF MOTOR STORAGE
4239 63 FIN M PUNCHER MOVE CLUTCH 4432 65 FIN U STAPEL MOT CLOSE ON/OFF
4240 63 FIN M PADDLE MOT 4433 65 FIN U STAPEL MOT REVERSE
4241 63 FIN M EJECT MOT 1 FRD 4434 65 FIN U STAPLE MOVE MOT HIGH FRONT ON/OFF
4242 63 FIN M EJECT MOT 2 FRD 4435 66 FIN U STAPLE MOVE MOT LOW FRONT ON/OFF
4243 64 FIN M EJECT MOT 3 FRD 4436 66 FIN U STAPLE MOVE MOT HIGH REAR ON/OFF
4244 64 FIN M EJECT MOT 4 FRD 4437 66 FIN U STAPLE MOVE MOT LOW REAR ON/OFF
4245 64 FIN M EJECT MOT 5 FRD 4438 66 FIN U COMPILE PADDLE SOL UP
4246 64 FIN M EJECT MOT 1 REV 4439 66 FIN U COMPILE PADDLE SOL DOWN
4247 64 FIN M MANUAL DEC SW 1 LED 4440 66 FIN U SUB PADDLE SOL UP
4248 64 FIN M MANUAL DEC SW 2 LED 4441 66 FIN U SUB PADDLE SOL DOWN
4249 64 FIN M MANUAL DEC SW 3 LED 4442 66 FIN U STACKR FLAPER MOT UP
4250 64 FIN M SCT EXIT MOT MID FRD 4443 66 FIN U STACKR FLAPER MOT DOWN
4251 64 FIN M SCT EXIT MOT LOW FRD 4444 66 FIN U SET CLAMP SOL ON/OFF
4252 64 FIN M SCT EXIT MOT LOW REV 4446 66 FIN U PADDLE SUPORT CLUTCH ON/OFF
4253 64 FIN M EJECT MOT Top-S FRD 4447 66 FIN U ELEVATOR MOT UP
4254 64 FIN M EJECT MOT Top-S REV 4448 66 FIN U ELEVATOR MOT DOWN
4255 64 FIN M INTERPOSER FEED MOT 4449 66 FIN U STACKER OFFSET MOT FRONT
4256 64 FIN M B/L P-PATH MOT HI 4450 66 FIN U STACKER OFFSET MOT REAR
4257 64 FIN M B/L P-PATH MOT MID 4451 66 FIN U ELEVATOR MOT UP 2
4258 64 FIN M B/L P-PATH MOT LOW 4452 66 FIN U ELEVATOR MOT DOWN 2
4259 64 FIN M B/L FOLDER-R MOT FRD 4453 66 FIN U TAMPER MOT MID FRONT ON/OFF
4260 64 FIN M B/L FOLDER-R MOT REV 4454 66 FIN U TAMPER MOT MID REAR ON/OFF
4261 64 FIN M TRAY BELT DRIVE MOT 4455 66 FIN U INTERPOSER TRAY UP ON/OFF
4262 64 FIN M BOOKLET PADDLE MOT 4456 66 FIN U INTERPOSER TRAY DOWN ON/OFF
4265 64 FIN M FOLDER DRIVE MOT2 4457 66 FIN U INTERPOSER NUDGER SOL ON/OFF
4266 64 FIN M FOLDER DRIVE MOT1 4458 66 FIN U BOOKLET KNIFE CLUTCH ON/OFF
4267 64 FIN M FOLDER ENT MOT HI 4459 66 FIN U BOOKLET ENDGUIDE MOT LOW DOWN
4268 64 FIN M FOLDER ENT MOT LOW 4461 66 FIN U BOOKLET ENDGUIDE MOT HI DOWN
4269 64 FIN M FOLDING SOLENOID 1 4462 66 FIN U BOOKLET ENDGUIDE MOT LOW UP
4270 64 FIN M FOLDING SOLENOID 2 4464 67 FIN U BOOKLET ENDGUIDE MOT HI UP
4271 64 FIN M I/P T-P ROLL CLUTCH 4465 67 FIN U BOOKLET STAPLE ON
4272 64 FIN M ENV TRAY LED 1 4468 67 FIN U BOOKLET GATE SOL PUSH
4273 64 FIN M FOLDER C SOLENOID 4469 67 FIN U BOOKLET GATE SOL PULL
4274 64 FIN M DECURLER CLUTCH 4470 67 FIN U ENDGUIDE MOT 1 UP ON/OFF
4275 64 FIN M DECURLER MOTOR 4471 67 FIN U ENDGUIDE MOT 1 DOWN ON/OFF
4405 65 FIN U FIN NVM DATA STORE 4472 67 FIN U ENDGUIDE MOT 2 UP ON/OFF
4406 65 FIN U FIN NVM DATA RESTORE 4473 67 FIN U ENDGUIDE MOT 2 DOWN ON/OFF
4410 65 FIN U DEC CAM CLUTCH ON/OFF 4474 67 FIN U FOLDER GATE SOL 1 PUSH
4412 65 FIN U PUNCHER MOT 2HOLE HOME MOVE 4475 67 FIN U FOLDER GATE SOL 1 PULL
4413 65 FIN U PUNCHER MOT 3HOLE HOME MOVE 4476 67 FIN U FOLDER GATE SOL 2 PUSH
4414 65 FIN U PUNCHER MOT 2HOLE ON/OFF 4477 67 FIN U FOLDER GATE SOL 2 PULL
4415 65 FIN U PUNCHER MOT 3HOLE ON/OFF 4478 67 FIN U ENV TRAY LOCK SOL OPEN
4416 65 FIN U PUNCHER MOVE MOT HIGH FRONT ON/OFF 4479 67 FIN U ENV TRAY LOCK SOL CLOSE
4417 65 FIN U PUNCHER MOVE MOT HIGH REAR ON/OFF 4480 67 FIN U NIP REREASE SOL ON/OFF
4418 65 FIN U PUNCHER MOVE MOT LOWFORNT ON/OFF 4481 67 FIN U BOOKLET TAMPER MOT F REAR ON/OFF 1
4419 65 FIN U PUNCHER MOVE MOT LOWREAR ON/OFF 4482 67 FIN U BOOKLET TAMPER MOT F REAR ON/OFF 2
4420 65 FIN U TRANSPORT GATE SOL PUSH 4483 67 FIN U BOOKLET TAMPER MOT F REAR ON/OFF 3
4421 65 FIN U TRANSPORT GATE SOL PULL 4484 67 FIN U BOOKLET TAMPER MOT F REAR ON/OFF 4
4422 65 FIN U TAMPER MOT HIGH FRONT ON/OFF 4485 67 FIN U BOOKLET TAMPER MOT F FRONT ON/OFF 1
4423 65 FIN U TAMPER MOT LOW FRONT ON/OFF 4486 67 FIN U BOOKLET TAMPER MOT F FRONT ON/OFF 2
4424 65 FIN U TAMPER MOT HIGH REAR ON/OFF 4487 67 FIN U BOOKLET TAMPER MOT F FRONT ON/OFF 3
4425 65 FIN U TAMPER MOT LOW REAR ON/OFF 4488 67 FIN U BOOKLET TAMPER MOT F FRONT ON/OFF 4
4426 65 FIN U END WALL MOT OPEN ON/OFF 4489 67 FIN U BOOKLET TAMPER MOT R FRONT 1 ON/OFF
4427 65 FIN U END WALL MOT CLOSE ON/OFF 4490 67 FIN U BOOKLET TAMPER MOT R FRONT 2 ON/OFF
4428 65 FIN U EJECT CLAMP MOT UP 4491 68 FIN U BOOKLET TAMPER MOT R FRONT 3 ON/OFF
4429 65 FIN U EJECT CLAMP MOT DOWN 4492 68 FIN U BOOKLET TAMPER MOT R FRONT 4 ON/OFF
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
4493 68 FIN U BOOKLET TAMPER MOT R REAR 1 ON/OFF 4691 71 FIN D B/LTRAY BELT ON TMG3
4494 68 FIN U BOOKLET TAMPER MOT R REAR 2 ON/OFF 4692 71 FIN D B/LTRAY BELT ON TMG4
4495 68 FIN U BOOKLET TAMPER MOT R REAR 3 ON/OFF 4693 71 FIN D B/LFULL TIMESUB TICK
4496 68 FIN U BOOKLET TAMPER MOT R REAR 4 ON/OFF 4694 71 FIN D FIN T/P MOT STEP OUT
4497 68 FIN U DEC OFF POSITION 4695 71 FIN D PUNCH MOT SNR DEFECT
4498 68 FIN U UPWARD CURL POSITION 4721 71 FIN D UNSTAPLE LIMIT CARD1
4499 68 FIN U D-WARD CURL POSITION 4722 71 FIN D UNSTAPLE LIMIT CARD2
4500 68 FIN I NVM PARA CLEAR 4723 71 FIN D MIX SIZE FULL DET2
4501 68 FIN I NVM-HFSI PARA CLEAR 4724 71 FIN D DECURLER CONTROL SET
4512 68 FIN I I/P COUNT CLEAR 4725 71 FIN D TOP-T FULL CLR TIME
4514 68 FIN I STAK-S-P COUNT CLEAR 4729 72 FIN D Z-FOLD 50 SHT STACK
4515 68 FIN I STAK-P COUNT CLEAR 4730 72 FIN D SIZE DETECT SET
4516 68 FIN I B/L-P COUNT CLEAR 4731 72 FIN D UNSTAPLE LIMIT SET1
4600 68 FIN C I/P COUNT 4732 72 FIN D PUNCH SELECT
4601 68 FIN C STACKER-SUB-P COUNT 4733 72 FIN D PUNCH SIDE REGI ADJ1
4602 68 FIN C STACKER-P COUNT 4734 72 FIN D PUNCH SIDE REGI ADJ2
4603 68 FIN C B/L PADDLE COUNT 4735 72 FIN D PUNCH SIDE REGI ADJ3
4650 69 FIN D B/LTRAY BELT TIMING1 4736 72 FIN D PUNCH CLUTCH ON TIM
4651 69 FIN D B/LTRAY BELT TIMING2 4737 72 FIN D NON PUNCH CLUTCH TIM
4652 69 FIN D B/LTRAY BELT TIMING3 4738 72 FIN D STACK-TRAY DOWN ADJ
4653 69 FIN D B/LTRAY BELT TIMING4 4739 72 FIN D PUNCH RESERVE ADJ1
4654 69 FIN D TOP TRAY DEC CTL SET 4740 72 FIN D PUNCH DUST FULL ADJ
4655 69 FIN D S-EJECT OFFSET SET 4741 72 FIN D STAPLE LIMIT 100
4656 69 FIN D Reserved 4742 72 FIN D STAPLE LIMIT 50
4657 69 FIN D S-EJCT CONDITION SET 4743 72 FIN D R-STAPLE POSITION 1
4658 69 FIN D B/L STAPLE CALI5 4744 72 FIN D UNSTAPLE LIMIT SET2
4659 69 FIN D B/L STAPLE CALI6 4745 72 FIN D TAMPING HOME ADJ
4660 69 FIN D B/L STAPLE CALI7 4746 72 FIN D COMPILE SLOW TIM
4661 69 FIN D B/L STAPLE CALI8 4747 72 FIN D EJECT MODE SET
4662 69 FIN D B/L STAPLE CALI9 4748 73 FIN D EJECT-R REVERSE TIM
4663 69 FIN D B/L STAPLE CALI10 4749 73 FIN D R-STAPLE POSITION 2
4664 69 FIN D B/L STAPLE CALI11 4750 73 FIN D NO PAPER PERIOD
4665 69 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI5-S 4751 73 FIN D B/L BELT SETTING
4666 69 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI6-S 4752 73 FIN D B/L COMPILE CALI1
4667 69 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI7-S 4753 73 FIN D B/L COMPILE CALI2
4668 70 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI8-S 4756 73 FIN D COMPILE UP LIMIT
4669 70 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI9-S 4757 73 FIN D S-PADDLE UP LIMIT
4670 70 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI10-S 4758 73 FIN D SINGLE STAPLE LIMIT
4671 70 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI11-S 4759 73 FIN D MIX SIZE FULL1
4672 70 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI5-L 4760 73 FIN D DUAL STAPLE LIMIT
4673 70 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI6-L 4761 73 FIN D TAIL EDGE HIGHT ADJ
4674 70 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI7-L 4762 73 FIN D PUNCH REVERSE ADJ2
4675 70 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI8-L 4764 73 FIN D BUFFER SHEET REVERCE
4676 70 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI9-L 4765 73 FIN D MAX STAPLE LIMIT
4677 70 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI10-L 4766 73 FIN D B/L FOLD ADJ LARGE
4678 70 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI11-L 4767 73 FIN D B/L FOLD ADJ SMALL
4679 70 FIN D B/L FULL TIME S UP16 4768 74 FIN D B/L STAPLE ADJ LARGE
4680 70 FIN D B/L FULL TIME L UP16 4769 74 FIN D B/L STAPLE ADJ SMALL
4681 70 FIN D STACK PITCH ADD TIME 4770 74 FIN D B/L R-TAMP ADJ
4682 70 FIN D TAMPING START ADJ2 4771 74 FIN D B/L STAPLE LIMIT
4683 70 FIN D TAMPING START ADJ3 4772 74 FIN D B/L UNSTAPLE LIMIT
4684 70 FIN D TAMPING START ADJ4 4773 74 FIN D B/L COMPILE CALIB1
4685 70 FIN D B/LTRAY BELT TIMING5 4774 74 FIN D B/L COMPILE CALIB2
4686 70 FIN D B/LTRAY BELT TIMING6 4775 74 FIN D Z-FOLD STACK-T SET
4687 71 FIN D B/LTRAY BELT TIMING7 4776 74 FIN D FOLDING TIME
4688 71 FIN D B/LTRAY BELT TIMING8 4777 74 FIN D Z-FOLD1 8K GCO
4689 71 FIN D B/LTRAY BELT ON TMG1 4778 74 FIN D Z-FOLD2 8K GCO
4690 71 FIN D B/LTRAY BELT ON TMG2 4779 74 FIN D Z-FOLD1 A3
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
4780 74 FIN D Z-FOLD1 11X17 4852 78 FIN D THICK-P PATH M-SPEED
4781 74 FIN D Z-FOLD1 B4 4853 78 FIN D STACK-T EJECT TIME
4782 74 FIN D BUFFER SHEET TIMING 4854 78 FIN D DESTINATION ID
4783 75 FIN D Z-FOLD1 8K 4855 78 FIN D FLAP COMBINATION
4784 75 FIN D Z-FOLD2 A3 4856 78 FIN D SINGLE-S STACK LIMIT
4785 75 FIN D Z-FOLD2 11X17 4857 78 FIN D DOUBLE-S STACK LIMIT
4786 75 FIN D Z-FOLD2 B4 4858 78 FIN D PUNCH REVERSE ADJ3
4787 75 FIN D MAX BI-FOLDING 4859 78 FIN D PUNCH REVERSE ADJ4
4788 75 FIN D Z-FOLD1 8K 4860 78 FIN D B/L MISREGI SETTING
4789 75 FIN D ENV-C FOLD1 A4SEF 4861 79 FIN D STACK-T EJECT S-STA
4790 75 FIN D ENV-C FOLD1 85X11SEF 4862 79 FIN D STACK-T EJECT D-STA
4791 75 FIN D ENV-C FOLD2 A4SEF 4863 79 FIN D STACK-T EJECT Z-STA
4792 75 FIN D ENV-C FOLD2 85X11SEF 4864 79 FIN D Z-FOLD NUM COMV B4
4793 75 FIN D PAPER ADD FEED ADJ 4865 79 FIN D PUNCHER COMBINATION
4794 75 FIN D ROLL NIP TIMING 4866 79 FIN D BUFFER-P EJECT SET
4796 75 FIN D Z-FL STACK-T SET B4S 4867 79 FIN D FOLDER C SOL ON A4S
4797 75 FIN D Z-FOLD LIMIT S-T B4S 4868 79 FIN D FOLDER C SOL ON LETS
4798 75 FIN D Z-FOLD LIMIT T-T 4869 79 FIN D FOLDER C SOL ON
4799 75 FIN D SUB PAD TIMING THIN 4870 79 FIN D B/L FULL TIME SMALL
4800 75 FIN D Z-FOLD LIMIT S-T A3 4871 79 FIN D B/L FULL TIME LARGE
4801 75 FIN D ROLL NIP TIMING Z 4872 79 FIN D FULL FAIL STATUS MIX
4802 76 FIN D PUNCH REGI TIM A4S 4873 79 FIN D MAX STAPLE SMALL
4808 76 FIN D B/L ADD TAMPING SET1 4875 79 FIN D D-STAPLE MOV ADJ F
4809 76 FIN D B/L STPHOLD TAMPING1 4876 79 FIN D D-STAPLE MOV ADJ F/R
4810 76 FIN D B / L ADD TAMPING NUM1 4877 79 FIN D ENABLE STACK H SNR3
4811 76 FIN D ENABLE STACK H SNR1 4878 79 FIN D ENABLE DEC AUTO LED
4815 76 FIN D P-SUPPORT SET WIDH2 4879 79 FIN D B/L STAPLE ADJ FS
4816 76 FIN D Z-FOLD 11X17 SETTING 4880 79 FIN D ENABLE S-H-SNR2
4817 76 FIN D SUB PADDLE TIM B5L 4881 79 FIN D BUFFER REVERSE ADJ
4820 76 FIN D PUNCH TIME 4882 79 FIN D ENABLE F-TRAY FULL
4821 76 FIN D STACKER TRAY TIME 4883 80 FIN D F-TRAY FULL SETTING
4822 76 FIN D STACK-T TOP WIDTH 4884 80 FIN D ENABLE MISREGI STACK
4823 76 FIN D STACK-T TOP LENGTH 4886 80 FIN D IPL VERSION
4824 76 FIN D STACK-T MAX WIDTH 4887 80 FIN D Z-FOLD TIME LOW
4825 76 FIN D STACK-T MAX LENGTH 4888 80 FIN D Z-FOLD TIME TOP
4826 76 FIN D B/L E-GUIDE CALI SET 4889 80 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI1 S
4827 76 FIN D S-TRAY EJECT A3 4890 80 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI2 S
4830 76 FIN D C-PADDLE UP TIMING S 4891 80 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI3 S
4831 76 FIN D C-PADDLE UP TIMING L 4892 80 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI4 S
4832 76 FIN D DISABLE 2/3P A-CHANG 4893 80 FIN D B/L STAPEL 15 LARGE
4833 77 FIN D ENABLE MIX JOB PUNCH 4894 81 FIN D B/L STAPLE 15 SAMLL
4834 77 FIN D EJECT SPEED SET <216 4895 81 FIN D B/L STAPLE CALI1
4835 77 FIN D EJECT SPEED SET >216 4896 81 FIN D B/L STAPLE CALI2
4836 77 FIN D ENV-Z FOLD1 A4SEF 4897 81 FIN D B/L STAPLE CALI3
4837 77 FIN D ENV-Z FOLD1 LET 4898 81 FIN D B/L STAPLE CALI4
4838 77 FIN D ENV-Z FOLD2 A4SEF 4900 81 FIN D R-STAPLE ADJ
4839 77 FIN D ENV-Z FOLD2 LET 4901 81 FIN D 12-227 DISABLE SET
4840 77 FIN D CENTER STAPLE ADJ 4903 81 FIN D P-SUPPORT SET WIDTH
4841 77 FIN D SET CLAMP TIME LOW 4904 81 FIN D THICK PAPER1 SET
4842 77 FIN D SET CLAMP TIME TOP 4905 81 FIN D REUSED PAPER SET
4843 77 FIN D P-FEED TIME LOW 4906 81 FIN D BUFFER DISABLE SET
4844 77 FIN D P-FEED TIME TOP 4907 82 FIN D 3TAM PAPER SET
4846 77 FIN D TAMPING START ADJ1 4908 82 FIN D Z-FOLD STAPLE 50PIN
4847 77 FIN D DEC CTL SET THIN-P 4909 82 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI1 L
4848 77 FIN D PUDDLE UP THIN-P 4910 82 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI2 L
4849 78 FIN D PUDDLE DOWN THIN-P 4911 82 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI3 L
4850 78 FIN D TAMPING SET THIN-P 4912 82 FIN D B/L FOLD CALI4 L
4851 78 FIN D STACK-T EJECT Z-FOLD 4913 82 FIN D S-PUDDLE MOV SET
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
4915 82 FIN D P-SUPPORT I/P CARD2 4985 86 FIN D B/L STP TAMP ADD NUM
4917 82 FIN D TAMPER HOLD CARD2 4986 86 FIN D Z-HOLD 100 FLAP-U A3
4918 82 FIN D TAMPER HOLD Z-FOLD 4987 86 FIN D Z-HOLD 100 FLAP-U B4
4919 82 FIN D C-FOLD SOL ON LETS 4988 86 FIN D BUF COMB STOP TIME
4920 82 FIN D C-FOLD SOL ON A4S 4989 86 FIN D BUF COMB STOP SET
4921 82 FIN D C-FOLD SOL ON B4S 4990 86 FIN D Z-HOLD 100 STP A3
4922 83 FIN D C-FOLD SOL ON 8KTFX 4991 86 FIN D Z-HOLD 100 STP B4
4923 83 FIN D C-FOLD SOL ON 8KGSO 4992 86 FIN D Z-HOLD UP CURL SET
4924 83 FIN D C-FOLD SOL ON A3S 4993 86 FIN D Z-HOLD NUM CONV A3
4925 83 FIN D C-FOLD SOL ON 11X17S 4994 86 FIN D Z-HOLD NUM CONV B4
4926 83 FIN D C-FOLD SOL TIM EMV 4995 87 FIN D B/L F-R TIME LOW A4S
4927 83 FIN D CLAMP UP TIMING NO-P 4996 87 FIN D B/L F-R TIME UP A4S
4928 83 FIN D CLAMP UP TIMING 4997 87 FIN D UNSTAPLE EJECT SPEED
4929 83 FIN D PUNCH SIDE ADJ IOT1 4998 87 FIN D Z-HOLD SHELF IN ADJ
4930 83 FIN D PUNCH SIDE ADJ IOT2 5010 88 SCN S FB ORGL DET SENSOR
4931 83 FIN D PUNCH SIDE ADJ IOT3 5011 88 SCN S FB ORGL SIZE SENSOR1
4932 83 FIN D PUNCH SIDE ADJ IOT4 5012 88 SCN S FB ORGL SIZE SENSOR2
4933 83 FIN D PUNCH SIDE ADJ IOT5 5013 88 SCN S FB ORGL SIZE SENSOR3
4934 83 FIN D PUNCH SIDE ADJ IOT6 5014 88 SCN S FB ORGL SIZE SENSOR4
4935 83 FIN D PUNCH SIDE ADJ IOT7 5015 88 SCN S FB ORGL SIZE SENSOR5
4943 84 FIN D C-EXIT SPEED B5THIN 5016 88 SCN S FB ORGL SIZE SENSOR6
4944 84 FIN D C-EXIT SPEED B5L 5017 88 SCN S FB ORGL COVER SNSR
4945 84 FIN D B/L MISREGI E-G SET 5018 88 SCN S FB ORGL CVR ANGL SNR
4950 84 FIN D EJECT TRAY SETTING 5019 88 SCN S SCANNER HP SENSOR
4951 84 FIN D OFFSET EJECT SETTING 5030 88 SCN S AF ORGL DET SENSOR
4952 84 FIN D STAPLE SETTING 5031 88 SCN S AF REGIST SENSOR
4953 84 FIN D PUNCHER SETTING 5032 88 SCN S AF ORGL IN SENSOR
4954 84 FIN D BOOKLET SETTING 5033 88 SCN S AF ORGL OUT SENSOR
4955 84 FIN D FOLDING SETTING 5034 88 SCN S AF FEED CVR SET SW
4956 84 FIN D PATCH LEVEL 5035 88 SCN S AF TRAY SENSOR 1
4957 84 FIN D UNSTAPLE LIM S-T MIX 5036 88 SCN S AF TRAY SENSOR 2
4958 84 FIN D Z-FOLD 1000SHT STACK 5040 88 SCN S AF UNIT DETECTION
4959 84 FIN D Z-HOLD P-JAM MEASURE 5041 88 SCN S AF SEPARATION SENSOR
4960 84 FIN D STACK-T OFFSET ADJ 5210 88 SCN M SCANNER LAMP
4961 84 FIN D STACK-T TIME Z-HOLD 5230 88 SCN M AF READ PULSE MTR CW
4962 84 FIN D STACK-T LOAD NUMBER 5231 88 SCN M AF FAN
4963 84 FIN D FLAP UP STAPLE NUM 5400 89 SCN U SCANNER TEST PRINT
4964 85 FIN D Z-FOLD DEC CTL SET 5405 89 SCN U SCANNER FRONT LED
4965 85 FIN D Z-FOLD P-PITCH SETA3 5406 89 SCN U SCANNER PROFILE MODE
4966 85 FIN D Z-FOLD P-PITCH SETLD 5409 89 SCN U SCANNER PRMTR PRINT
4967 85 FIN D Z-FOLD P-PITCH SETB4 5410 89 SCN U FB SCAN 1 CYCLE
4968 85 FIN D Z-FOLD P-PITCH SET H 5411 89 SCN U FB SCAN RPT CYCLE
4969 85 FIN D NO Z-FOLD P-PITCH A3 5412 89 SCN U CARRIAGE HP RETURN
4970 85 FIN D NO Z-FOLD P-PITCH LD 5413 89 SCN U CARRIAGE CHANGE POSITION
4971 85 FIN D NO Z-FOLD P-PITCH B4 5414 89 SCN U CARRIAGE LOCK POS
4972 85 FIN D NO Z-FOLD P-PITCH H 5415 89 SCN U SCANNER LOCK RELEASE
4973 85 FIN D Z-HOLD SPEED UP MECH 5430 89 SCN U AF SCAN REPEAT CYCLE
4974 85 FIN D Z-HOLD EJECT SPEED 5431 90 SCN U AF ORGNL FEED ACTION
4975 85 FIN D STACK-TRAY TYPE SET 5432 90 SCN U AF VR ADJ (P-CARD)
4976 85 FIN D Z-HOLD UP CURL ADJ 5433 90 SCN U AF VR ADJ (A4R)
4977 85 FIN D ENV-C FOLD DEC UP 5501 90 SCN I SCANNER JAM CLEAR
4978 85 FIN D FLAP DOWN STACK NUM 5508 90 SCN I SCNR OVER-PARA. CLR
4979 85 FIN D FLAP UP STACKER DOWN 5509 90 SCN I SCNR TEST PARAM. CLR
4980 85 FIN D Z-FOLD 100 STACK A3 5600 90 SCN C SCANNER ERROR DSPLAY
4981 85 FIN D Z-FOLD 100 STACK B4 5605 90 SCN C SCANNER TTL CNTR DSP
4982 86 FIN D FLAP UP MOVE TIME 5606 90 SCN C FB SCAN COUNT DSPLAY
4983 86 FIN D FLAP DOWN MOVE TIME 5607 90 SCN C AF SCAN COUNT DSPLAY
4984 86 FIN D B/L STP TAMP ADD SET 5608 90 SCN C SCNR OVER-PARA. DSPL
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
5609 90 SCN C SCNR TEST PARAM. DSP 5763 94 SCN D MOIRE C/DU/MC/ED
5610 90 SCN C FB ORIGINAL SIZE 5764 94 SCN D MOIRE C/DU/MC/DS
5630 90 SCN C AF ORIGINAL SIZE 5765 94 SCN D MOIRE C/PH/CLR/ED
5631 90 SCN C WHITE LEVEL CHECK _ R 5766 94 SCN D MOIRE C/PH/CLR/DS
5632 90 SCN C WHITE LEVEL CHECK _ G 5767 94 SCN D MOIRE C/PH/MC/ED
5633 90 SCN C WHITE LEVEL CHECK _ B 5768 94 SCN D MOIRE C/PH/MC/DS
5650 90 SCN C COLOR PROFILE S/N 5769 94 SCN D MOIRE S/LN/MC
5700 91 SCN D TEST PRNT RESOLUTION 5770 95 SCN D MOIRE S/DU/MC
5701 91 SCN D TEST SCAN SIZE SELCT 5771 95 SCN D MOIRE S/PH/MC
5703 91 SCN D TEST SCAN S/D SELECT 5772 95 SCN D MOIRE S/LN/GRY
5706 91 SCN D WHITE LEVEL THRESH_R 5773 95 SCN D MOIRE S/DU/GRY
5707 91 SCN D WHITE LEVEL THRESH_G 5774 95 SCN D MOIRE S/PH/GRY
5708 91 SCN D WHITE LEVEL THRESH_B 5775 95 SCN D MOIRE S/LN/CLR
5710 91 SCN D FB SCAN HRZNTL POSTN 5776 95 SCN D MOIRE S/DU/CLR
5711 91 SCN D FB SCAN STRT POSTN 5777 95 SCN D MOIRE S/PH/CLR
5712 91 SCN D FB SCAN ELONGTN ADJ 5778 95 SCN D MBC INTL SET C/CLR
5715 92 SCN D SCANNER LOCK/UNLOCK 5779 95 SCN D MBC INTL SET C/MC
5718 92 SCN D R0/ANALOG ADJUSTMENT 5780 95 SCN D MBC INTL SET S/CLR
5719 92 SCN D G0/ANALOG ADJUSTMENT 5781 95 SCN D MBC INTL SET S/GRY
5720 92 SCN D B0/ANALOG GAIN ADJ 5782 95 SCN D MBC INTL SET S/MC
5721 92 SCN D R1/ANALOG GAIN ADJ 5783 95 SCN D ABC FREQ THRESHOLD 1
5722 92 SCN D G1/ANALOG GAIN ADJ 5784 95 SCN D ABC FREQ THRESHOLD 2
5723 92 SCN D B1/ANALOG GAIN ADJ 5785 95 SCN D ABC DENSITY BORDER
5724 92 SCN D R0/DIGITAL GAIN ADJ 5786 95 SCN D ABC OFFSET - MONCHRO
5725 92 SCN D G0/DIGITAL GAIN ADJ 5787 95 SCN D ABC OFFSET - COLOR
5726 92 SCN D B0/DIGITAL GAIN ADJ 5788 95 SCN D MBC OFFSET - MONCHRO
5727 93 SCN D R1/DIGITAL GAIN ADJ 5789 95 SCN D MBC OFFSET - COLOR
5728 93 SCN D G1/DIGITAL GAIN ADJ 5790 95 SCN D ABC BETA OFFSET MC
5729 93 SCN D B1/DIGITAL GAIN ADJ 5791 95 SCN D ABC BETA OFFSET CLR
5730 93 SCN D AF SCAN HRZNTL POSTN 5792 95 SCN D MBC BETA OFFSET MC
5731 93 SCN D AF SCAN STRT POS (F) 5793 95 SCN D MBC BETA OFFSET CLR
5732 93 SCN D AF SCAN STRT POS (B) 5794 95 SCN D PLAIN BINRY THRESHLD
5733 93 SCN D AF SCAN ELONGTN (F) 5795 95 SCN D ACHRO 1 OFFSET C/ACS
5734 93 SCN D AF SCAN ELONGTN (B) 5796 95 SCN D ACHRO 1 OFFSET S/ACS
5735 93 SCN D AF SCAN CARRIAGE POS 5797 95 SCN D ACHRO 2 OFFSET C/ACS
5740 94 SCN D EDGE ENH C/LN/CLR 5798 96 SCN D ACHRO 2 OFFSET S/ACS
5741 94 SCN D EDGE ENH C/LN/MC 5799 96 SCN D LUMI THRESHOLD C/ACS
5742 94 SCN D EDGE ENH C/DU/CLR/ED 5800 96 SCN D LUMI THRESHOLD S/ACS
5743 94 SCN D EDGE ENH C/DU/CLR/DS 5801 96 SCN D CLR PXL THRHLD C/ACS
5744 94 SCN D EDGE ENH C/DU/MC/ED 5802 96 SCN D CLR PXL THRHLD S/ACS
5745 94 SCN D EDGE ENH C/DU/MC/DS 5803 96 SCN D COLOR PROFILE SELECT
5746 94 SCN D EDGE ENH C/PH/CLR/ED 5805 96 SCN D SCAN DENSITY SELECT
5747 94 SCN D EDGE ENH C/PH/CLR/DS 5810 96 SCN D HRZONTL LINE ON/OFF
5748 94 SCN D EDGE ENH C/PH/MC/ED 5811 96 SCN D VERTICAL LINE ON/OFF
5749 94 SCN D EDGE ENH C/PH/MC/DS 5815 96 SCN D COPY MODE MASK AMNT
5750 94 SCN D EDGE ENH S/LN/MC 5816 96 SCN D SCAN MODE MASK AMNT
5751 94 SCN D EDGE ENH S/DU/MC 5818 96 SCN D ABC OFFSET - 2 COLOR
5752 94 SCN D EDGE ENH S/PH/MC 5819 96 SCN D MBC OFFSET - 2 COLOR
5753 94 SCN D EDGE ENH S/LN/GRY 5820 96 SCN D ABC BETA OFFSET - 2C
5754 94 SCN D EDGE ENH S/DU/GRY 5821 96 SCN D MBC BETA OFFSET - 2C
5755 94 SCN D EDGE ENH S/PH/GRY 5850 96 SCN D IMAGE THRESH LN/DS
5756 94 SCN D EDGE ENH S/LN/CLR 5851 96 SCN D IMAGE THRESH PH/DS
5757 94 SCN D EDGE ENH S/DU/CLR 5900 97 SCN D FB SCAN DFT HRZL POS
5758 94 SCN D EDGE ENH S/PH/ CLR 5901 97 SCN D FB SCAN DFT STRT POS
5759 94 SCN D MOIRE C/LN/CLR 5902 97 SCN D FB SCAN DFT ELGN SET
5760 94 SCN D MOIRE C/LN/MC 5903 97 SCN D AF ELGN DFLT SET (F)
5761 94 SCN D MOIRE C/DU/CLR/ED 5904 97 SCN D AF ELGN DFLT SET (B)
5762 94 SCN D MOIRE C/DU/CLR/DS 5905 97 SCN D AF CARRIAGE DFLT POS
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
5911 97 SCN D EDG ENH INL C/MAP/ED 6057 128 MM D MM SIDE TRIM_HP LG
5912 97 SCN D EDG ENH INL C/MAP/DS 6058 128 MM D MM TOP TRIM_HP A4
5913 97 SCN D MOIRE INL C/MAP/ED 6059 128 MM D MM TOP TRIM_HP B5
5914 97 SCN D MOIRE INL C/MAP/DS 6060 128 MM D MM TOP TRIM_HP LT
5915 97 SCN D DUO BASIS C/PH/ED 6061 128 MM D MM TOP TRIM_HP LG
5916 97 SCN D DUO BASIS C/PH/DS 6065 128 MM D MM BDY HIT1_HP A3_3F
5917 97 SCN D DUO BASIS C/MAP/ED 6066 128 MM D MM BDY HIT1_HP A4_2F
5918 97 SCN D DUO BASIS C/MAP/DS 6067 128 MM D MM BDY HIT1_HP B5_3F
5919 97 SCN D DUO BASIS C/DU/ED 6069 128 MM D MM BDY HIT1_HP LT_3F
5920 97 SCN D DUO BASIS C/DU/DS 6071 128 MM D MM BDY HIT1_HP LG_4F
5921 97 SCN D DUO BASIS C/LN 6072 129 MM D MM BDY HIT1_OFFSET P
5922 97 SCN D DUO BASIS S/PH 6073 129 MM D MM BDY HIT2_HP A4_3F
5923 97 SCN D DUO BASIS S/DU 6074 129 MM D MM BDY HIT2_HP B5_3F
5924 97 SCN D DUO BASIS S/LN 6075 129 MM D MM BDY HIT2_HP LT_3F
5992 97 SCN D SCANNER LED ADJ 6076 129 MM D MM BDY HIT2_HP LG_4F
6005 126 MM D MM GUIDE MOTOR SPEED 6077 129 MM D MM BDY HIT2_OFFSET P
6006 126 MM D MM U FORM SWT TIM 1S 6078 129 MM D MM BDY FLD_NO FLD HP
6007 126 MM D MM U FORM SWT TIM 2S 6081 129 MM D MM WRAP FD PAUSE TIM
6008 126 MM D MM U FORM SWT TIM 3S 6082 129 MM D MM WRAP FD STOP TIM
6009 126 MM D MM U FORM SWT TIM 4S 6083 129 MM D MM FRM HIT2_HP A_3F
6010 126 MM D MM TEST PATERN SELCT 6085 129 MM D MM FRM HIT2_HP B_3F
6011 126 MM D MM TEST PATERN QTY 6086 129 MM D MM FRM HIT2_HP_C_3F
6012 126 MM D MM U BODY SWT TIM 1S 6087 129 MM D MM FRM HIT2_OFFSET P
6013 126 MM D MM U BODY SWT TIM 2S 6088 129 MM D MM W-F RESTART_A4<
6014 126 MM D MM U BODY SWT TIM 3S 6089 129 MM D MM W-F RESTART_B5&LG
6015 126 MM D MM U BODY SWT TIM 4S 6095 129 MM D MM FRM HOL MTR EXITE
6016 115 HCS D HCS TEST PRINT QTY 6096 129 MM D MM FORM BUKLE ADJ 1S
6017 115 HCS D HCS TEST OFFSET QTY 6097 129 MM D MM FORM BUKLE ADJ 2S
6018 115 HCS D HCS TEST PRINT PASS 6098 129 MM D MM FORM BUKLE ADJ 3S
6019 126 MM D MM PAD WET WAIT TIME 6099 129 MM D MM FORM BUKLE ADJ 4S
6020 126 MM D MM PAD WET ROT TIME 6102 129 MM D MM FORM HP ADJ PULSE
6021 126 MM D MM PAD WET PUSH TIME 6103 129 MM D MM FORM RESIST STOP
6022 126 MM D MM PAD WET ACT COUNT 6104 129 MM D MM FRM HOL POS PULSE
6023 126 MM D MM PAD WET ACT ALLOW 6105 130 MM D MM FORM HOL HP PULSE
6024 127 MM D MM JAM DET_OFF ZONE 6106 130 MM D MM FRM HOL MTR SPEED
6025 127 MM D MM JAM DET_ON ZONE 6131 130 MM D MM ENVLP EDGE SENSOR
6030 127 MM D MM END TRIM_START 1S 6133 130 MM D MM FORM REGIST SPD 2
6031 127 MM D MM END TRIM_START 2S 6134 130 MM D MM FORM HOL-MOT ADJ
6032 127 MM D MM END TRIM_START 3S 6135 130 MM D MM FRM ENT-NP-MOT AJ
6033 127 MM D MM END TRIM_START 4S 6136 130 MM D MM GLUE PAUSE TIME
6036 127 MM D MM END TRIM_HP RETRN 6137 130 MM D MM GLUE START TIMING
6037 127 MM D MM SIDE TRIM_START 6138 130 MM D MM GLUE PLATE HP POS
6038 127 MM D MM SIDE TRIM_HP TIM 6139 130 MM D MM GLUE MTR_BRK TIME
6039 128 MM D MM SIDE TRIM PULSE 1 6143 130 MM D MM FRM HIT3_HP_A_3F
6040 128 MM D MM SIDE TRIM PULSE 2 6145 130 MM D MM FRM HIT3_HP_B_3F
6041 128 MM D MM SIDE TRIM COUNT 6146 130 MM D MM FRM HIT3_HP_C_3F
6042 128 MM D MM TRM F-MTR_STOP 1S 6147 130 MM D MM FRM HIT3_OFFSET P
6043 128 MM D MM TRM F-MTR_STOP 2S 6148 130 MM D MM WATER EMPTY COUNT
6044 128 MM D MM TRM F-MTR_STOP 3S 6150 130 MM D MM F-FLD MTR_BRAKE T
6045 128 MM D MM TRM F-MTR_STOP 4S 6151 130 MM D MM GLUE POS AJ_A&C
6048 128 MM D MM TRIM FD_START TIM 6152 130 MM D MM GLUE POS ADJ_B
6050 128 MM D MM TRM NIP_BRAKE TIM 6153 130 MM D MM WATER EMPTY DRAIN
6051 128 MM D MM TOP TRIM_HIT AVID 6155 130 MM D MM F MTR_STP ADD TIM
6052 128 MM D MM TOP TRIM_HIT TIM 6156 130 MM D MM EJ VERT MTR SPEED
6053 128 MM D MM TRIM NIP_RETN TIM 6157 130 MM D MM EJ-VRT-MOT FLP AJ
6054 128 MM D MM SIDE TRIM_HP A4 6158 130 MM D MM EJECT TRAY FULL
6055 128 MM D MM SIDE TRIM_HP B5 6159 130 MM D MM FULL DETECT COUNT
6056 128 MM D MM SIDE TRIM_HP LT 6161 131 MM D MM EJT MTR SPD F DWN
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
6162 131 MM D MM EJT MTR SPD_BDY 0 6335 133 MM D MM DA1 BAR CODE SEN
6163 131 MM D MM EJT MTR SPD_BDY 1 6336 133 MM D MM DA2 ENVLP EDG SEN
6164 131 MM D MM EJT MTR SPD_BDY 2 6477 133 MM D MM P-FEED CTL SELECT
6165 131 MM D MM TRM EJT_NA JAM A4 6508 133 MM D MM TRM NIP_NIP BRAKE
6166 131 MM D MM TRM EJT_NA JAM B5 6509 133 MM D MM TRIM NIP_HP BRAKE
6167 131 MM D MM TRM EJT_NA JAM LT 6510 133 MM D MM TRM F-MTR SPDUP T
6168 131 MM D MM TRM EJT_NA JAM LG 6511 133 MM D MM TRM F-MTR SPDUP S
6169 131 MM D MM BDY FLD IN_NA JAM 6512 133 MM D MM END TMP STD-BY AJ
6170 131 MM D MM WRP IN_NJAM A4_3F 6513 133 MM D MM END TMP HIT ADJ
6171 131 MM D MM WRP IN_NJAM B5_3F 6541 133 MM D MM WRAP FOLD MTR SPD
6172 131 MM D MM WRP IN_NJAM LT_3F 6542 133 MM D MM WRAP FEED MTR SPD
6173 131 MM D MM WRP IN_NJAM A4_2F 6609 133 MM D MM EJT MTR SPD_BDY 3
6176 131 MM D MM WRP IN_NJAM LG_4F 6610 133 MM D MM EJT MTR SPD_BDY 4
6177 131 MM D MM WRP HP_NA JAM ADJ 6611 133 MM D MM EJT MTR SPD_BDY 5
6178 131 MM D MM TAMP EJECT JAM A4 6612 133 MM D MM EJT MTR SPD_BDY 6
6179 131 MM D MM TAMP EJECT JAM B5 6616 133 MM D MM TRY N-FULL COUNT
6180 131 MM D MM TAMP EJECT JAM LT 6617 133 MM D MM TRY FULL EJT NUM
6181 131 MM D MM TAMP EJECT JAM LG 6619 133 MM D MM EJT FENCE D COUNT
6182 131 MM D MM TOP TAMP NA JAM 6620 133 MM D MM TRY FULL F SENSOR
6183 131 MM D MM TOP TAMP JAM A4 6621 133 MM D MM TRY FULL R SENSOR
6184 131 MM D MM TOP TAMP JAM B5 6622 134 MM D MM LOW-TMP MOD VAL 1
6185 131 MM D MM TOP TAMP JAM LT 6623 134 MM D MM LOW-TMP MOD VAL 2
6186 131 MM D MM TOP TAMP JAM LG 6624 134 MM D MM L-TMP STOP MD SEL
6187 131 MM D MM BDY FLD JAM A4_3F 6625 134 MM D MM EJ-BLT INTRVL SET
6188 131 MM D MM BDY FLD JAM B5_3F 6626 134 MM D MM FL GLUE_JAM B
6189 131 MM D MM BDY FLD JAM LT_3F 6627 134 MM D MM FL GLUE_JAM C
6190 131 MM D MM BDY FLD JAM A4_2F 6628 134 MM D MM EJT VRT_NA JAM A
6191 131 MM D MM BDY FLD JAM LG_4F 6629 134 MM D MM EJT VRT_NA JAM B
6192 132 MM D MM WRAP IN JAM A4_3F 6630 134 MM D MM EJT VRT_NA JAM C
6193 132 MM D MM WRAP IN JAM B5_3F 6633 134 MM D MM GUDE BDY_S JAM A4
6194 132 MM D MM WRAP IN JAM LT_3F 6634 134 MM D MM GUDE BDY_S JAM B5
6195 132 MM D MM WRAP IN JAM A4_2F 6635 134 MM D MM GUDE BDY_S JAM LT
6196 132 MM D MM WRAP IN JAM LG_4F 6636 134 MM D MM GUDE BDY_S JAM LG
6197 132 MM D MM FLAP IN JAM ADJ A 6637 134 MM D MM GUDE FRM_S JAM A
6198 132 MM D MM FLAP IN JAM ADJ B 6638 134 MM D MM GUDE FRM_S JAM B
6199 132 MM D MM FLAP IN JAM ADJ C 6639 134 MM D MM GUDE FRM_S JAM C
6200 132 MM D MM GLUING JAM ADJ A 6641 134 MM D MM GUIDE_NA JAM ADJ
6201 132 MM D MM GLUING JAM ADJ B 6642 134 MM D MM FORM IN_NA JAM AJ
6202 132 MM D MM GLUING JAM ADJ C 6686 134 MM D MM FRM RT_NJAM
6203 132 MM D MM FLAP GLUING JAM A 6690 134 MM D MM GLUE_NA JAM ADJ
6204 132 MM D MM FLAP GLUING JAM B 6691 134 MM D MM CMP OUT_ST JAM A
6205 132 MM D MM FLAP GLUING JAM C 6692 134 MM D MM CMP OUT_ST JAM B
6207 132 MM D MM MID EXIT JAM ADJ 6693 134 MM D MM CMP OUT_ST JAM C
6208 132 MM D MM MID-E JM AJ A4_3F 6694 135 MM D MM FL GLUE_JAM A
6209 132 MM D MM MID-E JM AJ B5_3F 6695 135 MM D MM FRM HOL NA JAM AJ
6210 132 MM D MM MID-E JM AJ LT_3F 6696 135 MM D MM Int TampSenThreshold
6211 132 MM D MM MID-E JM AJ A4_2F 6697 135 MM D MM Int Tamp Sen ST JAM
6212 132 MM D MM MID-E JM AJ LG_4F 6698 135 MM D MM EJ-BLT INT (LOW)1
6214 132 MM D MM WRAP_NA JAM A 6699 135 MM D MM EJ-BLT INT (LOW)2
6216 132 MM D MM WRAP_NA JAM B 6700 48 CC D FD SPD(A3-STD) RIB
6217 132 MM D MM WRAP_NA JAM C 6701 48 CC D FD SPD(B4-STD) RIB
6223 132 MM D MM COMP OUT_NA JAM 6702 48 CC D FD SPD(A4-STD) RIB
6275 132 MM D MM WRAP_ST JAM A4_3F 6703 48 CC D FD SPD(B5-STD) RIB
6276 132 MM D MM WRAP_ST JAM B5_3F 6704 48 CC D FD SPD(A4R-STD) RIB
6277 132 MM D MM WRAP_ST JAM LT_3F 6705 48 CC D FD SPD(B5R-STD) RIB
6278 132 MM D MM WRAP_ST JAM A4_2F 6706 48 CC D FD SPD(A5-STD) RIB
6281 132 MM D MM WRAP_ST JAM LG_4F 6707 48 CC D FD SPD(B6-STD) RIB
6333 133 MM D MM EJCT_STAY JAM TIM 6708 48 CC D FD SPD(A5R-STD) RIB
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
6709 48 CC D FD SPD(A6-STD) RIB 6799 49 CC D TR3 P-PITCH(S-T-ST)
6710 48 CC D FD SPD(CTM-STD) RIB 6810 50 CC D P-PITCH(DPL-PCD)
6711 48 CC D FD SPD(A3-IJ) RIB 6811 50 CC D PFT P-PITCH(SPL-PCD)
6712 48 CC D FD SPD(B4-IJ) RIB 6830 50 CC D PFT P-PITCH(SPL-ENV)
6713 48 CC D FD SPD(A4-IJ) RIB 6850 50 CC D P-PITCH(D-U1-LG)
6714 48 CC D FD SPD(B5-IJ) RIB 6851 50 CC D P-PITCH(D-U1-ST)
6715 48 CC D FD SPD(A4R-IJ) RIB 6852 50 CC D PFT P-PITCH(S-U1-LG)
6716 48 CC D FD SPD(B5R-IJ) RIB 6853 50 CC D PFT P-PITCH(S-U1-ST)
6717 48 CC D FD SPD(A5-IJ) RIB 6854 50 CC D TR1 P-PITCH(S-U1-LG)
6718 48 CC D FD SPD(B6-IJ) RIB 6855 50 CC D TR1 P-PITCH(S-U1-ST)
6719 48 CC D FD SPD(A5R-IJ) RIB 6856 50 CC D TR2 P-PITCH(S-U1-LG)
6720 48 CC D FD SPD(A6-IJ) RIB 6857 50 CC D TR2 P-PITCH(S-U1-ST)
6721 48 CC D FD SPD(CTM-IJ) RIB 6858 50 CC D TR3 P-PITCH(S-U1-LG)
6722 48 CC D FD SPD(A3-STD) STOP 6859 50 CC D TR3 P-PITCH(S-U1-ST)
6723 48 CC D FD SPD(B4-STD) STOP 6870 50 CC D P-PITCH(D-U2-LG)
6724 48 CC D FD SPD(A4-STD) STOP 6871 50 CC D P-PITCH(D-U2-ST)
6725 48 CC D FD SPD(B5-STD) STOP 6872 50 CC D PFT P-PITCH(S-U2-LG)
6726 48 CC D FD SPD(A4R-STD) STOP 6873 50 CC D PFT P-PITCH(S-U2-ST)
6727 48 CC D FD SPD(B5R-STD) STOP 6874 50 CC D TR1 P-PITCH(S-U2-LG)
6728 48 CC D FD SPD(A5-STD) STOP 6875 50 CC D TR1 P-PITCH(S-U2-ST)
6729 48 CC D FD SPD(B6-STD) STOP 6876 50 CC D TR2 P-PITCH(S-U2-LG)
6730 48 CC D FD SPD(A5R-STD) STOP 6877 50 CC D TR2 P-PITCH(S-U2-ST)
6731 48 CC D FD SPD(A6-STD) STOP 6878 50 CC D TR3 P-PITCH(S-U2-LG)
6732 48 CC D FD SPD(CTM-STD) STOP 6879 50 CC D TR3 P-PITCH(S-U2-ST)
6733 48 CC D FD SPD(A3-IJ) STOP 6890 51 CC D P-PITCH(D-U3-LG)
6734 48 CC D FD SPD(B4-IJ) STOP 6891 51 CC D P-PITCH(D-U3-ST)
6735 48 CC D FD SPD(A4-IJ) STOP 6892 51 CC D PFT P-PITCH(S-U3-LG)
6736 48 CC D FD SPD(B5-IJ) STOP 6893 51 CC D PFT P-PITCH(S-U3-ST)
6737 48 CC D FD SPD(A4R-IJ) STOP 6894 51 CC D TR1 P-PITCH(S-U3-LG)
6738 48 CC D FD SPD(B5R-IJ) STOP 6895 51 CC D TR1 P-PITCH(S-U3-ST)
6739 48 CC D FD SPD(A5-IJ) STOP 6896 51 CC D TR2 P-PITCH(S-U3-LG)
6740 48 CC D FD SPD(B6-IJ) STOP 6897 51 CC D TR2 P-PITCH(S-U3-ST)
6741 48 CC D FD SPD(A5R-IJ) STOP 6898 51 CC D TR3 P-PITCH(S-U3-LG)
6742 48 CC D FD SPD(A6-IJ) STOP 6899 51 CC D TR3 P-PITCH(S-U3-ST)
6743 48 CC D FD SPD(CTM-IJ) STOP 6910 51 CC D P-PITCH(D-U4-LG)
6750 49 CC D P-PITCH(D-N-LG) 6911 51 CC D P-PITCH(D-U4-ST)
6751 49 CC D P-PITCH(D-N-ST) 6912 51 CC D PFT P-PITCH(S-U4-LG)
6752 49 CC D PFT P-PITCH(S-N-LG) 6913 51 CC D PFT P-PITCH(S-U4-ST)
6753 49 CC D PFT P-PITCH(S-N-ST) 6914 51 CC D TR1 P-PITCH(S-U4-LG)
6754 49 CC D TR1 P-PITCH(S-N-LG) 6915 51 CC D TR1 P-PITCH(S-U4-ST)
6755 49 CC D TR1 P-PITCH(S-N-ST) 6916 51 CC D TR2 P-PITCH(S-U4-LG)
6756 49 CC D TR2 P-PITCH(S-N-LG) 6917 51 CC D TR2 P-PITCH(S-U4-ST)
6757 49 CC D TR2 P-PITCH(S-N-ST) 6918 51 CC D TR3 P-PITCH(S-U4-LG)
6758 49 CC D TR3 P-PITCH(S-N-LG) 6919 51 CC D TR3 P-PITCH(S-U4-ST)
6759 49 CC D TR3 P-PITCH(S-N-ST) 6930 52 CC D P-PITCH(D-U5-LG)
6770 49 CC D P-PITCH(D-C-LG) 6931 52 CC D P-PITCH(D-U5-ST)
6771 49 CC D P-PITCH(D-C-ST) 6932 52 CC D PFT P-PITCH(S-U5-LG)
6772 49 CC D PFT P-PITCH(S-C-LG) 6933 52 CC D PFT P-PITCH(S-U5-ST)
6773 49 CC D PFT P-PITCH(S-C-ST) 6934 52 CC D TR1 P-PITCH(S-U5-LG)
6790 49 CC D P-PITCH(D-T-LG) 6935 52 CC D TR1 P-PITCH(S-U5-ST)
6791 49 CC D P-PITCH(D-T-ST) 6936 52 CC D TR2 P-PITCH(S-U5-LG)
6792 49 CC D PFT P-PITCH(S-T-LG) 6937 52 CC D TR2 P-PITCH(S-U5-ST)
6793 49 CC D PFT P-PITCH(S-T-ST) 6938 52 CC D TR3 P-PITCH(S-U5-LG)
6794 49 CC D TR1 P-PITCH(S-T-LG) 6939 52 CC D TR3 P-PITCH(S-U5-ST)
6795 49 CC D TR1 P-PITCH(S-T-ST) 6950 52 CC D P-PITCH(D-LWP-LG)
6796 49 CC D TR2 P-PITCH(S-T-LG) 6951 52 CC D P-PITCH(D-LWP-ST)
6797 49 CC D TR2 P-PITCH(S-T-ST) 6952 52 CC D PFT P-PITCH(S-LWP-LG)
6798 49 CC D TR3 P-PITCH(S-T-LG) 6953 52 CC D PFT P-PITCH(S-LWP-ST)
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
6954 52 CC D TR1 P-PITCH(S-LWP-LG) 7051 116 PB S PB BOOKLET FEED PULS SEN
6955 52 CC D TR1 P-PITCH(S-LWP-ST) 7052 116 PB S PB GUIDE SELECT OPEN SEN
6956 52 CC D TR2 P-PITCH(S-LWP-LG) 7053 116 PB S PB GUIDE SELECT CLOSE SEN
6957 52 CC D TR2 P-PITCH(S-LWP-ST) 7200 117 PB M PB PAPER FEED MOT1(NORMAL)
6958 52 CC D TR3 P-PITCH(S-LWP-LG) 7201 117 PB M PB PAPER FEED MOT1(REV)
6959 52 CC D TR3 P-PITCH(S-LWP-ST) 7202 117 PB M PB PAPER FEED MOT2(NORMAL)
6960 52 CC D FO SPD(A3 LWP)STOP 7203 117 PB M PB PAPER FEED MOT2(REV)
6961 52 CC D FO SPD(B4 LWP)STOP 7204 117 PB M PB RIGHT DOOR RELEASE SOL
6962 52 CC D FO SPD(A4 LWP)STOP 7205 117 PB M PB GLUE AMOUNT CHECK FAN
6963 52 CC D FO SPD(B5 LWP)STOP 7206 117 PB M PB BOOKLET EXIT1 MOT (NOR)
6964 52 CC D FO SP(A4R LWP)STOP 7207 117 PB M PB BOOKLET EXIT1 MOT (RVS)
6965 52 CC D FO SP(B5R LWP)STOP 7208 117 PB M PB BOOKLET EXIT2 MOT (NOR)
7001 116 PB S PB P-FEED COVER LENGTH SEN 7209 117 PB M PB BOOKLET EXIT2 MOT (RVS)
7002 116 PB S PB PAPER FEED CHECK SEN 7210 117 PB M PB EXHAUST FAN
7003 116 PB S PB BODY BLOCK EXIT SENSOR 7211 117 PB M PB COVER FEED MOT (NORMAL)
7004 116 PB S PB COVER REGISTRATION SEN 7212 117 PB M PB COVER FEED MOT (REVERS)
7005 116 PB S PB COVER CUT LENGTH SENSOR 7213 117 PB M PB COVER SUCTION FAN
7006 116 PB S PB COVER POSITION SENSOR 7214 117 PB M PB COVER SEPARATOR FAN
7007 116 PB S PB COVER DUST TRAY DET SEN 7215 117 PB M PB PAPER SEPARATION SOL
7008 116 PB S PB BOOK BLOCK DET SEN 7216 117 PB M PB COVER SEPARATION SOL
7009 116 PB S PB VERTICAL GUIDE HP SEN 7217 117 PB M PB COVER RESIST SOLENOID
7010 116 PB S PB FORE EDGE HP SEN 7218 117 PB M PB PRES-ROLLER SOLENOID
7011 116 PB S PB BODY TEXT JAM SENSOR 7220 117 PB M PB SUCTION CONTROL SOL
7012 116 PB S PB CLAMP UP/LOW HP SEN 7221 117 PB M PB P-FEED DRIVE CLUTCH
7013 116 PB S PB CLAMP UP/LOW INSERT SEN 7227 117 PB M PB BOOKLET EJECTION SOL
7014 116 PB S PB CLAMP BOOK BLK DET SEN 7228 117 PB M PB FRONT COVER RELEASE SOL
7015 116 PB S PB CLAMP OPEN SENSOR 7400 117 PB U PB GLUE SHEET FEED(NORMAL)
7016 116 PB S PB CLAMP CLOSE SENSOR 7401 117 PB U PB GLUE SHEET FEED(REVERS)
7017 116 PB S PB CLAMP HORIZONTAL HP SEN 7404 117 PB U PB BOOK BLOCK THICK CHECK
7018 116 PB S PB CLAMP HORZON P-FEED SEN 7405 117 PB U PB VERTICL G-PLATE SET POS
7019 116 PB S PB GLUE ROL BACKLASH SEN 7406 117 PB U PB VERTICL G-PLTE TAMP POS
7020 116 PB S PB GLUE SHEET FEED SEN 7407 117 PB U PB VERTICAL G-PLATE HP POS
7021 116 PB S PB GLUE SHEET CUT SENSOR 7408 117 PB U PB FORE-ED G-PLATE SET POS
7022 116 PB S PB FORMING COVER DET SEN 7409 117 PB U PB FORE-ED G-PLATE TAMP POS
7023 116 PB S PB COVER GUIDE HP SENSOR 7410 117 PB U PB FORE-ED G-PLATE HP POS
7024 116 PB S PB FORMING PLATE OP SEN 7411 117 PB U PB FORE EDGE PLATE REL POS
7025 116 PB S PB FORMING PLATE CL SEN 7412 117 PB U PB FORE EDGE PLATE HP POS
7026 116 PB S PB BOOKLET EXIT SENSOR 7413 117 PB U PB CLAMP MOVEMENT
7027 116 PB S PB BOOKLET GUIDE SENSOR 7414 118 PB U PB CLAMP INSTERT POS MOV
7028 116 PB S PB BOOKLET EXIT POS1 SEN 7415 118 PB U PB CLAMP HP POS MOV
7029 116 PB S PB BOOKLET EXIT POS2 SEN 7416 118 PB U PB CLAMP GLUE POS MOV
7030 116 PB S PB FORE EDGE HP POS CHECK 7417 118 PB U PB CLAMP NIPPING POS MOV
7031 116 PB S PB FORE EG RELSE POS CHECK 7418 118 PB U PB CLAMP INSERT HOLIZ POS
7032 116 PB S PB BLIND PLATE OP SENSOR 7419 118 PB U PB CLAMP HOLIZ HP POS
7033 116 PB S PB BLIND PLATE CL SENSOR 7420 118 PB U PB CLAMP HOLIZ GLUE POS
7034 116 PB S PB COVER CUT HP SENSOR 7421 118 PB U PB CLAMP HOLIZ NIP POS
7035 116 PB S PB COVER CUT LIMIT SENSOR 7422 118 PB U PB GLUE SHEET UNIT RELEASE
7036 116 PB S PB FRONT DOOR SW 7423 118 PB U PB GLUE SHEET UNIT PRES
7037 116 PB S PB RIGHT DOOR SW 7425 118 PB U PB NIPPING PLATE OPEN
7038 116 PB S PB UPPER COVER SW 7426 118 PB U PB NIPPING PLATE CLOSE
7039 116 PB S PB COVER DETECTION SENSOR 7427 118 PB U PB COVER G-PLATE TAMP POS
7040 116 PB S PB COVER TOP FACE SENSOR 7428 118 PB U PB COVER G-PLATE HP MOV
7042 116 PB S PB COVER FEED SENSOR 7430 118 PB U PB GLUE POS TILT ADG
7043 116 PB S PB COVER PASS SENSOR 7431 118 PB U PB GLUE POS TILT CHECK MOV
7044 116 PB S PB COVER SIZE 1 SENSOR 7432 118 PB U PB NIPPING POS TILT ADG
7045 116 PB S PB COVER SIZE 2 SENSOR 7433 118 PB U PB NIP POS TILT CHECK MOV
7047 116 PB S PB LIFT UP L-LIMIT SENSOR 7435 118 PB U PB COVER CUT DRIVE
7050 116 PB S PB BOOKLET JAM DET SEN 7436 118 PB U PB COVER CUT ADJ(INTERPOS)
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
7438 118 PB U PB GLUE ROLLER MOTOR 7648 121 PB D PB GLUE LEFT ADJ8
7439 118 PB U PB HALOGEN HEATER 7649 121 PB D PB GLUE LEFT ADJ9
7440 118 PB U PB SHEATH HEATER 7650 121 PB D PB GLUE LEFT ADJ10
7441 118 PB U PB GLUE CUT HEATER 7651 121 PB D PB HEAD EDGE HP ADJ
7442 118 PB U PB CLAMP HRZL EXIT POS MOV 7652 121 PB D PB COVER CUT-P ADJ
7443 118 PB U PB CLAMP HRZL BLADE POS 7664 122 PB D PB PAPER SPEED (632)
7444 118 PB U PB COVER LIFT UP 7665 122 PB D PB PAPER SPEED (535)
7445 119 PB U PB COVER LIFT DOWN 7666 122 PB D PB PAPER SPEED (464)
7446 119 PB U PB GLEU BLADE CHECK 1 7667 122 PB D PB PAPER SPEED (316)
7447 119 PB U PB GLEU BLADE CHECK 2 7668 122 PB D PB COVER-L RESL (IP)
7448 119 PB U PB BODY TEXT STACK POS CHK 7669 122 PB D PB BDY STCK SIZE SET
7449 119 PB U PB COVER NIP POS TRNS(CUT) 7670 122 PB D PB BDY STCK QTY SET
7450 119 PB U PB BODY CLAMP RANGE CHECK 7671 122 PB D PB TEST PRT BDY SIZE
7451 119 PB U PB GLUEING POS CHECK 7672 122 PB D PB TEST PRNT BDY QTY
7452 119 PB U PB NIPPING POS CHECK 7673 122 PB D PB TEST PRT COVR LNG
7453 119 PB U PB GUIDE PLATE OPEN POS 7674 122 PB D PB COVR PRT TRY SEL
7454 119 PB U PB GUIDE PLATE CLOSE POS 7675 106 HCF D HCAP-F BKL (STD-L)
7455 119 PB U PB TEST PRINT 7676 106 HCF D HCAP-F BKL (STD-S)
7456 119 PB U PB BLIND PLATE OPEN POS 7677 106 HCF D HCAP-F BUCKEL(THN-L)
7457 119 PB U PB BLIND PLATE CLOSE POS 7678 106 HCF D HCAP-F BUCKEL(THN-S)
7458 119 PB U PB CLAMP OPEN POS MOV 7700 53 CC D PFT UP LMT POS (STD)
7459 119 PB U PB CLAMP CLOSE POS MOV 7701 53 CC D PFT P-BUCKLE (STD)
7460 119 PB U PB Guide Select Raised Position Move 7702 53 CC D PFT P-F TIMING (STD)
7501 120 PB I PB COUNT 4 CLEAR 7703 53 CC D PFT AST ON/OFF (STD)
7602 120 PB C PB TOTAL BOOKLET COUNT 7704 53 CC D PFT AST START (STD)
7603 120 PB C PB TOTAL PRINT COUNT 7705 53 CC D PFT AST END (STD)
7604 120 PB C PB GLUE U-LIMIT TMP DET 7706 53 CC D TR1 LONG-P BKL (STD)
7605 120 PB C PB GLUE L-LIMIT TMP DET 7707 53 CC D TRAY1 P-F TMG (STD)
7606 120 PB C PB GLUE ROLLER TMP DET 7708 53 CC D TR1 AST ON/OFF (STD)
7607 120 PB C PB MELT TANK TEM DISPLAY 7709 53 CC D TR1 AST START (STD)
7608 120 PB C PB B-BLOCK THCNES DISP(0.1MM) 7710 53 CC D TR1 AST END (STD)
7609 120 PB C PB B-BLOCK THCNES DISP(PA) 7711 53 CC D TR2 LONG-P BKL (STD)
7610 120 PB C PB COVER LENGTH DISP(0.1MM) 7712 53 CC D TRAY2 P-F TMG (STD)
7611 120 PB C PB COVER LENGTH DISP(PA) 7713 53 CC D TR2 AST ON/OFF (STD)
7612 120 PB C PB FIRMWARE VERSION 7714 53 CC D TR2 AST START (STD)
7613 120 PB C PB LOADER VERSION 7715 53 CC D TR2 AST END (STD)
7614 120 PB C PB COVER INSERT COUNT 7716 53 CC D TR3 LONG-P BKL (STD)
7616 121 PB D PB COOL DOWN START 7717 53 CC D TRAY3 P-F TMG (STD)
7618 121 PB D PB CLMP B-BLK HRZL 7718 53 CC D TR3 AST ON/OFF (STD)
7619 121 PB D PB CLMP GLUE HRZL 7719 53 CC D TR3 AST START (STD)
7620 121 PB D PB CLUMP BLADE HRZL 7720 53 CC D TR3 AST END (STD)
7621 121 PB D PB CLUMP SHAPE HRZL 7721 53 CC D RE-FEED P-BKL (STD)
7623 121 PB D PB CLMP B-BLK HEIGHT 7722 106 HCF D HCAP-F UP LMT PO
7624 121 PB D PB CLMP GLUE HEIGHT 7724 106 HCF D HCAP-F P STRT (STD)
7625 121 PB D PB CLMP BLADE HEIGHT 7725 106 HCF D HCAP-F AST SET (STD)
7626 121 PB D PB CLMP SHAPE HEIGHT 7726 106 HCF D HCAP-F AST STRT(STD)
7627 121 PB D PB COVER LENGTH RESL 7727 106 HCF D HCAP-F AST END (STD)
7628 121 PB D PB COVER SHAPE ADJ 7728 53 CC D FD EJECT SPD ADJ NOR
7629 121 PB D PB P-PITCH SET A4/LT 7729 53 CC D RE-FD ARV TMG(N-LG)
7630 121 PB D PB P-PITCH SET B5 7730 53 CC D BELT SPD RATIO (STD)
7631 121 PB D PB P-PITCH SET A5 7731 53 CC D HEAD GAP (STD)
7641 121 PB D PB GLUE LEFT ADJ1 7732 53 CC D VERTICAL POS 1 (STD)
7642 121 PB D PB GLUE LEFT ADJ2 7733 53 CC D VERTICAL POS 2 (STD)
7643 121 PB D PB GLUE LEFT ADJ3 7734 53 CC D CIS S-MASK MODE(STD)
7644 121 PB D PB GLUE LEFT ADJ4 7735 53 CC D FD S-FNC OFFST (STD)
7645 121 PB D PB GLUE LEFT ADJ5 7736 53 CC D RE-FD ARV TMG(N-ST)
7646 121 PB D PB GLUE LEFT ADJ6 7737 53 CC D WING OFFSET (STD)
7647 121 PB D PB GLUE LEFT ADJ7 7738 53 CC D FU EJ ROLL SPD (STD)
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
7739 53 CC D AS S-FNC OFFST (STD) 7817 106 HCF D HCAP-F AST SET (THN)
7740 53 CC D AS E-FNC OFFST (STD) 7818 106 HCF D HCAP-F AST STRT(THN)
7741 54 CC D ENV FLAP MARGN (STD) 7819 106 HCF D HCAP-F AST END (THN)
7743 54 CC D TR1 SHRT-P BKL (STD) 7820 55 CC D FD EJECT SPD ADJ THN
7744 54 CC D TR2 SHRT-P BKL (STD) 7821 55 CC D RE-FD ARV TMG(T-LG)
7745 54 CC D TR3 SHRT-P BKL (STD) 7822 55 CC D BELT SPD RATIO (THN)
7746 54 CC D PFT UP LMT POS (CRD) 7823 55 CC D HEAD GAP (THN)
7747 54 CC D PFT P-BUCKLE (CRD) 7824 55 CC D VERTICAL POS 1 (THN)
7748 54 CC D PFT P-F TIMING (CRD) 7825 55 CC D VERTICAL POS 2 (THN)
7749 54 CC D PFT AST ON/OFF (CRD) 7826 55 CC D CIS S-MASK MODE(THN)
7750 54 CC D PFT AST START (CRD) 7827 55 CC D FD S-FNC OFFST (THN)
7751 54 CC D PFT AST END (CRD) 7828 55 CC D RE-FD ARV TMG(T-ST)
7752 54 CC D RE-FD ARV TMG(C-LG) 7829 55 CC D WING OFFSET (THN)
7753 54 CC D RE-FD ARV TMG(C-ST) 7830 55 CC D FU EJ ROLL SPD (THN)
7754 106 HCF D HCAP-F BUCKEL(CRD-L) 7831 55 CC D AS S-FNC OFFST (THN)
7755 106 HCF D HCAP-F BUCKEL(CRD-S) 7832 55 CC D AS E-FNC OFFST (THN)
7767 54 CC D RE-FEED P-BKL (CRD) 7833 55 CC D ENV FLAP MARGN (THN)
7768 106 HCF D HCAP-F UP POS (CRD) 7835 56 CC D TR1 SHRT-P BKL (THN)
7770 106 HCF D HCAP-F P STRT (CRD) 7836 56 CC D TR2 SHRT-P BKL (THN)
7771 106 HCF D HCAP-F AST SET (CRD) 7837 56 CC D TR3 SHRT-P BKL (THN)
7772 106 HCF D HCAP-F AST STRT(CRD) 7838 56 CC D PFT UP LMT POS (PCD)
7773 106 HCF D HCAP-F AST END (CRD) 7839 56 CC D PFT P-BUCKLE (PCD)
7774 54 CC D FD EJECT SPD ADJ THK 7840 56 CC D PFT P-F TIMING (PCD)
7776 54 CC D BELT SPD RATIO (CRD) 7841 56 CC D PFT AST ON/OFF (PCD)
7777 54 CC D HEAD GAP (CRD) 7842 56 CC D PFT AST START (PCD)
7778 54 CC D VERTICAL POS 1 (CRD) 7843 56 CC D PFT AST END (PCD)
7779 54 CC D VERTICAL POS 2 (CRD) 7844 56 CC D RE-FD ARV TMG(PCD)
7780 54 CC D CIS S-MASK MODE(CRD) 7859 56 CC D RE-FEED P-BKL (PCD)
7781 54 CC D FD S-FNC OFFST (CRD) 7860 106 HCF D HCAP-F UP LIMT (PCD)
7783 54 CC D WING OFFSET (CRD) 7861 106 HCF D HCAP-F BUCKEL (PCD)
7784 54 CC D FU EJ ROLL SPD (CRD) 7862 106 HCF D HCAP-F P START (PCD)
7785 54 CC D AS S-FNC OFFST (CRD) 7863 106 HCF D HCAP-F AST SET (PCD)
7786 54 CC D AS E-FNC OFFST (CRD) 7864 106 HCF D HCAP-F AST STRT(PCD)
7787 54 CC D ENV FLAP MARGN (CRD) 7865 106 HCF D HCAP-F AST END (PCD)
7792 54 CC D PFT UP LMT POS (THN) 7866 56 CC D FD EJECT SPD ADJ PST
7793 54 CC D PFT P-BUCKLE (THN) 7868 56 CC D BELT SPD RATIO (PCD)
7794 54 CC D PFT P-F TIMING (THN) 7869 56 CC D HEAD GAP (PCD)
7795 55 CC D PFT AST ON/OFF (THN) 7870 56 CC D VERTICAL POS 1 (PCD)
7796 55 CC D PFT AST START (THN) 7871 56 CC D VERTICAL POS 2 (PCD)
7797 55 CC D PFT AST END (THN) 7872 56 CC D CIS S-MASK MODE(PCD)
7798 55 CC D TR1 LONG-P BKL (THN) 7873 56 CC D FD S-FNC OFFST (PCD)
7799 55 CC D TRAY1 P-F TMG (THN) 7875 56 CC D WING OFFSET (PCD)
7800 55 CC D TR1 AST ON/OFF (THN) 7876 56 CC D FU EJ ROLL SPD (PCD)
7801 55 CC D TR1 AST START (THN) 7877 56 CC D AS S-FNC OFFST (PCD)
7802 55 CC D TR1 AST END (THN) 7878 56 CC D AS E-FNC OFFST (PCD)
7803 55 CC D TR2 LONG-P BKL (THN) 7879 56 CC D ENV FLAP MARGN (PCD)
7804 55 CC D TRAY2 P-F TMG (THN) 7884 56 CC D PFT UP LMT POS (ENV)
7805 55 CC D TR2 AST ON/OFF (THN) 7885 56 CC D PFT P-BUCKLE (ENV)
7806 55 CC D TR2 AST START (THN) 7886 56 CC D PFT P-F TIMING (ENV)
7807 55 CC D TR2 AST END (THN) 7887 56 CC D PFT AST ON/OFF (ENV)
7808 55 CC D TR3 LONG-P BKL (THN) 7888 56 CC D PFT AST START (ENV)
7809 55 CC D TRAY3 P-F TMG (THN) 7889 56 CC D PFT AST END (ENV)
7810 55 CC D TR3 AST ON/OFF (THN) 7900 107 HCF D HCAP-F BUCKEL(ENV-L)
7811 55 CC D TR3 AST START (THN) 7901 107 HCF D HCAP-F BUCKEL(ENV-S)
7812 55 CC D TR3 AST END (THN) 7905 57 CC D RE-FEED P-BKL (ENV)
7813 55 CC D RE-FEED P-BKL (THN) 7906 107 HCF D HCAP-F UP LIMT (ENV)
7814 106 HCF D HCAP-F UP POS (THN) 7908 107 HCF D HCAP-F P START (ENV)
7816 106 HCF D HCAP-F P STRT (THN) 7909 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST SET (ENV)
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
7910 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST STRT(ENV) 8642 32 CC C TAG SER. 1 R FINAL
7911 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST SET (ENV) 8643 32 CC C TAG SER. 2 L FINAL
7912 57 CC D FD EJECT SPD ADJ ENV 8644 32 CC C TAG SER. 2 R FINAL
7914 57 CC D BELT SPD RATIO (ENV) 8645 32 CC C TAG SER. 3 L FINAL
7915 57 CC D HEAD GAP (ENV) 8646 32 CC C TAG SER. 3 R FINAL
7916 57 CC D VERTICAL POS 1 (ENV) 8647 32 CC C TAG SER. 4 L FINAL
7917 57 CC D VERTICAL POS 2 (ENV) 8648 32 CC C TAG SER. 4 R FINAL
7919 57 CC D FD S-FNC OFFST (ENV) 8649 32 CC C TAG SER. 5 L FINAL
7921 57 CC D WING OFFSET (ENV) 8650 32 CC C TAG SER. 5 R FINAL
7922 57 CC D FU EJ ROLL SPD (ENV) 8655 32 CC C TEMP REG OP TM - MC
7923 57 CC D AS S-FNC OFFST (ENV) 8656 32 CC C TEMP REG OP TM - CD1
7924 57 CC D AS E-FNC OFFST (ENV) 8657 32 CC C TEMP REG OP TM - CD2
7925 57 CC D ENV FLAP MARGN (ENV) 8658 32 CC C TEMP REG OP TM - CD3
7926 57 CC D BELT FAN SET(ENV 1) 8659 32 CC C TEMP REG OP TM - CD4
7927 57 CC D BELT FAN SET(ENV 2) 8660 32 CC C TEMP REG OP TM - CD5
7950 122 PB D PB EDGE TRIM POS 9600 107 HCF D HCAP-F BUCKEL (U1-L)
7954 122 PB D PB EDGE TRIM POS 9601 107 HCF D HCAP-F BUCKEL (U1-S)
7958 122 PB D PB COVR TRIM POS 9602 107 HCF D HCAP-F BUCKEL (U2-L)
7962 122 PB D PB CLAMP PALS VALUE1 9603 107 HCF D HCAP-F BUCKEL (U2-S)
7963 122 PB D PB CLAMP PALS VALUE2 9604 107 HCF D HCAP-F BUCKEL (U3-L)
7964 122 PB D PB B/L GUIDE ROTATN 9605 107 HCF D HCAP-F BUCKEL (U3-S)
7965 122 PB D PB EG TRIM OP(A4/LT) 9606 107 HCF D HCAP-F BUCKEL (U4-L)
7966 122 PB D PB EG TRIM OP(A5/B5) 9607 107 HCF D HCAP-F BUCKEL (U4-S)
7967 122 PB D PB EG TRIM CL(A4/LT) 9608 107 HCF D HCAP-F BUCKEL (U4-L)
7968 122 PB D PB EDGE TRIM CL(A5) 9609 107 HCF D HCAP-F BUCKEL (U4-S)
7969 122 PB D PB EDGE TRIM CL(B5) 9700 58 CC D PFT UP LMT POS (U1)
7970 122 PB D PB CLMP BLD HFT ADJ 1 9701 58 CC D PFT P-BUCKLE (U1)
7971 122 PB D PB CLMP BLD HFT ADJ 2 9702 58 CC D PFT P-F TIMING (U1)
7972 122 PB D PB CLMP BLD HFT ADJ 3 9703 58 CC D PFT AST ON/OFF (U1)
7973 122 PB D PB CLMP BLD HFT ADJ 4 9704 58 CC D PFT AST START (U1)
7974 122 PB D PB CLMP BLD HFT ADJ 5 9705 58 CC D PFT AST END (U1)
8000 13 CC S RFID-RUN-C SIGNAL 9706 58 CC D TR1 LONG-P BKL (U1)
8001 13 CC S RFID-RUN-K SIGNAL 9707 58 CC D TRAY1 P-F TMG (U1)
8002 13 CC S RFID-RUN-M SIGNAL 9708 58 CC D TR1 AST ON/OFF (U1)
8003 13 CC S RFID-RUN-Y SIGNAL 9709 58 CC D TR1 AST START (U1)
8004 13 CC S RFID-RUN-MACHIN CODE 9710 58 CC D TR1 AST END (U1)
8400 24 CC U MC FINAL REGISTERING 9711 58 CC D TR2 LONG-P BKL (U1)
8401 24 CC U M/C CARD DATA INPUT 9712 58 CC D TRAY2 P-F TMG (U1)
8611 32 CC C INK VOLUME DISPLAY C 9713 58 CC D TR2 AST ON/OFF (U1)
8612 32 CC C INK VOLUME DISPLAY M 9714 58 CC D TR2 AST START (U1)
8613 32 CC C INK VOLUME DISPLAY Y 9715 58 CC D TR2 AST END (U1)
8614 32 CC C INK VOLUME DISPLAY K 9716 58 CC D TR3 LONG-P BKL (U1)
8620 32 CC C MACHINE RGSTR CONDTN 9717 58 CC D TRAY3 P-F TMG (U1)
8624 32 CC C MACHINE OPERATION ID 9718 58 CC D TR3 AST ON/OFF (U1)
8628 32 CC C M/C CARD CONDITION 9719 58 CC D TR3 AST START (U1)
8629 32 CC C MACHINE ID 9720 58 CC D TR3 AST END (U1)
8630 32 CC C MACHINE ACTION ID 9721 58 CC D RE-FEED P-BKL (U1)
8631 32 CC C TAG SER. 1 L INTERIM 9722 107 HCF D HCAP-F UP LIM (U1)
8632 32 CC C TAG SER. 1 R INTERIM 9724 107 HCF D HCAP-F P START (U1)
8633 32 CC C TAG SER. 2 L INTERIM 9725 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST SET (U1)
8634 32 CC C TAG SER. 2 R INTERIM 9726 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST STRT(U1)
8635 32 CC C TAG SER. 3 L INTERIM 9727 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST END (U1)
8636 32 CC C TAG SER. 3 R INTERIM 9728 58 CC D FD EJECT SPD ADJ U1
8637 32 CC C TAG SER. 4 L INTERIM 9729 59 CC D RE-FD ARV TMG(U1-LG)
8638 32 CC C TAG SER. 4 R INTERIM 9730 59 CC D BELT SPD RATIO (U1)
8639 32 CC C TAG SER. 5 L INTERIM 9731 59 CC D HEAD GAP (U1)
8640 32 CC C TAG SER. 5 R INTERIM 9732 59 CC D VERTICAL POS 1 (U1)
8641 32 CC C TAG SER. 1 L INTERIM 9733 59 CC D VERTICAL POS 2 (U1)
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
9734 59 CC D CIS S-MASK MODE(U1) 9793 58 CC D PFT P-BUCKLE (U3)
9735 59 CC D FD S-FNC OFFST (U1) 9794 58 CC D PFT P-F TIMING (U3)
9736 59 CC D FD E-ROLL SPEED (U1) 9795 58 CC D PFT AST ON/OFF (U3)
9737 59 CC D WING OFFSET (U1) 9796 58 CC D PFT AST START (U3)
9738 59 CC D FU EJ ROLL SPD (U1) 9797 58 CC D PFT AST END (U3)
9739 59 CC D AS S-FNC OFFST (U1) 9798 58 CC D TR1 LONG-P BKL (U3)
9740 59 CC D AS E-FNC OFFST (U1) 9799 58 CC D TRAY1 P-F TMG (U3)
9741 59 CC D ENV FLAP MARGN (U1) 9800 58 CC D TR1 AST ON/OFF (U3)
9742 59 CC D RE-FD ARV TMG(U1-ST) 9801 58 CC D TR1 AST START (U3)
9743 59 CC D TR1 SHRT-P BKL (U1) 9802 58 CC D TR1 AST END (U3)
9744 59 CC D TR2 SHRT-P BKL (U1) 9803 58 CC D TR2 LONG-P BKL (U3)
9745 59 CC D TR3 SHRT-P BKL (U1) 9804 58 CC D TRAY2 P-F TMG (U3)
9746 58 CC D PFT UP LMT POS (U2) 9805 58 CC D TR2 AST ON/OFF (U3)
9747 58 CC D PFT P-BUCKLE (U2) 9806 58 CC D TR2 AST START (U3)
9748 58 CC D PFT P-F TIMING (U2) 9807 58 CC D TR2 AST END (U3)
9749 58 CC D PFT AST ON/OFF (U2) 9808 58 CC D TR3 LONG-P BKL (U3)
9750 58 CC D PFT AST START (U2) 9809 58 CC D TRAY3 P-F TMG (U3)
9751 58 CC D PFT AST END (U2) 9810 58 CC D TR3 AST ON/OFF (U3)
9752 58 CC D TR1 LONG-P BKL (U2) 9811 58 CC D TR3 AST START (U3)
9753 58 CC D TRAY1 P-F TMG (U2) 9812 58 CC D TR3 AST END (U3)
9754 58 CC D TR1 AST ON/OFF (U2) 9813 58 CC D RE-FEED P-BKL (U3)
9755 58 CC D TR1 AST START (U2) 9814 107 HCF D HCAP-F UP LIMT (U3)
9756 58 CC D TR1 AST END (U2) 9816 107 HCF D HCAP-F P START (U3)
9757 58 CC D TR2 LONG-P BKL (U2) 9817 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST SET (U3)
9758 58 CC D TRAY2 P-F TMG (U2) 9818 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST STRT (U3)
9759 58 CC D TR2 AST ON/OFF (U2) 9819 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST END (U3)
9760 58 CC D TR2 AST START (U2) 9820 58 CC D FD EJECT SPD ADJ U3
9761 58 CC D TR2 AST END (U2) 9821 59 CC D RE-FD ARV TMG(U3-LG)
9762 58 CC D TR3 LONG-P BKL (U2) 9822 59 CC D BELT SPD RATIO (U3)
9763 58 CC D TRAY3 P-F TMG (U2) 9823 59 CC D HEAD GAP (U3)
9764 58 CC D TR3 AST ON/OFF (U2) 9824 59 CC D VERTICAL POS 1 (U3)
9765 58 CC D TR3 AST START (U2) 9825 59 CC D VERTICAL POS 2 (U3)
9766 58 CC D TR3 AST END (U2) 9826 59 CC D CIS S-MASK MODE(U3)
9767 58 CC D RE-FEED P-BKL (U2) 9827 59 CC D FD S-FNC OFFST (U3)
9768 107 HCF D HCAP-F UP LIM (U2) 9828 59 CC D FD E-ROLL SPEED (U3)
9770 107 HCF D HCAP-F P START (U2) 9829 59 CC D WING OFFSET (U3)
9771 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST SET (U2) 9830 59 CC D FU EJ ROLL SPD (U3)
9772 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST STRT (U2) 9831 59 CC D AS S-FNC OFFST (U3)
9773 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST END (U2) 9832 59 CC D AS E-FNC OFFST (U3)
9774 58 CC D FD EJECT SPD ADJ U2 9833 59 CC D ENV FLAP MARGN (U3)
9775 59 CC D RE-FD ARV TMG(U2-LG) 9834 59 CC D RE-FD ARV TMG(U3-ST)
9776 59 CC D BELT SPD RATIO (U2) 9835 59 CC D TR1 SHRT-P BKL (U3)
9777 59 CC D HEAD GAP (U2) 9836 59 CC D TR2 SHRT-P BKL (U3)
9778 59 CC D VERTICAL POS 1 (U2) 9837 59 CC D TR3 SHRT-P BKL (U3)
9779 59 CC D VERTICAL POS 2 (U2) 9838 58 CC D PFT UP LMT POS (U4)
9780 59 CC D CIS S-MASK MODE(U2) 9839 58 CC D PFT P-BUCKLE (U4)
9781 59 CC D FD S-FNC OFFST (U2) 9840 58 CC D PFT P-F TIMING (U4)
9782 59 CC D FD E-ROLL SPEED (U2) 9841 58 CC D PFT AST ON/OFF (U4)
9783 59 CC D WING OFFSET (U2) 9842 58 CC D PFT AST START (U4)
9784 59 CC D FU EJ ROLL SPD (U2) 9843 58 CC D PFT AST END (U4)
9785 59 CC D AS S-FNC OFFST (U2) 9844 58 CC D TR1 LONG-P BKL (U4)
9786 59 CC D AS E-FNC OFFST (U2) 9845 58 CC D TRAY1 P-F TMG (U4)
9787 59 CC D ENV FLAP MARGN (U2) 9846 58 CC D TR1 AST ON/OFF (U4)
9788 59 CC D RE-FD ARV TMG(U2-ST) 9847 58 CC D TR1 AST START (U4)
9789 59 CC D TR1 SHRT-P BKL (U2) 9848 58 CC D TR1 AST END (U4)
9790 59 CC D TR2 SHRT-P BKL (U2) 9849 58 CC D TR2 LONG-P BKL (U4)
9791 59 CC D TR3 SHRT-P BKL (U2) 9850 58 CC D TRAY2 P-F TMG (U4)
9792 58 CC D PFT UP LMT POS (U3) 9851 58 CC D TR2 AST ON/OFF (U4)
TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel) TM P Unit Cat TM Name (On the Panel)
9852 58 CC D TR2 AST START (U4) 9912 58 CC D FD EJECT SPD ADJ U5
9853 58 CC D TR2 AST END (U4) 9913 59 CC D RE-FD ARV TMG(U5-LG)
9854 58 CC D TR3 LONG-P BKL (U4) 9914 59 CC D BELT SPD RATIO (U5)
9855 58 CC D TRAY3 P-F TMG (U4) 9915 59 CC D HEAD GAP (U5)
9856 58 CC D TR3 AST ON/OFF (U4) 9916 59 CC D VERTICAL POS 1 (U5)
9857 58 CC D TR3 AST START (U4) 9917 59 CC D VERTICAL POS 2 (U5)
9858 58 CC D TR3 AST END (U4) 9918 59 CC D CIS S-MASK MODE(U5)
9859 58 CC D RE-FEED P-BKL (U4) 9919 59 CC D FD S-FNC OFFST (U5)
9860 107 HCF D HCAP-F UP LIMT (U4) 9920 59 CC D FD E-ROLL SPEED (U5)
9862 107 HCF D HCAP-F P START (U4) 9921 59 CC D WING OFFSET (U5)
9863 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST SET (U4) 9922 59 CC D FU EJ ROLL SPD (U5)
9864 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST STRT (U4) 9923 59 CC D AS S-FNC OFFST (U5)
9865 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST END (U4) 9924 59 CC D AS E-FNC OFFST (U5)
9866 58 CC D FD EJECT SPD ADJ U4 9925 59 CC D ENV FLAP MARGN (U5)
9867 59 CC D RE-FD ARV TMG(U4-LG) 9926 59 CC D RE-FD ARV TMG(U5-ST)
9868 59 CC D BELT SPD RATIO (U4) 9927 59 CC D TR1 SHRT-P BKL (U5)
9869 59 CC D HEAD GAP (U4) 9928 59 CC D TR2 SHRT-P BKL (U5)
9870 59 CC D VERTICAL POS 1 (U4) 9929 59 CC D TR3 SHRT-P BKL (U5)
9871 59 CC D VERTICAL POS 2 (U4) 9931 58 CC D PFT UP LMT POS(LWP)
9872 59 CC D CIS S-MASK MODE(U4) 9932 58 CC D TR1 SHRT-P BKL(LWP)
9873 59 CC D FD S-FNC OFFST (U4) 9933 58 CC D PFT P-F TIMING(LWP)
9874 59 CC D FD E-ROLL SPEED (U4) 9934 58 CC D PFT AST ON/OFF (LWP)
9875 59 CC D WING OFFSET (U4) 9935 58 CC D PFT AST START (LWP)
9876 59 CC D FU EJ ROLL SPD (U4) 9936 58 CC D PFT AST END(LWP)
9877 59 CC D AS S-FNC OFFST (U4) 9937 58 CC D TR1 LONG-P BKL (LWP)
9878 59 CC D AS E-FNC OFFST (U4) 9938 58 CC D TRAY1 P-F TMG (LWP)
9879 59 CC D ENV FLAP MARGN (U4) 9939 58 CC D TR1 AST ON/OFF (LWP)
9880 59 CC D RE-FD ARV TMG(U4-ST) 9940 58 CC D TR1 AST START (LWP)
9881 59 CC D TR1 SHRT-P BKL (U4) 9941 58 CC D TR1 AST END (LWP)
9882 59 CC D TR2 SHRT-P BKL (U4) 9942 58 CC D TR2 LONG-P BKL (LWP)
9883 59 CC D TR3 SHRT-P BKL (U4) 9943 58 CC D TRAY2 P-F TMG (LWP)
9884 58 CC D PFT UP LMT POS (U5) 9944 58 CC D TR2 AST ON/OFF (LWP)
9885 58 CC D PFT P-BUCKLE (U5) 9945 58 CC D TR2 AST START (LWP)
9886 58 CC D PFT P-F TIMING (U5) 9946 58 CC D TR2 AST END (LWP)
9887 58 CC D PFT AST ON/OFF (U5) 9947 58 CC D TR3 LONG-P BKL (LWP)
9888 58 CC D PFT AST START (U5) 9948 58 CC D TRAY3 P-F TMG (LWP)
9889 58 CC D PFT AST END (U5) 9949 58 CC D TR3 AST ON/OFF (LWP)
9890 58 CC D TR1 LONG-P BKL (U5) 9950 58 CC D TR3 AST START (LWP)
9891 58 CC D TRAY1 P-F TMG (U5) 9951 58 CC D TR3 AST END (LWP)
9892 58 CC D TR1 AST ON/OFF (U5) 9952 58 CC D RE-FEED P-BKL (LWP)
9893 58 CC D TR1 AST START (U5) 9953 107 HCF D HCAP-F UP LMT PO(LP)
9894 58 CC D TR1 AST END (U5) 9955 107 HCF D HCAP-F P STRT (LWP)
9895 58 CC D TR2 LONG-P BKL (U5) 9956 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST SET (LWP)
9896 58 CC D TRAY2 P-F TMG (U5) 9957 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST STRT(LWP)
9897 58 CC D TR2 AST ON/OFF (U5) 9958 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST END (LWP)
9898 58 CC D TR2 AST START (U5) 9959 58 CC D FD EJECT SPD ADJ LWP
9899 58 CC D TR2 AST END (U5) 9960 59 CC D RE-FD ARV TMG(LWP-LG)
9900 58 CC D TR3 LONG-P BKL (U5) 9961 59 CC D BELT SPD RATIO (LWP)
9901 58 CC D TRAY3 P-F TMG (U5) 9962 59 CC D HEAD GAP (LWP)
9902 58 CC D TR3 AST ON/OFF (U5) 9963 59 CC D VERTICAL POS 1 (LWP)
9903 58 CC D TR3 AST START (U5) 9964 59 CC D VERTICAL POS 2 (LWP)
9904 58 CC D TR3 AST END (U5) 9965 59 CC D CIS S-MASK MODE(LWP)
9905 58 CC D RE-FEED P-BKL (U5) 9966 59 CC D FD S-FNC OFFST (LWP)
9906 107 HCF D HCAP-F UP LIMT (U5) 9967 59 CC D FD E-ROLL SPEED(LWP)
9908 107 HCF D HCAP-F P START (U5) 9968 59 CC D WING OFFSET (LWP)
9909 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST SET (U5) 9969 59 CC D FU EJ ROLL SPD (LWP)
9910 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST STRT (U5) 9970 59 CC D AS S-FNC OFFST (LWP)
9911 107 HCF D HCAP-F AST END (U5) 9971 59 CC D AS E-FNC OFFST (LWP)
PROCEDURE:
1. With the machine powered ON, insert the USB Memory Stick in the USB slot on the machine operation panel.
2. Execute test mode No. 460 and turn OFF the machine power using the Sub Power Key on the machine operation panel.
<The data is still not copied yet.>
3. Turn ON the machine power using the Sub Power Key on the machine operation panel, and wait until the machine boots up
completely.
<The user setting data is saved in the USB Memory Stick at this time.>
4. Remove the USB Memory Stick after the machine is completely booted up.
NOTE:
Error Message W48-0280 may display when this test mode is activated right after the USB Memory Stick is set on the
machine.
In that case, take either one of the two actions listed below.
1) Wait at least 5 seconds before activating the test mode from the time the USB Memory Stick is set on the machine.
2) Re-activate the test mode when error message W48-0280 displays.
PROCEDURE:
1. With the machine powered ON, insert the USB Memory Stick in the USB slot on the machine operation panel.
2. Execute test mode No. 461 and turn OFF the machine power using the Sub Power Key on the machine operation panel.
<The data is still not restored onto the HDD yet.>
3. Turn ON the machine power using the Sub Power Key on the machine operation panel, and wait until the machine boots up
completely.
<The user setting data is restored onto the HDD at this time.>
4. Remove the USB Memory Stick after the machine is completely booted up.
5. Reboot the machine again and confirm that the restore of the data onto the HDD is successfully done.
NOTE:
Error Message W48-0280 may display when this test mode is activated right after the USB Memory Stick is set on the
machine.
In that case, take either one of the two actions listed below.
1) Wait at least 5 seconds before activating the test mode from the time the USB Memory Stick is set on the machine.
2) Re-activate the test mode when error message W48-0280 displays.
Not shown in the Test Mode list on the panel display.
Test mode number is not listed on the test mode selection display.
The test mode number must be typed in.
473 Charge Count Print (Import)
Reads user & dealer information that stored in [Charge count print] from USB memory stick.
File name: ChargeCountTest.csv
Caution: 1. Run this test mode after 5 seconds of insert the USB memory stick. 2. Run this test mode again, if [W49-0280-6]
error codes occur.
474 Charge Count Print (Export)
Writes user & dealer information that stored in [Charge count print] to USB memory stick.
File name: ChargeCountTest.csv
Caution: 1. Run this test mode after 5 seconds of insert the USB memory stick. 2. Run this test mode again, if [W49-0280-6]
error codes occur.
490 Security Firmware Installation <Optional RISO Security Package>
This test mode is used only when optional RISO Security Package is purchased.
<The RISO Security Package Software is stored in the USB memory device which comes in the chargeable option package.>
In order to make this Test Mode No.490 active, follow the instruction given bellow.
1) Go into Test Mode No.780 [Tech Access Button Display] and change the setting from [0] to [1] .
2) Escape out of the test mode and go into the Admin setting.
3) Select [Maintenance Permission] and change the setting from
[Prohibited] to [Permitted].
4) Go into the test mode and Test Mode No.490 can then be found listed in the [System] category of all the test modes.
Or you can directly type in the number 490 on the operation panel.
This test mode installs the security option firmware and enables the optional security.
RISO Security Package Key Code must be keyed in by Test Modes No. 760, 761 and 762 prior to this test mode to enable the
installation of the security package.
Follow the instruction which comes with the RISO Security Package, and also the [Chapter 18 RISO Security Package] of this
Technical Manual.
The machine reboots automatically after the security option firmware is installed.
NOTE: <Caution in relation to the installation of this optional software.>
1) Activating this test mode will clear the users area and Admin. settings.
2) Print job will not be accepted while in this test mode
3) Print jobs that are received and those being received will be deleted.
4) Do not power OFF the machine while this test mode is in action.
Paper Feed Settings (U1-U5, Light Paper) ComColor Unit (Series 9000)
Test Mode Number
U1 U2 U3 U4 U5 LP Process Name Default Unit/Range Description
0: Top
Specifies the upper limit position of the
9700 9746 9792 9838 9884 9931 PFT UP LMT POS 1 1: Middle
paper feed tray.
2: Bottom
Specifies the amount of slackness in
external paper feeding.
9701 9747 9793 9839 9885 9932 PFT P-BUCKLE 3 (-10 - 20)mm
Adjusts the timing of external paper feed
motor deactivation.
Adjusts the timing of external paper feed
motor activation.
Changes the activation timing of the
external paper feed motor relative to the
9702 9748 9794 9840 9886 9933 PFT P-F TIMING 0 (-30 - 30)ms
timing of registration motor startup.
The interval between external paper
feed motor activation and deactivation is
not changed.
Specifies whether assist control is
0: OFF
9703 9749 9795 9841 9887 9934 PFT AST ON/OFF 1 executed when paper is transferred from
1: ON
external paper feeding.
Specifies the time when external paper
9704 9750 9796 9842 9888 9935 PFT AST START 0 (-100 - 100)ms
feed assist is started.
Specifies the time when external paper
9705 9751 9797 9843 9889 9936 PFT AST END 0 (-100 - 100)ms
feed assist is finished.
Specifies the amount of slackness when
9706 9752 9798 9844 9890 9937 TR1 LONG-P BKL 3 (-10 - 20)mm
long paper is transferred from tray 1.
Specifies the timing when paper transfer
9707 9753 9799 9845 9891 9938 TRAY1 P-F TMG 0 (-100 - 100)ms
starts from tray 1.
Specifies whether assist control is
0: OFF
9708 9754 9800 9846 9892 9939 TR1 AST ON/OFF 1 executed when paper is transferred from
1: ON
tray 1.
Specifies the time when tray 1 assist is
9709 9755 9801 9847 9893 9940 TR1 AST START 1 (-100 - 100)ms
started.
Specifies the time when tray 1 assist is
9710 9756 9802 9848 9894 9941 TR1 AST END 0 0-200ms
finished.
Specifies the amount of slackness when
9711 9757 9803 9849 9895 9942 TR2 LONG-P BKL 4 (-10 - 20)mm
long paper is transferred from tray 2.
Specifies the timing when paper transfer
9712 9758 9804 9850 9896 9943 TRAY2 P-F TMG 0 (-100 - 100)ms
starts from tray 2.
Specifies whether assist control is
0: OFF
9713 9759 9805 9851 9897 9944 TR2 AST ON/OFF 1 executed when paper is transferred from
1: ON
tray 2.
Specifies the time when tray 2 assist is
9714 9760 9806 9852 9898 9945 TR2 AST START 1 (-100 - 100)ms
started.
Specifies the time when tray 2 assist is
9715 9761 9807 9853 9899 9946 TR2 AST END 0 0-200ms
finished.
Specifies the amount of slackness when
9716 9762 9808 9854 9900 9947 TR3 LONG-P BKL 3 (-10 - 20)mm
long paper is transferred from tray 3.
Specifies the timing when paper transfer
9717 9763 9809 9855 9901 9948 TRAY3 P-F TMG 0 (-100 - 100)ms
starts from tray 3.
Specifies whether assist control is
0: OFF
9718 9764 9810 9856 9902 9949 TR3 AST ON/OFF 1 executed when paper is transferred from
1: ON
tray 3.
Specifies the time when tray 3 assist is
9719 9765 9811 9857 9903 9950 TR3 AST START 1 (-100 - 100)ms
started.
Specifies the time when tray 3 assist is
9720 9766 9812 9858 9904 9951 TR3 AST END 0 0-200ms
finished.
Specifies the amount of slackness in re-
9721 9767 9813 9859 9905 9952 RE-FEED P-BKL 6 0-20mm
feeding.
FD EJECTION
9728 9774 9820 9866 9912 9959 SPEED 0 (-300 - 300)mm/s Compensates the FD ejection speed.
COMPENSATION
Paper Feed Settings (U1-U5, Light Paper) ComColor Unit (Series 9000)
Test Mode Number
U1 U2 U3 U4 U5 LP Process Name Default Unit/Range Description
RE-FEED ARRIVAL
Compensates the re-feed paper arrival
9729 9775 9821 9867 9913 9960 TIMING (U-LONG 20 (-50 - 50)ms
timing. (Long paper = 356 mm or longer.)
SHEET)
Specifies the belt speed ratio.
This is the transfer belt speed ratio
9730 9776 9822 9868 9914 9961 BELT SPD RATIO 1000 950-1020
relative to a registration roller speed of
1. (1=0.1%)
Specifies the head gap
9731 9777 9823 9869 9915 9962 HEAD GAP 0
0: Standard 1: Card 2: Envelopes 1 3: Envelopes 2
9732 9778 9824 9870 9916 9963 VERTICAL POS 1 0 (-20 - 20)mm Adjusts secondary scanning position 1.
9733 9779 9825 9871 9917 9964 VERTICAL POS 2 0 (-20 - 20)mm Adjusts secondary scanning position 2.
Activate or Inactivate the CIS on the
CIS SIDE MASK 0: Inactive
side registration unit to check the paper
9734 9780 9826 9872 9918 9965 1
MODE 1: Active
width for the Side Margin and Image
Centering.
60 (80- Adjusts the FD paper ejection fence
9735 9781 9827 9873 9919 9966 FD S-FNC OFFST (-500 - 500)
TM9966) offset. (1=0.1mm)
Adjusts the FD paper ejection roller speed.
9736 9782 9828 9874 9920 9967 FD E-ROLL SPEED 0 0: Standard 1: Heavyweight 2: Lightweight 3: Postcard 4:
Envelopes
Adjusts the FU paper ejection wing
9737 9783 9829 9875 9921 9968 WING OFFSET 0 (-500 - 500)
offset. (1=0.1mm)
Adjusts the FD paper ejection roller
9738 9784 9830 9876 9922 9969 FU EJ ROLL SPD 850 177-1500mm/s
speed.
Adjusts the side paper guide offset of the
9739 9785 9831 9877 9923 9970 AS S-FNC OFFST (-40) (-200 - 400)
auto control stacking tray. (1=0.1mm)
Adjusts the end paper guide offset of the
9740 9786 9832 9878 9924 9971 AS E-FNC OFFST 0 (-300 - 300)
auto control stacking tray. (1=0.1mm)
Specifies the length of the overlap width
9741 9787 9833 9879 9925 9972 ENV FLAP MARGN 0 0-720
for envelopes. (1=0.1mm)
RE-FEED ARRIVAL Compensates the re-feed paper arrival
9742 9788 9834 9880 9926 9973 TIMING (U - 4 (-50 - 50)ms timing. (Short paper = 355 mm or
SHORT) shorter.)
Specifies the amount of slackness when
9743 9789 9835 9881 9927 9974 TR1 SHRT-P BKL 3 (-10 - 20)mm
short paper is transferred from tray 1.
Specifies the amount of slackness when
9744 9790 9836 9882 9928 9975 TR2 SHRT-P BKL 4 (-10 - 20)mm
short paper is transferred from tray 2.
Specifies the amount of slackness when
9745 9791 9837 9883 9929 9976 TR3 SHRT-P BKL 3 (-10 - 20)mm
short paper is transferred from tray 3.
In case of the light weight paper been
selected by the user, and Transfer belt
fan 3 & 4 (middle side) are OFF, and all
TRNS BELT FAN
N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A 9977 40 1-100% other 4 Transfer belt fans are running by
SET (LWP)
set duty.
To reduce contamination by mist
problem on envelope printing.
AF Default Stretching/ Specifies the default value of 05733 (AF scanning image
5903 0 (-20 - 20)
Shrinkage Setting (Front) stretching/shrinkage adjustment (top)).
AF Default Stretching/ Specifies the default value of 05734 (AF scanning image
5904 0 (-20 - 20)
Shrinkage Setting (Back) stretching/shrinkage adjustment (bottom)).
Paper Feed Settings (U1-U5, Light Paper) OPTIONS / High Capacity Feeder
Test Mode Number
U1 U2 U3 U4 U5 LP Process Name Default Unit/Range Description
HCF Paper Buckle Sets the amount of slackness of HCF
9600 9602 9604 9606 9608 9978 6 (-4 - 15)mm
(Long) unit. (Long paper)
HCF Paper Buckle Sets the amount of slackness of HCF
9601 9603 9605 9607 9609 9979 0 (-4 - 15)mm
(Short) unit. (Short paper)
HCF Upper Limit 0: Top 1: Middle Sets the upper limit position of HCF
9722 9768 9814 9860 9906 9953 1
Position 2: Bottom unit.
HCF Paper Feed Sets the paper feed timing of HCF
9724 9770 9816 9862 9908 9955 0 (-100 - 100)ms
Timing unit.
HCF P-F Assist 0: OFF Select paper feed assist control of
9725 9771 9817 9863 9909 9956 1
Control 1: ON the HCF unit.
HCF P-F Assist Sets the paper feed assist start
9726 9772 9818 9864 9910 9957 0 (-100 - 100)ms
Start Timing timing of HCF unit.
HCF P-F Assist End Sets the paper feed assist end
9727 9773 9819 9865 9911 9958 0 0-200ms
Timing timing of HCF unit.